US20050020576A1 - Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof - Google Patents

Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20050020576A1
US20050020576A1 US10/807,113 US80711304A US2005020576A1 US 20050020576 A1 US20050020576 A1 US 20050020576A1 US 80711304 A US80711304 A US 80711304A US 2005020576 A1 US2005020576 A1 US 2005020576A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
methyl
pyrrolidinyl
phenyl
ethyl
mmol
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US10/807,113
Inventor
Wei Zhang
Alan Maycock
Michael Marella
Virendra Kumar
Forrest Gaul
Michael Chang
Deqi Guo
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Adolor Corp
Original Assignee
Adolor Corp
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Priority claimed from US08/612,680 external-priority patent/US5646151A/en
Priority claimed from US08/796,078 external-priority patent/US5688955A/en
Priority claimed from US09/150,369 external-priority patent/US6303611B1/en
Application filed by Adolor Corp filed Critical Adolor Corp
Priority to US10/807,113 priority Critical patent/US20050020576A1/en
Assigned to ADOLOR CORPORATION reassignment ADOLOR CORPORATION ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: CHANG, MICHAEL AN-CHIH, GUO, DEQI, MARELLA, MICHAEL A., GAUL, FORREST, KUMAR, VIRENDRA, MAYCOCK, ALAN L.
Assigned to ADOLOR CORPORATION reassignment ADOLOR CORPORATION ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: ZHANG, WEI YUAN
Publication of US20050020576A1 publication Critical patent/US20050020576A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D295/00Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms
    • C07D295/04Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring nitrogen atoms
    • C07D295/06Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring nitrogen atoms substituted by halogen atoms or nitro radicals
    • C07D295/073Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring nitrogen atoms substituted by halogen atoms or nitro radicals with the ring nitrogen atoms and the substituents separated by carbocyclic rings or by carbon chains interrupted by carbocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/40Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having five-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. sulpiride, succinimide, tolmetin, buflomedil
    • A61K31/403Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having five-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. sulpiride, succinimide, tolmetin, buflomedil condensed with carbocyclic rings, e.g. carbazole
    • A61K31/404Indoles, e.g. pindolol
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/435Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/44Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/4427Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof containing further heterocyclic ring systems
    • A61K31/4439Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof containing further heterocyclic ring systems containing a five-membered ring with nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. omeprazole
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K45/00Medicinal preparations containing active ingredients not provided for in groups A61K31/00 - A61K41/00
    • A61K45/06Mixtures of active ingredients without chemical characterisation, e.g. antiphlogistics and cardiaca
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D207/00Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom
    • C07D207/02Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom
    • C07D207/04Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D207/10Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members with hetero atoms or with carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals, directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D207/12Oxygen or sulfur atoms
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D209/00Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings, condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom
    • C07D209/02Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings, condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom condensed with one carbocyclic ring
    • C07D209/04Indoles; Hydrogenated indoles
    • C07D209/30Indoles; Hydrogenated indoles with hetero atoms or with carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, directly attached to carbon atoms of the hetero ring
    • C07D209/42Carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D213/00Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D213/02Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D213/04Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having no bond between the ring nitrogen atom and a non-ring member or having only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom
    • C07D213/24Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having no bond between the ring nitrogen atom and a non-ring member or having only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D213/54Radicals substituted by carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals
    • C07D213/56Amides
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D241/00Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings
    • C07D241/02Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings not condensed with other rings
    • C07D241/04Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,4-diazine or hydrogenated 1,4-diazine rings not condensed with other rings having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D403/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00
    • C07D403/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00 containing two hetero rings
    • C07D403/06Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00 containing two hetero rings linked by a carbon chain containing only aliphatic carbon atoms

Definitions

  • This invention relates to compounds, to processes of their preparation, to pharmaceutical compositions containing them and to their medical use as agonists at kappa opioid receptors.
  • Opium and its derivatives are potent analgesics that also have other pharmacological effects, and exert their effects by interacting with high-affinity receptors.
  • CNS central nervous system
  • mu
  • delta
  • kappa
  • the ⁇ receptors are abundant in CNS and mediate analgesia, gastrointestinal motility and various hormonal functions.
  • the ⁇ receptors bind morphine-like drugs and mediate the opiate phenomena associated with morphine, including analgesia, opiate dependence, cardiovascular and respiratory functions, and several neuroendocrine effects.
  • the ⁇ receptors have a wide distribution in CNS and mediate a spectrum of functions including the modulation of drinking, water balance, food intake, gut motility, temperature control and various endocrine functions. They also produce analgesia.
  • analgesia See, for example: Leander et al, J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 234, 463-469, 1985; Morley et al, Peptides 4, 797-800, 1983; Manzanares et al, Neuroendocrinology 52, 200-205, 1990; and Iyengar et al, J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther, 238, 429-436, 1986.
  • opioid analgesics such as morphine and codeine act as J receptor agonists. These opioids have well-known, undesirable and potentially dangerous dependence forming side effects.
  • Compounds which are ⁇ -receptor agonists act as analgesics through interaction with ⁇ opioid receptors.
  • the advantage of these agonists over the classical ⁇ receptor agonists, such as morphine, lies in their ability to cause analgesia while being devoid of morphine-like behavioral effects and addiction liability.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,065,573 discloses 4-amino-4-phenylcyclohexane ketal compounds having analgesic activity.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,212,878 discloses phenylacetamide derivatives having analgesic properties and reduced physical dependence liability properties, relative to morphine and methadone.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,145,435 discloses N-(2-amino-cycloaliphatic)-phenylacetamide compounds having analgesic activity and narcotic antagonist activity.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,098,904 discloses N-(2-amino-cycloaliphatic)-benzoamides and naphthamides useful for relieving pain.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,359,476 discloses substituted cycloalkane-amides useful as analgesic and having low abuse liability.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,438,130 discloses 1-oxa-, aza- and thia-spirocyclic compounds having analgesic activity, low physical dependence and abuse liability properties and little dysphoric inducing properties.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,663,343 discloses substituted naphthalenyloxy-1,2-diaminocyclohexyl amides as analgesics.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,906,655 discloses 1,2-cyclohexylaminoaryl amides having high kappa-opioid affinity, selectivity and potency and useful as analgesics, diuretics, anti-inflammatory and psychotherapeutic agents.
  • compositions containing them Compounds having kappa opioid agonist activity, compositions containing them and method of using them as analgesics are provided.
  • the present invention provides a compound of the formulae I, II, IIA, III, IIIA, IIIB, IIIB-i, IV and IVA, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • X 4 and X 5 are independently H; halogen; OH; OCH 3 ; CF 3 ; NO 2 ; NH 2 ; amino substituted with acyl, carbamate, alkyl or aryl sulfonates; COR′′ where R′′ is OH, amino, alkoxy, aryloxy or heteroaryloxy.
  • Compounds of formula (IIA) have at least two chiral centers and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form.
  • the invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • Compounds of formula (IIIA) have at least one chiral center and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form.
  • the invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • Compounds of formula (IIIB) have at least one chiral center and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form.
  • the invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • Compounds of formula (IIIB-i) have at least one chiral center and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form.
  • the invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • Compounds of formula (IV) have at least one chiral center and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form.
  • the invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • Compounds of formula (IVA) have at least one chiral center and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form.
  • the invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • alkyl as used herein alone or as part of another group, denotes optionally substituted, straight and branched chain saturated hydrocarbon groups, preferably having 1 to 12 carbons in the normal chain, most preferably lower alkyl groups.
  • exemplary unsubstituted alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, t-butyl, isobutyl, pentyl, hexyl, isohexyl, 4,4-dimethylpentyl, octyl, 2,2,4-trimethylpentyl, nonyl, decyl, undecyl, dodecyl and the like.
  • substituents include one or more of the following groups: halo, alkoxy, arylalkyloxy (e.g., benzyloxy), alkylthio, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, hydroxy, carboxyl (—COOH), amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, formyl, alkylcarbonyloxy, alkylcarbonyl, heterocyclo, aryloxy, hydroxy or thiol (—SH).
  • lower alkyl denotes such optionally substituted groups as described above for alkyl having 1 to 4 carbon atoms in the normal chain.
  • aromatic or “aryl” as used herein or as part of another group, denote optionally substituted, homocyclic aromatic groups, preferably containing 1 or 2 rings and 6 to 12 ring carbons.
  • exemplary unsubstituted groups include phenyl, biphenyl and naphthyl.
  • exemplary substituents include one or more, preferably three or fewer, nitro groups, alkyl groups as described above, and/or one or more groups described above as alkyl substituents.
  • Preferred aryl groups are unsubstituted aryl and hydroxyaryl.
  • aralkyl as used herein alone or as part of another group, denotes an aryl-alkyl-group wherein aryl and alkyl are as described previously.
  • exemplary aralkyl groups include benzyl, phenethyl and naphthylmethyl.
  • heterocyclo or “heterocyclic” as used herein alone or as part of another group, denote optionally substituted fully saturated or unsaturated, aromatic or non-aromatic cyclic groups having at least one heteroatom in at least one ring, preferably monocyclic or bicyclic groups having 5 or 6 atoms in each ring.
  • Aromatic heterocyclo or heterocyclic groups are also referred to herein as “heteroaryl” groups.
  • the heterocyclo group may, for example, have 1 or 2 oxygen atoms, 1 or 2 sulfur atoms, and/or 1 to 4 nitrogen atoms in the ring.
  • Each heterocyclo group may be bonded through any carbon or heteroatom off the ring system.
  • Preferred groups include those of the following formula, which may be bonded through any atom of the ring system:
  • halogen or “halo” as used herein alone or as part of another group, denote chlorine, bromine, fluorine and iodine.
  • acyl denotes the moiety formed by removal of the hydroxyl group from the group —COOH of an organic carboxylic acid.
  • exemplary groups include alkylcarbonyl, arylcarbonyl, or carbocyclo- or heterocyclocarbonyl.
  • acyloxy as used herein alone or as part of another group denotes an acyl group as described above bonded through an oxygen linkage (—O—).
  • alkoxy denotes an alkyl-O group wherein alkyl is as described previously.
  • exemplary alkoxy groups include methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, i-propoxy, n-butoxy, pentoxy and heptoxy.
  • aryloxy as used herein, alone or as part of another group, denotes an aryl-O group wherein aryl is as described previously.
  • exemplary aryloxy groups include phenoxy and naphthoxy.
  • aralkyloxy denotes an aralkyl-O group wherein aralkyl is as described previously.
  • An exemplary aralkyloxy group is benzyloxy.
  • alkylene denotes a straight or branched bivalent hydrocarbon chain group having from about 1 to 8 carbons.
  • exemplary alkylene groups include methylene (—CH 2 —), ethylene (—CH 2 CH 2 —), propylene (—CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 —) and butylene (—CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 —).
  • alkylene dioxide denotes a —O-alkylene-O— group wherein alkylene is as described previously.
  • alkylene dioxide groups include methylene dioxide (—O—CH 2 —O—) and ethylene dioxide (—O—CH 2 CH 2 —O—).
  • Peripherally-acting ⁇ agonists can be prepared by the attachment of polar groups to non-peptide ⁇ opioid receptor selective agonists, such as the arylacetamides.
  • the introduction of the polar groups may result in either retention or enhancement of antinociceptive potency and selectivity and also may increase the polarity of the ligand sufficient to reduce or eliminate CNS penetration across the blood-brain barrier (BBB).
  • BBB blood-brain barrier
  • the arylacetamide pharmacophore can be divided into three regions: the aromatic region, the central region, and the amine region. All three regions represent potential positions for the attachment of polar groups.
  • the 3′-substituted series can be prepared via Scheme 2.
  • the reduction of the Schiff base intermediate formed during the cyclization to 6 is expected to be stereoselective due to the directing effect of the neighboring hydroxymethyl group.
  • Both intermediates 11 and 12 can be derivatized to confer peripheral selectivity.
  • the 5′-substituted series can be prepared via Schemes 3 and 4. Starting from N-t-Boc-O-MEM-D-serine, the 5′-(S) series can be prepared, and starting from from N-t-Boc-O-MEM-L-serine allows the preparation of the 5′-(R) series.
  • the 2R isomers of 33-34 and 35-36 can be prepared from intermediates 24 and 25, respectively to produce
  • Compound of formula II of the present invention are made by peripheralization by substitutions of the benzo portion of the tetrahydronaphthyl ring of DuPont series of compounds with polar groups.
  • the tetralone derivatives can be converted to dihydronaphthyl derivatives and subjected to chemistry similar to that employed in the preparation of U50,488 derivatives.
  • the resulting compounds are racemic mixtures that can be derivatized to confer peripheral selectivity. If necessary, the final compounds or one of the intermediates can be resolved to test both enantiomers.
  • the compounds of formula III of the present invention are prepared by substituting the central phenyl ring with polar groups.
  • Ar, R 1 , R 2 , X 7 , and n are defined as in formula III.
  • Intermediate 85 can be coupled to 2S-isothiocyanato succinic acid and deprotected to produce 2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N- ⁇ 1-[3-(N-succinic acid-2S-thioureido)aminomethyl]phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl ⁇ acetamide (89).
  • Intermediate 80 can be treated with dibenzyl phosphoryl chloride followed by deprotection to produce 2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N- ⁇ 1-3-(N-phosphoramido)aminophenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl ⁇ acetamide (90).
  • the diamino intermediate 91 (J. Med. Chem. 1990, 33, 286) can be coupled to different regioisomers of nitrophenylacetic acid, which are all commercially available. Reduction of the nitro group provides an amino group for the attachment of polar groups. Alternatively, the amino intermediates 95-97 readily undergo diazonium chemistry that converts the amino groups to carboxyl and sulfonyl chloride groups. This allows the polar groups to be attached via different linkers.
  • Intermediate 96 can be treated with methanesulfonyl chloride to produce ( ⁇ )-(5 ⁇ ,7 ⁇ ,8 ⁇ )-N-methyl-N-[7-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-1-oxaspiro-[4,5]dec-8-yl]-3-(N-methanesulfonamido)aminophenylacetamide (104).
  • Compounds of the above formulas may have one or more asymmetric carbon atoms. Pure sterochemically isomeric forms of the above compounds may be obtained, and diastereoisomers isolated by physical separation methods, including, but not limited to crystallization and chromatographic methods. Cis and trans diasteriomeric racemates may be further resolved into their isomers. If separated, active isomers may be identified by their activity. Such purification is not, however, necessary for preparation of the compositions or practice of the methods herein.
  • the compounds provided herein also include pharmaceutically acceptable salts, acids and esters thereof, stereoisomers, and also metabolites or prodrugs thereof that possess activity as analgesics but do not cause substantial CNS effects when administered or applied.
  • Metabolites include any compound that is produced upon administration of the compound and metabolism thereof.
  • N-Benzyl-D-serine (1) 1 To a mixture of D-serine (25.0 g, 0.237 mol) and 200 mL anhydrous methanol was added sodium cyanoborohydride (11.95 g, 0.190 mol), while maintaining the temperature at 0° C. with an ice bath. Then, benzaldehyde (26.5 mL, 0.261 mol) was added to the reaction flask, dropwise, at 30° C. The mixture was stirred for 60 Hr. at room temperature. Then, the mixture was filtered and rinsed with methanol (50 mL). The white solid was dried in a vacuum oven at 40° C. and 10 mmHg over 2 nights: 24.5 g.
  • N-Benzyl-D-serine methyl ester (2) Hydrogen chloride (gas) was bubbled into anhydrous methanol for 10 minutes. Then, the solution was allowed to cool to room temperature. Then, N-benzyl-D-serine (24.6 gm, 0.126 mol) was added to the reaction flask and refluxed over night under dry nitrogen. Then, the solvent was evaporated and dissolved in dichloromethane (200 mL), and washed with a saturated solution of sodium bicarbonate. The dichloromethane layer was dried with magnesium sulfate and the solvent was evaporated. (23 gm, 87.2% yield). 1 H NMR (CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 3.41 (d, 1H, CH), 3.52-3.80 (dd, 2H, benzylic), 3.69 (s, 3H, OMe), 7.27 (s, 5H, ArH).
  • N-[(1,1-Dimethylethoxy)carbonyl-D-Ser-(O-Bzl)-N-benzyl-D-Ser-OMe (3) To a solution of N-boc-D-serine-(O-bzl)OH (15 g, 50.76 mmol) in anhydryous dichloromethane (200 mL) was added HOBt (7.54 g, 55.8 mmol) at 0° C. under dry nitrogen. Then, DCC (11.5 g, 55.7 mmol) in dichloromethane (100 mL) was added dropwise to the reaction flask. Then, this mixture was stirred for 1 Hr.
  • N-benzyl-D-serine-OMe (10 g, 47.8 mmol) in dichloromethane (100 mL) was added dropwise to the reaction flask. Then, stirred for 4 days. Then, filtered and rinsed with dichloromethane (100 ml). The white precipitate was DCU and HOBt. The filtrate was evaporated and re-dissolved in ethyl acetate (100 mL). Then, this was allowed to precipitate, overnight—more DCU. This was filtered and rinsed with ethyl acetate.
  • the compound was prepared by the catalytic hydrogenation of (R)-1 HCl following the procedure described in the above reference.
  • the product was isolated as a free base as clear oil in 81% yield and the dihydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl; 1 H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 1.67 (4H, m), 1.95-3.10 (6H, m), 3.10-3.80 (7H, m), 4.30 (1H, m), 4.65 (1H, m), 7.05 (1H, m), 7.35 (3H, m); MS (FAB) 356 (M+H) + .
  • the hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl to give (R)-3k HCl, 0.10 g (21%); mp 183-185° C.; 1 H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 1.68 (4H, m), 2.30-3.00 (6H, m), 3.15-4.00 (5H, m), 4.15-4.65 (3H, m), 4.85 (1H, m), 7.00 (1H, m), 7.31 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 435 (M+H) + .
  • Racemic compounds were prepared as illustrated by the following steps. (R,S)-2-[(1-Pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride [(R,S)-4 HCl]
  • 1,1′-Carbonyldiimidazole (0.324 g, 2.0 mmol) was added to a stirred solution of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.41 g, 2.0 mmol) in 10 mL of CH 2 Cl 2 at room temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere, and the resulting solution was continued stirring for additional 1 h. The resulting solution was then added to a stirred solution of (R,S)-5 (0.247 g, 1.0 mmol) in 10 mL of CH 2 Cl 2 at 0° C. and the reaction mixture was stirred for further 20 h. The reaction mixture was diluted with CH 2 Cl 2 and washed with aqueous 2M Na 2 CO 3 .
  • the compound was prepared by the hydrogenation of (R,S)-9e HCl on 10% Pd/C following the procedure described in the literature1.
  • the compound, (R,S)-9f 2HCl was isolated as dihydrochloride in 84% yield; mp 195° C. (d); 1 H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d 6 ) ⁇ 2.00 (4H, m), 3.05-4.45 (16H, m), 3.75 (3H, s), 5.00 (1H, m), 7.45 (4H, brs); MS (FAB) 361 (M+H) + ; Anal. Calcd for C 19 H 28 N 4 O 3 .2HCl.H 2 O: C, 50.56; H, 7.15; N, 12.41. Found: C, 50.36; H, 7.26; N, 12.05.
  • the compound was prepared from 4-trifluorometylphenylacetic acid and isolated as hydrochloride salt, (R,S)-10b HCl, in 30% yield; mp 110° C.; 1 H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d 6 ) ⁇ 2.00 (4H, m), 2.15 (3H, s), 2.70-3.25 (6H, m), 3.504.45 (8H, m), 5.05 (1H, m), 7.70 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 398 (M+H) + .
  • the compound was prepared from 2-trifluorometylphenylacetic acid and the hydrochloride salt was made from 1M etherial HCl to give (R,S)-10c HCl in 57%; 220° C. (d); 1 H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 1.65 (4H, m), 2.05 (3H, s), 2.25-3.25 (6H, m), 3.40-4.10 (6H, m), 4.50 (2H, m), 4.70 (1H, m), 7.30 (2H, m), 7.60 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 398 (M+H) + .
  • the compound was prepared from 2-nitro-phenylacetic acid following Procedure A and isolated on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH 2 Cl 2 :CH 3 OH:28% NH 4 OH (99:1:2) to give the desired product as a free base (3.15 g, 78%). Then, proceed on to the next step.
  • reaction mixture was evaporated under reduced pressure (due to the water solubility of this compound there was no aqueous work-up) and isolated on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH 2 Cl 2 :CH 3 OH:28% NH 4 OH (98:2:2) to give the desired product as a free base (0.18 g, 20%); 1 H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl 3 ) d 1.76 (m, 4H), 2.25-3.15 (m, 10H), 3.26 (t, 2H), 3.88 (m, 1H), 4.39 (t, 1H).
  • the compound was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel, eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :CH 3 OH:28% NH 4 OH (99:1:2) to give the desired product as a free base (m.p. 140-145° C.; 0.08 g, 47% yield).
  • the hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etheral HCl.
  • the compound was prepared by coupling of 4- ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇ -trifluoromethylphenyl-acetic acid with methyl-3-(R,S)-[3-(S)-hydroxy-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazine carboxylate; mp: (HCl salt) 98-100° C.; 1 H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 1.6-3.1 (11H, m), 3.4-5.4 (12H, m), 7.1-7.7 (8H, m); MS (FAB) 616 (M+H) + ; Anal. Calcd for C 29 H 31 F 6 N 3 O 5 .HCl. H 2 O.0.25NH 4 Cl: C, 50.97; H, 5.16; N, 6.66. Found: C, 50.45; H, 5.07; N, 6.67.
  • the compound was prepared by methylsulphonylation of 4-acetyl-1-[3-amino)phenyl]acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine as clear oil, the dihydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl; mp: (HCl salt)140° C. (dec.); 1 H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 1.5-1.7 (4H, m), 1.8-3.1 (13H, m), 3.44.9 (9H, m), 6.5 (2H, m), 7.0 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 423 (M+H) + .
  • the compound was prepared by coupling of 4- ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇ -trifluoromethyphenyl acetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-hydroxy-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt) 134-136° C.; 1 H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 1.6-3.2 (15H, m), 3.4-4.1 (5H, m), 4.3-5.2 (3H, m), 7.3 (4H, m), 7.5 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 599 (M+H) + ; Anal. Calcd for C 29 H 31 F 6 N 3 O 4 .HCl.0.5NH 4 Cl: C, 52.55; H, 5.17; N, 7.40. Found: C, 52.05; H, 5.56; N, 7.90.
  • the compound was prepared by coupling of 2-pyridylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt) 127-130° C.; 1 H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 1.4-1.7 (4H, m), 2.0 (3H, s), 2.2-3.2 (9H, m), 3.4-4.8 (6H, m), 6.8-7.5 (3H, m), 8.4 (1H, m); MS (FAB) 331 (M+H) + ; Anal. Calcd. for C 18 H 26 N 4 O 2 .2HCl.0.5NH 4 Cl: C, 50.27; H, 7.03; N, 14.65. Found: C, 50.86; H, 6.47; N, 15.79.
  • the compound was prepared from 1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(3-hydroxy-1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine dihydrochloride 1 (0.25 g, 0.56 mmol), methanesulfonyl chloride (0.43 mL, 5.56 mmol), triethylamine (2.3 mL, 16.53 mmol) and CH 2 Cl 2 (20 mL) at 0° C. for 6 h. After dilution with saturated NaHCO 3 solution (20 mL) and washed with water (20 mL). Then, dried over MgSO 4 .
  • the compound was purified by flash chromatography on silica gel, eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :CH 3 OH:28% NH 4 OH (99:1:2) to give the desired product as a free base (0.28 g; 94% yield) and a hydrochloride salt was generated (0.067 g; m.p. 130-132° C.; 1 H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 2.10 (m, 1H), 2.29 (m, 1H), 2.59 (m, 4H), 2.89 (s.
  • the compound was prepared by coupling of 4-( ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇ -triflouromethyl)phenyl acetic acid with 4-methyl sulphonyl-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-hydroxy-1-(pyrrolidinyl) methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt) 120-123° C.; 1 H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 1.8-2.2 (4H, m), 2.4-3.3 (8H, m), 2.7 (3H, s), 3.64.0 (6H, m), 4.8-5.2 (2H, m), 7.4 (4H, m), 7.6 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 636 (M+H) + ; Anal. Calcd. For C 28 H 31 F 6 N 3 O 5 S. HCl: C, 50.04; H, 4.80; N, 6.25. Found: C, 50.34; H, 4.80; N, 6.09.
  • the compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(3′-(S)-hydroxypyrrolidine)methyl]piperazine. Then, this racemic mixture was separated on a Chiralpak AD column using 100% acetonitrile as the eluant. Then, from the 2-(S), 3′-(S) enantiomer a HCl salt was generated (1.0 gm.); mp: (HCl salt)130-135° C.; [a] 20 +25.560 (0.85%; w/v MeOH).
  • the compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(3′-(R)hydroxy-1-pyrrolidine)methyl]piperazine. Then, this racemic mixture was separated on a Chiralpak AD column using 100% acetonitrile as the eluant. Then, from the 2-(R), 3′-(R) enantiomer a HCl salt was generated (0.9 gm.); mp: (HCl salt)130-135° C.; [a] 20 ⁇ 30.49° (0.88%; w/v MeOH).
  • the compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(3′-(R)-hydroxy-1-pyrrolidine)methyl]piperazine. Then, this racemic mixture was separated on a Chiralpak AD column using 100% acetonitrile as the eluant. Then, from the 2-(S), 3′-(R) enantiomer a HCl salt was generated (1.05 gm); mp: (HCl salt)130-135° C.; [a] 20 +28.80 (0.75%; w/v MeOH).
  • Intermediates 17 and 18 were prepared via known methods from 6-methoxy-1-tetralone and 1-tetralone, respectively. Intermediates 17 and 18 were coupled to 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid to produce ( ⁇ )-19 and ( ⁇ )-20.
  • the t-butyl ester intermediate was flash column chromatographed twice eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 :2% MeOH and CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 :1% MeOH, respectively.
  • the t-butyl ester was then deprotected in a mixture of THF (4 mL) and conc. HCl (2 mL) with stirring at 25° C. overnight and at 50° C. for 1 h before the mixture was evaporated.
  • the residue was then dissolved in a mixture of trifluoroacetic acid (2 mL), 4 N HCl (2 mL), and anisole (1 drop), and stirred at 25° C. for 2.5 days before the mixture was evaporated.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling method from ( ⁇ )-1 (1.453 g, 5.58 mmol), diphenylacetic acid (2.369 g, 11.16 mmol), DCC (2.373 g, 11.50 mmol), and pyridine (0.93 mL, 11.5 mmol).
  • the product was flash column chromatographed eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 :1% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O and crystallized from MeOH-Et 2 O to yield ( ⁇ )-6.HCl (1.7 g, 63%): m.p.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling method from ( ⁇ )-2 (0.5790 g, 2.103 mmol), 2-nitro-4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (1.0512 g, 4.204 mmol), DCC (0.8948 g, 4.34 mmol), and pyr (0.35 mL, 4.3 mmol). After stirring at 25° C. overnight, more 2-nitro-4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (1.0510 g, 4.203 mmol), DCC (0.8946 g, 4.34 mmol), and CH 2 Cl 2 (10 mL) were added, and after 5 h, the reaction was worked up according to the general procedure.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from ( ⁇ )-2 (1.8173 g, 6.600 mmol), 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid (2.7066 g, 13.20 mmol), DCC (2.8057 g, 13.60 mmol), and pyr (1.10 mL, 13.6 mmol).
  • the product was purified by flash column eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 :1% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with Et 2 O—HCl and washed with hot MeOH to yield ( ⁇ )-9.HCl (2.49 g, 76%): m.p.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from ( ⁇ )-2 (0.3414 g, 1.240 mmol), 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (0.5309 g, 2.478 mmol), DCC (0.5288 g, 2.563 mmol), and pyr (0.21 mL, 2.55 mmol). After stirring at 25° C. overnight, more of 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (0.5307 g, 2.477 mmol), DCC (1.1356 g, 5.504 mmol), and CH 2 Cl 2 (13 mL) were added, and the mixture was worked up according to the general procedure after another night of stirring.
  • diethyl 2-bromoethylphosphonate (0.8601 g, 3.52 mmol) was added to a mixture of ( ⁇ )-10 (0.3042 g, 0.704 mmol) and NEt(iPr) 2 (0.74 mL, 4.2 mmol) in dry THF (4 mL). After 10 min, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N 2 for 2.5 days before more diethyl 2-bromoethylphosphonate (0.8546 g) and NEt(iPr) 2 (0.74 mL, 4.2 mmol) were added.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from ( ⁇ )-17 (0.6213 g, 1.40 mmol), 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.5764 g, 2.81 mmol), DCC (0.5951 g, 2.88 mmol), and pyr (0.23 mL, 2.88 mmol).
  • the product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 :1% MeOH and further purified by radial chromatography eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 .
  • the product was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O to yield ( ⁇ )-19.HCl (0.3 g, 32%): m.p.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from ( ⁇ )-18 (0.4530 g, 1.095 mmol), 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.4485 g, 2.19 mmol), DCC (0.4677 g, 2.27 mmol), and pyr (0.18 mL, 2.26 mmol).
  • the product was purified by flash column eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 and then by radial chromatography eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 .
  • the product was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O and then washed with hot MeOH to yield ( ⁇ )-20.HCl (0.33 g, 47%): m.p.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from ( ⁇ )-23 (0.4265 g, 1.971 mmol), 2-nitro-4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.9859 g, 3.943 mmol), DCC (0.8350 g, 4.047 mmol), and pyr (0.33 mL, 4.06 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by silica gel column eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O and crystallized from MeOH to yield ( ⁇ )-24.HCl (0.3630 g, 38%, first crop): m.p.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from ( ⁇ )-23 (0.3229 g, 1.492 mmol), 2-nitro-4-trifluoromethylphenylacetic acid (0.5579 g, 2.24 mmol), DCC (0.5512 g, 2.67 mmol), and pyr (0.19 mL, 2.31 mmol).
  • the crude product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O and crystallized from MeOH-Et 2 O to yield ( ⁇ )-26.HCl (0.3643 g, 50%): m.p.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from ( ⁇ )-23 (0.2615 g, 1.209 mmol), diphenylacetic acid (0.5123 g, 2.41 mmol), DCC (0.5138 g, 2.49 mmol), and pyr (0.20 mL, 2.5 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by gravity column eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O and crystallized from MeOH to yield ( ⁇ )-28.HCl (0.3815 g, 71%): m.p.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from ( ⁇ )-23 (0.3271 g, 1.51 mmol), 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (0.6464 g, 3.017 mmol), DCC (0.6438, 3.12 mmol), and pyr (0.25 mL, 3.1 mmol).
  • the product was purified by gravity column eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O and crystallized from MeOH-Et 2 O to yield ( ⁇ )-29.HCl (0.5295 g, 78%): m.p.
  • Example 2a The preparation of a compound of Formula IIA is shown in Example 2a.
  • Compounds 1-5 were prepared by the method described in Chang, A.-C. Ph.D. Thesis, University of Minnesota-Twin Cities, 1995.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from 8 (1.4886 g, 5.97 mmol), 2-nitrophenylacetic acid (2.1619 g, 11.93 mmol), DCC (2.5402 g, 12.31 mmol), and pyridine (1.00 mL, 12.36 mmol).
  • the crude product was converted to the HCl salt with Et 2 O—HCl without chromatography and crystallized from MeOH-Et 2 O.
  • the first crop was recrystallized again from MeOH-Et 2 O to yield 10.HCl (1.3663 g, 51%): m.p.
  • Raney nickel was added in small quantities to a mixture of 10 (0.9857 g, 2.3899 mmol) and hydrazine hydrate (55%, 2 mL) in EtOH (30 mL) until gas evolution stopped in about 10 min. The mixture was then filtered through celite, and the Raney nickel was washed with hot MeOH (100 mL). The filtrate was evaporated and dried in vacuo before the residue was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO 3 and CH 2 Cl 2 , which was dried (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtered through celite, and evaporated.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from 8 (0.3690 g, 1.4801 mmol), 2-nitro-4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.7301 g, 2.920 mmol), DCC (0.6213 g, 3.01 mmol), and pyridine (0.24 mL, 3.01 mmol).
  • the crude product was converted to the HCl salt with Et 2 O—HCl without chromatography and crystallized from MeOH to yield 13.HCl (0.3232 g, 42%): m.p. (HCl salt) 165° C.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from 8 (0.5138 g, 2.061 mmol), 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (0.8825 g, 4.119 mmol), DCC (0.8771 g, 4.251 mmol), and pyridine (0.34 mL, 4.245 mmol).
  • the crude product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CHCl 3 :2% NH 3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O and crystallized from MeOH to yield 14.HCl (0.4695 g, 47%): m.p.
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling method from 8 (1.9948 g, 8.001 mmol), N-Boc-4-aminophenylacetic acid (3.0589 g, 12.173 mmol), DCC (2.6602 g, 12.89 mmol), and pyridine (1.04 mL, 12.9 mmol).
  • the crude product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 : 2% NH 3 :1% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O and crystallized from MeOH to yield 18.HCl (0.4891 g, 12%, first crop): m.p. (HCl salt) 170° C.
  • This compound was prepared from 16 (1.0729 g, 1.992 mmol), Raney nickel, and hydrazine hydrate (2 mL) in EtOH (30 mL). The conditions were similar to those used for the preparation of 9. The product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 , and the pure fractions were converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O to yield 17.HCl (0.1194 g, 11%, unoptimized): m.p.
  • diethyl chlorophosphate (0.84 mL, 5.81 mmol) was added to a mixture of 17 (0.7383 g, 1.4514 mmol) and NEt(iPr) 2 (1.5 mL, 8.7 mmol) in dry THF (15 mL). After 10 min, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N 2 overnight before more THF (15 mL), NEt(iPr) 2 (0.76 mL), and diethyl chlorophosphate (0.42 mL) were sequentially added. After 3 h, the mixture was quenched with H 2 O, diluted with CH 2 Cl 2 , evaporated, and dried in vacuo.
  • the DCU was washed with a little CH 2 Cl 2 , and the filtrate was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO 3 and CH 2 Cl 2 , which was dried (MgSO 4 ), filtered through celite, and evaporated. Toluene was added to azeotrope off pyridine. The product was flash column chromatographed eluting with CHCl 3 :2% NH 3 :2% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O and crystallized from MeOH to yield 21.HCl (0.14 g, 47%): m.p.
  • This compound was prepared from 20 (0.2 g, 0.91 mmol), 2-nitro-4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.45 g, 1.8 mmol), DCC (0.37 g, 1.8 mmol), NEt(iPr) 2 (0.48 mL, 2.7 mmol), and pyridine (0.15 mL, 1.8 mmol).
  • the conditions are similar to those for the preparation of 21.
  • the product was column chromatographed eluting with CH 2 Cl 2 :2% NH 3 :1% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et 2 O and crystallized from iPrOH to yield 22.HCl (0.060 g, 14%): m.p.
  • This compound was prepared from 20 (0.2 g, 0.91 mmol), 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (0.41 g, 1.8 mmol), DCC (0.37 g, 1.8 mmol), pyridine (0.15 mL, 1.8 mmol), and NEt(iPr) 2 (0.48 mL, 2.7 mmol).
  • the conditions are similar to those for the preparation of 21. After stirring at 25° C. overnight, more pyridine (0.075 mL, 0.9 mmol) and DCC (0.18 g, 0.9 mmol) were added, and the reaction was worked up the next day.
  • the plug was rinsed with methylene chloride and the aqueous layer was extracted with methylene chloride. The combined organic layers were dried (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give 2.2 g of a light brown solid.
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 8% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 1.7 g (88%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 29 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the procedure described in the preparation of 29 from 28 (0.6 g; 2.9 mmol), 2-nitrophenylacetic acid (0.8 g; 4.4 mmol), DCC (1.2 g; 5.8 mmol), and pyridine (00.1 mL; 1.4 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 7% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 0.2 g (20%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 31 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (1.4 g; 6.9 mmol), 2-nitro 4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (1.9 g; 7.6 mmol), HOBT (1.0 g; 7.6 mmol), EDCI (1.4 g; 7.6 mmol), and pyridine (0.8 mL; 10.3 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 2.0 g (60%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 32 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (432 mg; 2. mmol), 4-Methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (500 mg; 2.3 mmol), HOBT (341 mg; 2.5 mmol), EDCI (483 mg; 2.5 mmol), and DIPEA (0.550 mL; 3.1 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 4% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 160 mg (19%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 33 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (500 mg; 2.4 mmol), 2-Methoxyphenylacetic acid (610 mg; 3.6 mmol), HOBT (495 mg; 3.6 mmol), EDCI (700 mg; 3.6 mmol), and DIPEA (0.850 mL; 4.8 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 7% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 822 mg (96%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 34 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (500 mg; 2.4 mmol), Indole-3-acetic acid (641 mg; 3.6 mmol), HOB (494 mg; 3.6 mmol), EDCI (700 mg; 3.6 mmol), and DIPEA (0.637 mL; 3.6 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 7% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 761 mg (88%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 35 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (200 mg; 0.9 mmol), ( ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇ -Trifluoro-p-tolyl) acetic acid (239 mg; 1.1 mmol), HOBT (157 mg; 1.1 mmol), EDCI (223 mg; 1.1 mmol), and DIPEA (0.203 mL; 1.1 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 2% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 354 mg (93%) of pure product which was treated with 11.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 36 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (500 mg; 2.4 mmol), (2-Nitro- ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇ -trifluro-4-tolyl) acetic acid (728 mg; 2.9 mmol), OBT (395 mg; 2.9 mmol), EDCI (559 mg; 2.9 mmol), and DIPEA (0.510 mL; 2.9 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 10% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 786 mg (74%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 37 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (100 mg; 0.4 mmol), (1-[p-chlorobenzoyl)-5-methoxy-2-methyl indole-3-acetic acid (189 mg; 0.5 mmol), HOBT (73 mg; 0.5 mmol), EDCI (101 mg; 0.5 mmol), and DIPEA (128 mL; 0.7 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 200 mg (79%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 38 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (1.5 g; 7.3 mmol), 4-Nitrophenylacetic acid (2.0 g; 11.0 mmol), HOBT (1.4 g; 11.0 mmol), EDCI (2.1 g; 11.0 mmol), and DIPEA (2.5 mL; 14.6 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 2.5 g (93%) of pure product which was treated with 11.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 39 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (1.5 g; 7.3 mmol), 3-Nitrophenylacetic acid (2.0 g; 11.0 mmol), HOBT (1.4 g; 11.0 mmol), EDCI (2.1 g; 11.0 mmol), and DIPEA (2.5 mL; 14.6 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 2.6 g (100%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 40 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (350 mg; 1.7 mmol), 2-Pyridylacetic acid hydrochloride (326 mg; 1.8 mmol), HOBT (253 mg; 1.8 mmol), EDCI (360 mg; 1.8 mmol) and DIPEA (0.644 mL; 3.7 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 400 mg (72%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 41 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (120 mg; 0.5 mmol), 3-Pyridylacetic acid hydrochloride (110 mg; 0.6 mmol), HOBT (85 mg; 0.6 mmol), EDCI (120 mg; 0.6 mmol), and DIPEA (0.280 mL; 1.5 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 6% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 142 mg (76%) of pure product which was treated with 11.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 42 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (200 mg; 0.9 mmol), ( ⁇ )-6-Methoxy- ⁇ -methyl-2-naphaleneacetic acid (217 mg; 1.0 mmol), HOBT (142 mg; 1.0 mmol), EDCI (201 mg; 1.0 mmol), and DIPEA (0.256 mL; 1.4 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 2% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 130 mg (33%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 43 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (200 mg; 0.9 mmol), ( ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇ -Trifluoro-m-tolyl) acetic acid (214 mg; 1.0 mmol), HOBT (142 mg; 1.0 mmol), EDCI (201 mg; 1.0 mmol), and DIPEA (0.256 mL; 1.4 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 6% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 250 mg (67%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 44 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (120 mg; 0.5 mmol), 4-Pyridylacetic acid hydrochloride (150 mg; 0.8 mmol), HOBT (117 mg; 0.8 mmol), EDCI (166 mg; 0.8 mmol), and DIPEA (0.202 mL; 1.1 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 172 mg (92%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 45 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (200 mg; 0.9 mmol), ( ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇ -Trifluoro-o-tolyl)acetic acid (239 mg; 1.1 mmol), HOBT (157 mg; 1.1 mmol), EDCI (223 mg; 1.1 mmol), and DIPEA (0.203 mL; 1.1 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 4% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 339 mg (82%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 46 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (200 mg; 0.9 mmol), (S)-( ⁇ )-4-Isobutyl- ⁇ -methylphenylacetic acid (217 mg; 1.0 mmol), HOBT (142 mg; 1.0 mmol), EDCI (201 mg; 1.0 mmol), and DIPEA (0.256 mL; 1.4 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 2% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 240 mg (66%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 47 as the HCl salt.
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (250 mg; 1.2 mmol), 3,4,5-Trimethoxyphenylacetic acid (304 mg; 1.3 mmol), HOBT (181 mg; 1.3 mmol), EDCI (256 mg; 1.3 mmol), and DIPEA (0.318 mL; 1.8 mmol).
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 500 mg (100%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 48 as the HCl salt.
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 4% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to give 100 mg (95%) of desired product which was treated with 1.0 M HCl to aford 3a as a tan solid.
  • the compound was prepared from 4-methylsulfonylphenyl acetic acid following the procedure described for 3d.
  • methyl sulfonamide ester (3.0 g, 12.34 mmol) was suspended in 3N aqueous HCl and heated to reflux with stirring for 24 h. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was re-dissolved in CH 2 Cl 2 , filtered, and concentrated to a small volume. Addition of either ether or hexane gave compound A in 80-95% yield and these acids were used in the condensation reactions.
  • the crude product was purified using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 10% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 1.6 g of a mixture of the 2 and 4 substituted sulfamide products.
  • the mixture was separated using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 2% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia on a chromatotran to afford 14 mg (0.5%) of the 2-substituted compound 3p and 20 mg (0.7%) of the 4-substituted compound 3r, which were converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether.
  • the reaction mixture was stirred at this temperature for 72 h, filtered and evaporated to dryness to give the crude product.
  • the compound was purified on a silica gel column [solvent system: CH 2 Cl 2 :CH 3 OH:28% NH 4 OH (99:1:2)] to give the free base of the desired product.
  • the hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl and recrystallized from CH 2 Cl 2 :ether (1:1) to give 3y (2.0 g, 60%); mp 165-167° C.
  • the compound 3z was prepared from 2-(2-amino-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide 1 following the above in 40% yield; mp 153-155° C.
  • the compound 3aa was prepared from 2-(2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide 1 following the above in 93% yield; mp 149-1511C; Anal. Calcd. for C 25 H 29 N 3 O 4 .0.5C 4 H 4 O 4 .H 2 O: C, 63.39; H, 6.50; N, 8.21. Found: C, 63.37; H, 6.20; N, 8.22.
  • Compound 3cc was prepared using the same procedure as described in the preparation of compound (2-N-Methylsulonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (for the preparation see U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955).
  • the compound 3ff was prepared from N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-((3S)-3-hydroxypyrrolidine-1-yl)ethyl]-2-aminophenylacetamide 2 and 4-trifluoromethylphenyl acetic acid in 54% yield; mp 217-219° C.
  • the compound 3jj was prepared from 9-anthracene carboxylic acid as above in 34% yield; mp 273-275° C.; 1 H NMR (200, MHz, CDCl 3 ) ⁇ 2.00 (m, 4H), 2.67 (s, 3H), 3.00 (m, 1H), 3.45 (m, 1H), 3.88 (m, 1H), 4.40 (m, 2H), 5.80 (m, 1H), 7.43 (m, 8H), 7.88 (m, 5H), 8.38 (s, 1H).
  • the reaction was quenched by adding saturated aqueous NaHCO 3 (20 ml) and stirred for 10 minutes. After separation, the organic layer was washed with water, brine, dried (Na 2 SO 4 ). The solvent was removed via rotary evaporation and the brown residue was purified by silica column chromatography [2% MeOH/CH 2 Cl 2 (2% NH 3 )] to give the product (2.4 g, 58%).
  • the compound was prepared from 3,4-dichlorocinnamic acid in 70% yield; mp 220-222° C.; Anal. Calcd. for C 22 H 24 Cl 2 N 2 O.HCl: C, 60.08; H, 5.73; N, 6.37. Found: C, 60.25; H, 5.81; N, 6.28.
  • the compound was prepared from 2-nitrocinnamic acid in 46% yield; mp 195-197° C.; Anal. Calcd. for C 22 H 25 N 3 O 3 .HCl: C, 63.53; H, 6.30; N, 10.10. Found: C, 63.25; H, 6.38; N, 10.08.
  • Compound 3bbb was prepared using the same general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure as described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955 with 2-fluorophenylacetic acid (415 mg; 2.69 mmol), HOBT (363 mg; 2.69 mmol), EDCI (514 mg; 2.69 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.63 mL; 3.66 mmol), and (1S) 1-[(2-methylamino-2-phenyl)ethyl]pyrrolidine (500 mg; 2.44 mmol) in 10 mL of dry methylene chloride at room temperature.
  • Compound 3ccc was prepared using the same general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955 with 4-fluorophenylacetic acid (415 mg; 2.69 mmol), HOBT (363 mg; 2.69 mmol), EDCI (514 mg; 2.69 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.63 mL; 3.66 mmol) and (1S) 1-[(2-methylamino-2-phenyl)ethyl]pyrrolidine (500 mg; 2.44 mmol) in 10 mL of dry methylene chloride at room temperature.
  • the racemic diamine (3) was prepared by a number of procedure reported in the literature. 10,11 Alternatively, the amine was also prepared from cyclohexene oxide (1) following the procedure described in Scheme I and the literature in 70% overall yield as brown oil. A sample was purified by the distillation (b.p. 75-82° C./1.0 mm, lit. 2 b.p.
  • the compound was prepared according to the literature method (DeCosata, B.; Linda, B.; Rothman, R. B.; Jacobson, A. E.; Bykov, V.; Pert, A.; Rice, K. E. FEBBS Lett.

Landscapes

  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)

Abstract

Compounds having kappa opioid agonist activity, compositions containing them and method of using them as analgesics are provided.
The compounds of formulae I, II, IIA, III, IIIA, IIIB, IIB-i, IV and IVA have the structure:
Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00001
Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00002
wherein
    • R1, R2, R3, R4; and
    • X, X4, X5, X7, X9; Y, Z and n are as described in the specification.

Description

  • This application is a continuation-in-part of application Ser. No. 09/478,482, filed Jan. 6, 2000, now allowed, which in turn is a divisional of application Ser. No. 09/150,369, filed Sep. 9, 1998, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,303,611, which in turn is a continuation-in-part of application Ser. No. 09/034,661 filed Mar. 3, 1998, now U.S. Pat. No. 5,945,443, which in turn is a divisional of application Ser. No. 08/899,086 filed on Jul. 23, 1997, now U.S. Pat. No. 5,744,458, which in turn is a divisional of application Ser. No. 08/796,078, filed on Feb. 5, 1997, now U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955, which in turn is a continuation-in-part of application Ser. No. 08/612,680, filed on Mar. 8, 1996, now U.S. Pat. No. 5,646,151. The disclosures of each of the foregoing applications is hereby incorporated herein by reference, in their entireties.
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • 1. Field of the Invention
  • This invention relates to compounds, to processes of their preparation, to pharmaceutical compositions containing them and to their medical use as agonists at kappa opioid receptors.
  • 2. Reported Developments
  • Opium and its derivatives are potent analgesics that also have other pharmacological effects, and exert their effects by interacting with high-affinity receptors.
  • It has been shown by investigators that there are at least three major opioid receptor types in the central nervous system (hereinafter CNS) and in the periphery. These receptors, known as mu (μ), delta (δ) and kappa (κ), have distinct pharmacological profiles, anatomical distributions and functions. [See, for example: Wood, P. L., Neuropharmacology, 21, 487497, 1982; Simon, E. J., Med. Res. Rev., 11, 357-374, 1991; Lutz et al, J. Recept. Res. 12, 267-286; and Mansour et al, Opioid I, ed. Herz, A. (Springer, Berlin) pp. 79-106, 1993.] The δ receptors are abundant in CNS and mediate analgesia, gastrointestinal motility and various hormonal functions. The μ receptors bind morphine-like drugs and mediate the opiate phenomena associated with morphine, including analgesia, opiate dependence, cardiovascular and respiratory functions, and several neuroendocrine effects.
  • The κ receptors have a wide distribution in CNS and mediate a spectrum of functions including the modulation of drinking, water balance, food intake, gut motility, temperature control and various endocrine functions. They also produce analgesia. [See, for example: Leander et al, J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 234, 463-469, 1985; Morley et al, Peptides 4, 797-800, 1983; Manzanares et al, Neuroendocrinology 52, 200-205, 1990; and Iyengar et al, J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther, 238, 429-436, 1986.]
  • Most clinically used opioid analgesics such as morphine and codeine act as J receptor agonists. These opioids have well-known, undesirable and potentially dangerous dependence forming side effects. Compounds which are κ-receptor agonists act as analgesics through interaction with κ opioid receptors. The advantage of these agonists over the classical μ receptor agonists, such as morphine, lies in their ability to cause analgesia while being devoid of morphine-like behavioral effects and addiction liability.
  • A large number of classes of compounds which act as agonists at κ opioid receptors have been described in the art including the following illustrative classes of compounds.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,065,573 discloses 4-amino-4-phenylcyclohexane ketal compounds having analgesic activity.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,212,878 discloses phenylacetamide derivatives having analgesic properties and reduced physical dependence liability properties, relative to morphine and methadone.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,145,435 discloses N-(2-amino-cycloaliphatic)-phenylacetamide compounds having analgesic activity and narcotic antagonist activity.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,098,904 discloses N-(2-amino-cycloaliphatic)-benzoamides and naphthamides useful for relieving pain.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,359,476 discloses substituted cycloalkane-amides useful as analgesic and having low abuse liability.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,438,130 discloses 1-oxa-, aza- and thia-spirocyclic compounds having analgesic activity, low physical dependence and abuse liability properties and little dysphoric inducing properties.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,663,343 discloses substituted naphthalenyloxy-1,2-diaminocyclohexyl amides as analgesics.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,906,655 discloses 1,2-cyclohexylaminoaryl amides having high kappa-opioid affinity, selectivity and potency and useful as analgesics, diuretics, anti-inflammatory and psychotherapeutic agents.
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • Compounds having kappa opioid agonist activity, compositions containing them and method of using them as analgesics are provided.
  • In its compound aspect, the present invention provides a compound of the formulae I, II, IIA, III, IIIA, IIIB, IIIB-i, IV and IVA, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • The compounds of formula (I) have the following structure:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00003

    wherein
      • n is an integer from 1 to 3, with 1 being preferred;
      • R1 and R2 are together —(CH2)m— where m is an integer from 4 to 8, with 4 being preferred; —CH2CH(OH)(CH2)2—; —CH2CH(F)(CH2)2—; —(CH2)2O(CH2)2—; or —(CH2)2CH═CHCH2—;
      • Ar is unsubstituted or mono- or di-substituted phenyl wherein said substituents are selected from the group consisting of halogen, OCH3, SO2CH3, CF3, amino, alkyl, and 3,4-dichloro; benzothiophenyl; benzofuranyl; naphthyl; diphenyl methyl; or 9-fluorene;
      • Z is —P(O)(OBn)2; —P(O)(OH)2; —(CH2)pC(O)NHOH; —(CH2)pCO2H; —SO2CH3; —SO2NH2; —CO(CH2)pCH(NH2)(CO2H); —COCH(NH2)(CH2)pCO2H; —CO2CH3; —CONH2; —(CH2)pO(CH2)pCO2H; —(CH2)pO(CH2)pCONHOH; —(CH2)pNHSO2CH3; —(CH2)pNHC(S)NHCH(CO2H)(CH2)pCO2H; —(CH2)pSO3H; or
        Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00004

        wherein
      • p is an integer from 0 to 20;
      • R3 is —H or -Ac;
      • X2 is —CO2H; —NHSO2CH3; NHP(O)(OBn)2; NHP(O)(OH)2; —OP(O)(OBn)2; or OP(O)(OH)2;
      • X and Y are independently —CH2NHSO2CH3, —CH2NHP(O)(OBn)2, —CH2NHP(O)(OH)2, —CH2OP(O)(OBn)2, —CH2OP(O)(OH)2, —(CH2)qO(CH2)qCO2H, —(CH2)qO(CH2)qSO3H, —(CH2)qO(CH2)2CHNHOH, —CH2NHC(S)NHCH(CO2H)(CH2)qCO2H or
        Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00005

        wherein
      • q is an integer from 1 to 20;
      • r is an integer from 1 to 20
      • R4 is —H or -Ac
      • X3 is —CO2H; —NHSO2CH3; —NHP(O)(OBn)2; —NHP(O)(OH)2; —OP(O)(OBn)2; or —OP(O)(OH)2.
  • The compounds of formula II have the following structure:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00006

    wherein
      • n is an integer from 1 to 3, with 1 being preferred;
      • R1 and R2 are together —(CH2)m—, where m is an integer from 4 to 8, with 4 being preferred; —CH2CH(OH)(CH2)2—; CH2CH(F)(CH2)2—; —(CH2)2O(CH2)2—; or —(CH2)2CH═CHCH2—;
      • Ar is unsubstituted or mono- or di-substituted phenyl wherein said substituents are selected from the group consisting of halogen, OCH3, SO2CH3, CF3, amino, alkyl, and 3,4-dichloro; benzothiophenyl; benzofuranyl; naphthyl; diphenyl methyl; or 9-fluorene;
      • X4 and X5 are independently —OP(O)(OBn)2; —OP(O)(OH); —CO2H; —SO3H; —O(CH2)sCO2H; —NHSO2CH3; —CONH(CH2)sCO2H; or —SO2NH(CH2)sCO2H; wherein s is an integer from 1 to 5
      • or X4 and X5 are independently
        Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00007

        wherein
      • t is an integer from 1 to 20
      • R5 is —H or -Ac
      • X6 is —CO2H; —NHSO2CH3; —NHP(O)(OBn)2; —NHP(O)(OH)2; —OP(O)(OBn)2; or —OP(O)(OH)2.
  • The compounds of formula IIA have the following structure:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00008

    wherein
      • n is an integer from 1 to 3, with 1 being preferred;
      • R1 and R2 are together (CH2)m, where m is an integer from 4 to 8, with 4 being preferred; —CH2CH(OR)(CH2)2— wherein R is H, alkyl, acyl or aroyl; CH2CH(F)(CH2)2—; —(CH2)2(CH2)2—; or —(CH2)2CH═CHCH2—;
      • Ar is unsubstituted or mono- or di-substituted phenyl; wherein said substituents are selected from the group consisting of halogen, OCH3, OH, SO2CH3, CF3, NH2, alkyl, CN, unsubstituted and substituted sulfamoyl groups;
      • Ar may also be substituted with —NH(CH2)uCO2R′; —NH(CH2)u(CH═CH)u(CH2)CO2R′; —NHCO(CH2)u(CH═CH)u(CH2)uCO2R′; —NHP(O)(OBn)2; —NHP(O)(OR′)2; —(CH2)uNHSO2CH3; —(CH2)uNHC(S)NHCH(CO2R′)(CH2)uCO2R′; —CONHOH; or —(CH2)uCONHOH;
        wherein
      • u is an integer from 0 to 5;
      • R′ is H or lower alkyl;
      • or Ar is
        Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00009
      • R6 is —H or -Ac
      • X6 is —CO2H; —NHSO2CH3; —NHP(O)(OBn)2; —NHP(O)(OH)2; —OP(O)(OBN)2; or —OP(O)(OH)2;
      • R7 is —NH(CH2)vCO2H; —NH(CH2)vCH(NH2)(CO2H); —NHCH(CO2H)(CH2)vNH2; —NH(CH2)vSO3H; —NH(CH2)vPO3H2; —NH(CH2)vNHC(NH)NH2; or —NHCH(CO2H)(CH2)vCO2H; and
      • v is an integer from 1 to 20.
  • X4 and X5 are independently H; halogen; OH; OCH3; CF3; NO2; NH2; amino substituted with acyl, carbamate, alkyl or aryl sulfonates; COR″ where R″ is OH, amino, alkoxy, aryloxy or heteroaryloxy.
  • Compounds of formula (IIA) have at least two chiral centers and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form. The invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • The compounds of formula III have the following structure:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00010

    wherein
      • n is an integer from 1 to 3, with 1 being preferred;
      • R1 and R2 are together —(CH2)m—, where m is an integer from 4 to 8, with 4 being preferred; —CH2CH(OH)(CH2)2—; CH2CH(F)(CH2)2—; —(CH2)2O(CH2)2—; or —(CH2)2CH═CHCH2—;
      • Ar is unsubstituted or mono- or di-substituted phenyl wherein said substituents are selected from the group consisting of halogen, OCH3, SO2CH3, CF3, amino, alkyl, and 3,4-dichloro; benzothiophenyl; benzofuranyl; naphthyl; diphenyl methyl; or 9-fluorene;
      • X7 is —NHSO2CH3; —NHP(O)(OBn)2; —NHP(O)(OH)2; —(CH2)uNHSO2CH3; —(CH2)uNHC(S)NHCH(CO2H)(CH2)uCO2H; —CONHOH; or —(CH2)uCONHOH; wherein u is an integer from 1 to 5
      • or X7 is
        Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00011
      • R6 is —H or -Ac
      • X8 is —CO2H; —NHSO2CH3; —NHP(O)(OBn)2; —NHP(O)(OH)2;
      • —OP(O)(OBn)2; or —OP(O)(OH)2;
      • R7 is —NH(CH2)vCO2H; —NH(CH2)vCH(NH2)(CO2H); —NHCH(CO2H)(CH2)vNH2; —NH(CH2)vSO3H; —NH(CH2)vPO3H2; —NH(CH2)vNHC(NH)NH2; —NHCH(CO2H)(CH2)vCO2H; and
      • v is an integer from 1 to 20
  • The compounds of formula IIIA have the following structure:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00012

    wherein
      • n is an integer from 1 to 3, with 1 being preferred;
      • R1 and R2 are together —(CH2)m—, where m is an integer from 4 to 8, with 4 being preferred; —CH2CH(OR)(CH2)2—, wherein R is H, alkyl, acyl or aroyl; CH2CH(F)(CH2)2—; —(CH2)2O(CH2)2—; or —(CH2)2CH═CHCH2;
      • Ar is unsubstituted or mono- or di-substituted phenyl; wherein said substituents are selected from the group consisting of halogen, OCH3, OH, SO2CH3, CF3, NH2, alkyl, CN, unsubstituted and substituted sulfamoyl groups;
      • Ar may also be substituted with —NH(CH2)uCO2R′; —NH(CH2)u(CH═CH)u(CH2)CO2R′; —NHCO(CH2)u(CH═CH)u(CH2)uCO2R; —NHP(O)(OBn) 2; —NHP(O)(OR)2; —(CH2)uNHSO2CH3; —(CH2)uNHC(S)NHCH(CO2R)(CH2)uCO2R′; —CONHOH; or —(CH2)uCONHOH;
        wherein
      • u is an integer from 0 to 5;
      • R′ is H or lower alkyl;
      • or Ar is
        Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00013
      • R6 is —H or -Ac
      • X8 is —CO2H; —NHSO2CH3; —NHP(O)(OBn)2; —NHP(O)(OH)2; —OP(O)(OBn)2; or —OP(O)(OH)2;
      • R7 is —NH(CH2)vCO2H; —NH(CH2)vCH(NH2)(CO2H); —NHCH(CO2H)(CH2)vNH2; —NH(CH2)vSO3H; —NH(CH2)vPO3H2; —NH(CH2)vNHC(NH)NH2; —NHCH(CO2H)(CH2)vCO2H; and
      • v is an integer from 1 to 20;
      • X7 is H; halogen; OH; OCH3; CF3; NO2; NH2; amino substituted with acyl, carbamate, alkyl or aryl sulfonates; COR″ where R″ is OH, amino, alkoxy, aryloxy or heteroaryloxy.
  • Compounds of formula (IIIA) have at least one chiral center and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form. The invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • The compounds of formula IIIB have the following structure:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00014

    wherein:
      • n is an integer from 1 to 3;
      • R1 and R2 are together alkylene of about 4 to about 8 carbons, optionally substituted with a group R′, where R′ is selected from —OH, halogen, —NRaRb, in which Ra and Rb are independently selected from hydrogen, —C(═O)Rc, —SO2Rd and —C(═O)(CH2)mCO2Re, in which Rc and Rd are independently selected from alkyl, aryl and heteroaryl, Re is hydrogen or alkyl and m is an integer from 1 to 3;
      • Ar is unsubstituted phenyl or mono-, di-, tri-, or tetra-substituted phenyl, wherein said substituents are independently selected from halogen; alkyl; alkoxy; aryloxy; aralkyloxy; alkylene dioxide; —OH; —SO2Rf in which Rf is alkyl or aryl; —CN; haloalkyl; —NRgRh, in which Rg and Rh are independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, —C(═O)Rf, —C(═O)—N(Re)2, —S(O)2Rf, and —(CH2)y—CO2Re in which y is an integer from 1 to 3; —S(O)2N(Ri)(Rj), in which Ri and Rj are each independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl optionally substituted with —CO2Re, aryl and aralkyl; or Ri and Rj together form —(CH2)2X(CH2)2—, where X is a direct bond, —CH2—, —NRe—, S or O;
      • R is hydrogen, halogen, —OH, alkoxy, or —NRkRl, where Rk and Rl are independently selected from hydrogen and alkyl.
  • Compounds of formula (IIIB) have at least one chiral center and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form. The invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • The compounds of formula IIIB-i have the following structure.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00015

    wherein:
      • x is an integer from 0 to 4;
      • R″ is hydrogen, fluoro, —OH, —NHC(═O)Rc, —NHSO2Rd and —NHC(═O)(CH2)mCO2Re, in which Rc and Rd are independently selected from alkyl, aryl and heteroaryl, Re is hydrogen or alkyl and m is an integer from 1 to 3
      • R3 is independently selected from halogen; alkyl; alkoxy; aryloxy; aralkyloxy; alkylene dioxide; —OH; —SO2Rf in which Rf is alkyl or aryl; —CN; haloalkyl; —NRgRh, in which Rg and Rh are independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, —C(═O)Rf, —C(═O)—N(Re)2, —S(O)2Rf in which Rf is alkyl or aryl, and —(CH2)y—CO2Re in which y is an integer from 1 to 3; —S(O)2N(Ri)(Rj), in which Ri and Rj are each independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl optionally substituted with —CO2Re, aryl and aralkyl; or Ri and Rj together form —(CH2)2X(CH2)2—, where X is a direct bond, —CH2—, —NRe—, S or O;
      • R is hydrogen, halogen, —OH, alkoxy, or —NRkRl, where Rk and Rl are independently selected from hydrogen and alkyl.
  • Compounds of formula (IIIB-i) have at least one chiral center and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form. The invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • The compounds of formula IV have the following structure:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00016

    wherein
      • n is an integer from 1 to 3, with 1 being preferred;
      • R1 and R2 are together —(CH2)m—, where m is an integer from 4 to 8, with 4 being preferred; —CH2CH(OH)(CH2)2—; CH2CH(F)(CH2)2—; —(CH2)2O(CH2)2—; or —(CH2)2CH═CHCH2—;
      • R3 and R4 are independently H; OCH3; alkyl; or C—O(CH2)2;
      • X9 represents 1 to 4 substituents selected from the group consisting of -halogen; —CF3; —OCH3; —SO2NH(CH2)qCO2H; —CONH(CH2)qCO2H; —NH2; —NHSO2CH3; —NHP(O)(OBn)2; —NHP(O)(OH)2; —SO2CH3; —OP(O)(OBN)2; —OP(O)(OH)2; —CO2H; —O(CH2)qCO2H; —O(CH2)qSO3H; —O(CH2)qOPO3H2; wherein q is 1 to 20;
      • or X9 is
        Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00017

        wherein
      • t is an integer from 1 to 20
      • R5 is —H or -Ac
      • X6 is —CO2H; —NHSO2CH3; —NHP(O)(OBn)2; —NHP(O)(OH)2; —OP(O)(OBn)2; or —OP(O)(OH)2.
  • Compounds of formula (IV) have at least one chiral center and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form. The invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • The compunds of formula IVA have the following structure:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00018

    wherein
      • n is an integer from 1 to 3, with 1 being preferred;
      • R1 and R2 are together —(CH2)m—, where m is an integer from 4 to 8, with 4 being preferred; —CH2CH(OR)(CH2)2—; wherein R is H, alkyl, acyl, or aroyl; CH2CH(F)(CH2)2—; —(CH2)2O(CH2)2—; or —(CH2)2CH═CHCH2—;
      • R3 and R4 are independently H; OCH3; alkyl; or —O(CH2)2;
      • X9 represents 1 to 4 substituents selected from the groups consisting of -halogen; —CF3; OH, —OCH3; —SO2NH(CH2)qCH3; —NH(CH2)qCOR′; —NH(CH2)q(CH═CH)q(CH2)qCO2R′; —NH(CH)q(CH≡CH)q(CH)qCO2R; —NHCO(CH2)q(CH═CH)q(CH2)qCO2R; and —NHCO(CH)q(CH═CH)q(CH)qCO2R′
        wherein
      • q is an integer from 0 to 20
      • R′ is OH, lower alkyl, aryl ester or aryl amide.
  • Compounds of formula (IVA) have at least one chiral center and may exist in more than one diastereoisomeric form. The invention includes within its scope all enantiomers, and diastereosomers and the mixtures thereof.
  • The meaning of the terms used in the specification and the claims, unless otherwise denoted, are as follows.
  • The term “alkyl” as used herein alone or as part of another group, denotes optionally substituted, straight and branched chain saturated hydrocarbon groups, preferably having 1 to 12 carbons in the normal chain, most preferably lower alkyl groups. Exemplary unsubstituted alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, t-butyl, isobutyl, pentyl, hexyl, isohexyl, 4,4-dimethylpentyl, octyl, 2,2,4-trimethylpentyl, nonyl, decyl, undecyl, dodecyl and the like. Exemplary substituents include one or more of the following groups: halo, alkoxy, arylalkyloxy (e.g., benzyloxy), alkylthio, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, hydroxy, carboxyl (—COOH), amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, formyl, alkylcarbonyloxy, alkylcarbonyl, heterocyclo, aryloxy, hydroxy or thiol (—SH).
  • The term “lower alkyl” as used herein denotes such optionally substituted groups as described above for alkyl having 1 to 4 carbon atoms in the normal chain.
  • The terms “ar” or “aryl” as used herein or as part of another group, denote optionally substituted, homocyclic aromatic groups, preferably containing 1 or 2 rings and 6 to 12 ring carbons. Exemplary unsubstituted groups include phenyl, biphenyl and naphthyl. Exemplary substituents include one or more, preferably three or fewer, nitro groups, alkyl groups as described above, and/or one or more groups described above as alkyl substituents. Preferred aryl groups are unsubstituted aryl and hydroxyaryl.
  • The term “aralkyl” as used herein alone or as part of another group, denotes an aryl-alkyl-group wherein aryl and alkyl are as described previously. Exemplary aralkyl groups include benzyl, phenethyl and naphthylmethyl.
  • The terms “heterocyclo” or “heterocyclic” as used herein alone or as part of another group, denote optionally substituted fully saturated or unsaturated, aromatic or non-aromatic cyclic groups having at least one heteroatom in at least one ring, preferably monocyclic or bicyclic groups having 5 or 6 atoms in each ring. Aromatic heterocyclo or heterocyclic groups are also referred to herein as “heteroaryl” groups. The heterocyclo group may, for example, have 1 or 2 oxygen atoms, 1 or 2 sulfur atoms, and/or 1 to 4 nitrogen atoms in the ring. Each heterocyclo group may be bonded through any carbon or heteroatom off the ring system. Preferred groups include those of the following formula, which may be bonded through any atom of the ring system:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00019
      • wherein r is 0 or 1 and T is —O—, —S—, —N—R8 or —CH—R8 where R8 is hydrogen, alkyl, aryl or arylalkyl. Exemplary heterocyclo groups include the following: thienyl, furyl, pyrrolyl, pyridyl, imidazolyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, azepinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, benzothiazolyl, benzoxazolyl, benzimidazolyl, morpholinyl, piperazinyl, 4-alkylpiperazinyl, 4-alkylpiperidinyl, 3-alkpyrrolidinyl, oxazolyl, pyrazolyl, thiophenyl, pyridazinyl, thiazolyl, triazoyl, pyrimidinyl, 1,4-dioxanyl, benzoxadiazolyl, and benzofurazanyl. Exemplary substituents include one or more alkyl groups as described above and/or one or more groups described above as alkyl substituents.
  • The terms “halogen” or “halo” as used herein alone or as part of another group, denote chlorine, bromine, fluorine and iodine.
  • The term “acyl”, as used herein alone or as part of another group, denotes the moiety formed by removal of the hydroxyl group from the group —COOH of an organic carboxylic acid. Exemplary groups include alkylcarbonyl, arylcarbonyl, or carbocyclo- or heterocyclocarbonyl. The term “acyloxy”, as used herein alone or as part of another group denotes an acyl group as described above bonded through an oxygen linkage (—O—).
  • The term “alkoxy”, as used herein, alone or as part of another group, denotes an alkyl-O group wherein alkyl is as described previously. Exemplary alkoxy groups include methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, i-propoxy, n-butoxy, pentoxy and heptoxy.
  • The term “aryloxy”, as used herein, alone or as part of another group, denotes an aryl-O group wherein aryl is as described previously. Exemplary aryloxy groups include phenoxy and naphthoxy.
  • The term “aralkyloxy”, as used herein, alone or as part of another group, denotes an aralkyl-O group wherein aralkyl is as described previously. An exemplary aralkyloxy group is benzyloxy.
  • The term “alkylene”, as used herein, alone or as part of another group, denotes a straight or branched bivalent hydrocarbon chain group having from about 1 to 8 carbons. Exemplary alkylene groups include methylene (—CH2—), ethylene (—CH2CH2—), propylene (—CH2CH2CH2—) and butylene (—CH2CH2CH2CH2—).
  • The term “alkylene dioxide”, as used herein, alone or as part of another group, denotes a —O-alkylene-O— group wherein alkylene is as described previously. Exemplary alkylene dioxide groups include methylene dioxide (—O—CH2—O—) and ethylene dioxide (—O—CH2CH2—O—).
  • In the formulas described herein, it is intended that when any symbol appears more than once in a particular formula or substituent, its meaning in each instance is independent of the other.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION
  • Peripherally-acting κ agonists can be prepared by the attachment of polar groups to non-peptide κ opioid receptor selective agonists, such as the arylacetamides. In designing the peripherally-acting ligands, the introduction of the polar groups may result in either retention or enhancement of antinociceptive potency and selectivity and also may increase the polarity of the ligand sufficient to reduce or eliminate CNS penetration across the blood-brain barrier (BBB). Thus, the identity and the positioning of the polar group(s) are important.
  • Using the prototypic arylacetamide, U50,488, as an example, the arylacetamide pharmacophore can be divided into three regions: the aromatic region, the central region, and the amine region. All three regions represent potential positions for the attachment of polar groups.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00020
  • Compounds of formula (I) of the present invention are made as follows.
  • A series of novel compounds were made based on the class of arylacetamides reported by Glaxo (J. Med. Chem. 1993, 36, 2075). Specifcally, compound 1 can be deprotected to yield intermediate 2, which can be derivatized by the attachment of a variety of polar groups (Scheme 1).
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00021
  • The 3′-substituted series can be prepared via Scheme 2. The reduction of the Schiff base intermediate formed during the cyclization to 6 is expected to be stereoselective due to the directing effect of the neighboring hydroxymethyl group. Both intermediates 11 and 12 can be derivatized to confer peripheral selectivity.
  • The 5′-substituted series can be prepared via Schemes 3 and 4. Starting from N-t-Boc-O-MEM-D-serine, the 5′-(S) series can be prepared, and starting from from N-t-Boc-O-MEM-L-serine allows the preparation of the 5′-(R) series.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00022
      • wherein Ar, R1, R2, and n are defined in formula I.
        Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00023
      • wherein Ar1, R1, R2 and n are as defined in formula I.
        Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00024
      • wherein Ar1, R1, R2 and n are as defined in formula I.
        Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00025
      • wherein Ar, R1, R2 and n are defined in formula I.
  • Using Schemes 1-4 the following example compounds are made.
  • Intermediate 3 can be treated with t-butyl bromoacetate and deprotected to produce {4-[1-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)acetyl-2R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]piperazinyl}acetic acid (26).
  • Intermediate 3 can be reacted with methane sulfonyl chloride to produce [1-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)acetyl-4-methanesulfonyl-2R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine (27).
  • Intermediate 3 can be coupled to N-t-Boc-L-aspartic acid-b-benzyl ester and deprotected to produce [4-S-Aspartic acid-α-amido-1-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl-2R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine (28).
  • Intermediate 11 can be treated with t-butyl bromoacetate and deprotected to produce Methyl-[2R-(O-2-acetic acid)hydroxymethyl-4-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl-3R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate (29).
  • Intermediate 11 can be coupled to to N-t-Boc-L-aspartic acid-b-benzyl ester and deprotected to produce Methyl-[2R-(O-S-aspartic acid-α-acetyl)hydroxymethyl-4-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl-3R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate (30).
  • Intermediate 12 can be treated with methanesulfonyl chloride to produce Methyl-[4-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl-2R-(N-methanesulfonamido)aminomethyl-3R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl)-1-piperazinecarboxylate (31).
  • Intermediate 12 can be coupled to 2S-isothiocyanato-succinic acid-dibenzyl ester and deprotected to yield Methyl-{4-[3,4-dichlorophenyl]acetyl-3R-[1-pyrrolidinyl]methyl-2R-[N-(succinic acid-2S-thioureido)]aminomethyl}-1-piperazinecarboxylate (32).
  • Intermediate 21 can be treated with t-butyl bromoacetate and deprotected to produce Methyl-[2S-(O-2-acetic acid)hydroxymethyl-4-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl-5R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate (33).
  • Intermediate 21 can be coupled to to N-t-Boc-L-aspartic acid-b-benzyl ester and deprotected to produce Methyl-[2S-(O-S-aspartic acid-α-acetyl)hydroxymethyl-4-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl-5R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate (34).
  • Intermediate 22 can be treated with methanesulfonyl chloride to produce Methyl-[4-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl-2S-(N-methanesulfonamido)aminomethyl-5R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate (35).
  • Intermediate 22 can be coupled to 2S-isothiocyanato-succinic acid-dibenzyl ester and deprotected to yield Methyl-{4-[3,4-dichlorophenyl]acetyl-5R-[1-pyrrolidinyl]methyl-2S-[N-(succinic acid-2S-thioureido)]aminomethyl}-1-piperazinecarboxylate (36).
  • The 2R isomers of 33-34 and 35-36 can be prepared from intermediates 24 and 25, respectively to produce
    • Methyl-[2R-(O-2-acetic acid)hydroxymethyl-4-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl-5R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate (37).
    • Methyl-[2R-(O-S-aspartic acid-a-acetyl)hydroxymethyl-4-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl-5R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate (38).
    • Methyl-[4-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl-2R-(N-methanesulfonamido)aminomethyl-5R-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate (39).
    • Methyl-{4-[3,4-dichlorophenyl]acetyl-5R-[1-pyrrolidinyl]methyl-2R-[N-(succinic acid-2S-thioureido)]aminomethyl}-1-piperazinecarboxylate (40).
  • The corresponding structural formulas are shown hereunder.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00026
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00027
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00028
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00029
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00030
  • Compound of formula II of the present invention are made by peripheralization by substitutions of the benzo portion of the tetrahydronaphthyl ring of DuPont series of compounds with polar groups.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00031
  • Starting material or precursors of the starting material are commercially available and thus allows regiospecific substitutions of the tetrahydronaphthyl ring (Scheme 5). While 5-hydroxytetralone, 6-hydroxytetralone, 7-hydroxytetralone, and 7-aminotetralone derivatives are readily available, 5-aminotetralone could be prepared from 5-hydroxytetralone (J. Org. Chem. 1972, 37, 3570).
  • The tetralone derivatives can be converted to dihydronaphthyl derivatives and subjected to chemistry similar to that employed in the preparation of U50,488 derivatives. The resulting compounds are racemic mixtures that can be derivatized to confer peripheral selectivity. If necessary, the final compounds or one of the intermediates can be resolved to test both enantiomers.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00032
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00033
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00034
      • wherein R1, R2, and n are as defined in formula I.
  • Following the procedure shown in Schemes 5-7, the following example compounds are prepared.
  • Intermediate (±)-64 can be treated with t-butyl bromoacetate and deprotected to produce (±)-2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-1-[1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-5-(O-2-acetic acid)-hydroxy-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)naphthyl]acetamide (72).
  • Intermediate (±)-65 can be treated with t-butyl bromoacetate and deprotected to produce (±)-2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-1-[1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-7-(O-2-acetic acid)-hydroxy-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)naphthyl]acetamide (73).
  • Intermediate (±)-66 can be treated with methanesulfonyl chloride to produce (±)-2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-1-[1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-7-(N-methanesulfonamido)-amino-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)naphthyl]acetamide (74).
  • Intermediate (±)-67 can be treated with methanesulfonyl chloride to produce (±)-2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-1-[1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-5-(N-methanesulfonamido)-amino-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)naphthyl]acetamide (75).
  • Intermediate (±)-68 can be treated with glycine benzyl ester and deprotected to produce (±)-2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-1-[1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-5-(N-2-acetic acid)-carboxamido-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)naphthyl]acetamide (76).
  • Intermediate (±)-69 can be treated with glycine benzyl ester and deprotected to produce (±)-2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-1-[1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-5-(N-2-acetic acid)-sulfonamido-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)naphthyl]acetamide (77).
  • Intermediate (±)-70 can be treated with glycine benzyl ester and deprotected to produce (±)-2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-1-[1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-7-(N-2-acetic acid)-carboxamido-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)naphthyl]acetamide (78).
  • Intermediate (±)-71 can be treated with glycine benzyl ester and deprotected to produce (±)-2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-1-[1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-7-(N-2-acetic acid)-sulfonamido-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)naphthyl]acetamide (79).
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00035
  • The compounds of formula III of the present invention are prepared by substituting the central phenyl ring with polar groups.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00036

    wherein Ar, R1, R2, X7, and n are defined as in formula III.
  • Compound 80 and analogues undergo a variety of diazonium-involving reactions for the attachment of polar groups (Scheme 7).
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00037
  • Using the procedure shown in Scheme 7, the following compounds are made.
  • Intermediate 81 can be treated with dibenzyl phosphoryl chloride followed by deprotection to produce 2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{1-3-(O-phosphoryl)hydroxyphenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide (87).
  • Intermediate 85 can be coupled to methanesulfonyl chloride to produce 2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{1-[3-(N-methanesulfonamido)aminomethyl]phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide (88).
  • Intermediate 85 can be coupled to 2S-isothiocyanato succinic acid and deprotected to produce 2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{1-[3-(N-succinic acid-2S-thioureido)aminomethyl]phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide (89).
  • Intermediate 80 can be treated with dibenzyl phosphoryl chloride followed by deprotection to produce 2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{1-3-(N-phosphoramido)aminophenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide (90).
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00038
  • The compounds of formula IV may be prepared by Scheme 8.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00039
      • wherein R1, R2, R3, and R4 are defined in formulas III and IV.
  • The diamino intermediate 91 (J. Med. Chem. 1990, 33, 286) can be coupled to different regioisomers of nitrophenylacetic acid, which are all commercially available. Reduction of the nitro group provides an amino group for the attachment of polar groups. Alternatively, the amino intermediates 95-97 readily undergo diazonium chemistry that converts the amino groups to carboxyl and sulfonyl chloride groups. This allows the polar groups to be attached via different linkers.
  • Following the procedure in Scheme 8, the following compounds are made.
  • Intermediate 96 can be treated with methanesulfonyl chloride to produce (−)-(5α,7α,8β)-N-methyl-N-[7-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-1-oxaspiro-[4,5]dec-8-yl]-3-(N-methanesulfonamido)aminophenylacetamide (104).
  • Intermediate 98 can be coupled to glycine benzyl ester and deprotected to yield (−)-(5α,7α,8β)-N-methyl-N-[7-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-1-oxaspiro-[4,5]dec-8-yl]-3-(N-2-acetic acid)sulfonamidophenylacetamide (105).
  • Intermediate 99 can be coupled to glycine benzyl ester and deprotected to yield (−)-(5α,7α,8β)-N-methyl-N-[7-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-1-oxaspiro-[4,5]dec-8-yl]-3-(N-2-acetic acid)carboxamidophenylacetamide (106).
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00040
  • Compounds of the above formulas may have one or more asymmetric carbon atoms. Pure sterochemically isomeric forms of the above compounds may be obtained, and diastereoisomers isolated by physical separation methods, including, but not limited to crystallization and chromatographic methods. Cis and trans diasteriomeric racemates may be further resolved into their isomers. If separated, active isomers may be identified by their activity. Such purification is not, however, necessary for preparation of the compositions or practice of the methods herein.
  • As used herein, the compounds provided herein also include pharmaceutically acceptable salts, acids and esters thereof, stereoisomers, and also metabolites or prodrugs thereof that possess activity as analgesics but do not cause substantial CNS effects when administered or applied. Metabolites include any compound that is produced upon administration of the compound and metabolism thereof.
  • More detailed preparations of the compounds of the present invention follow.
  • Compounds of Formula I
  • Preparatory for the compounds of formula I, the following intermediates were prepared.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00041
  • N-Benzyl-D-serine (1)1: To a mixture of D-serine (25.0 g, 0.237 mol) and 200 mL anhydrous methanol was added sodium cyanoborohydride (11.95 g, 0.190 mol), while maintaining the temperature at 0° C. with an ice bath. Then, benzaldehyde (26.5 mL, 0.261 mol) was added to the reaction flask, dropwise, at 30° C. The mixture was stirred for 60 Hr. at room temperature. Then, the mixture was filtered and rinsed with methanol (50 mL). The white solid was dried in a vacuum oven at 40° C. and 10 mmHg over 2 nights: 24.5 g. The filtrate was retained and the solvent was evaporated. This oil was passed through a silica gel column (10% MeOH/CH2Cl2) and 3.4 g of the desired compound was isolated. The total amount of the product was 27.9 g (60.0% yield). 1H NMR (DMSO-d6) δ 3.25 (m, 1H, CH), 3.85 (m, 2H, CH2), 4.11 (d, 2H, benzylic CH2), 7.45-7.53 (m, 5H, ArH).
  • Ref.
    • (1) Ohfune, Y.; Kurokawa, N.; Higuichi, N.; Saito, M.; Hashimoto, M.; Tanaka, T. An efficient one-step reductive N-monoalkyation of α-amino acids. Chemistry Letters. 1984, 441-444.
  • N-Benzyl-D-serine methyl ester (2): Hydrogen chloride (gas) was bubbled into anhydrous methanol for 10 minutes. Then, the solution was allowed to cool to room temperature. Then, N-benzyl-D-serine (24.6 gm, 0.126 mol) was added to the reaction flask and refluxed over night under dry nitrogen. Then, the solvent was evaporated and dissolved in dichloromethane (200 mL), and washed with a saturated solution of sodium bicarbonate. The dichloromethane layer was dried with magnesium sulfate and the solvent was evaporated. (23 gm, 87.2% yield). 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 3.41 (d, 1H, CH), 3.52-3.80 (dd, 2H, benzylic), 3.69 (s, 3H, OMe), 7.27 (s, 5H, ArH).
  • N-[(1,1-Dimethylethoxy)carbonyl-D-Ser-(O-Bzl)-N-benzyl-D-Ser-OMe (3): To a solution of N-boc-D-serine-(O-bzl)OH (15 g, 50.76 mmol) in anhydryous dichloromethane (200 mL) was added HOBt (7.54 g, 55.8 mmol) at 0° C. under dry nitrogen. Then, DCC (11.5 g, 55.7 mmol) in dichloromethane (100 mL) was added dropwise to the reaction flask. Then, this mixture was stirred for 1 Hr. Then, N-benzyl-D-serine-OMe (10 g, 47.8 mmol) in dichloromethane (100 mL) was added dropwise to the reaction flask. Then, stirred for 4 days. Then, filtered and rinsed with dichloromethane (100 ml). The white precipitate was DCU and HOBt. The filtrate was evaporated and re-dissolved in ethyl acetate (100 mL). Then, this was allowed to precipitate, overnight—more DCU. This was filtered and rinsed with ethyl acetate. Then, this was isolated on a silica gel column (20% ethyl acetate/hexanes): an oil—17.3 g, 74.3% yield. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 1.43 (s, 9H, t-Bu), 3.54 (t, 1H, OH), 3.72 (s, 3H, OMe), 3.75 (dd, 2H, CH2) 3.79 (dd, 2H, CH2), 4.41 (d, 2H, CH2 benzylic), 4.43 (d, 2H, CH2 benzylic), 7.27-7.30 (m, 10H, ArH).
  • (2R,5R)-2-((Benzyloxy)methyl)-5-(Hydroxymethyl)-4-(phenylmethyl)-3,6-piperazine dione (4)2:
  • Into anhydrous chloroform (300 mL) was bubbled hydrogen chloride (gas). Then, the dipeptide (3) (13.5 g, 27.7 mmol) in chloroform (100 ml) was added to the reaction flask. The flask was stoppered and stirred for 64 Hr. Then, a saturated solution (100 ml) of sodium bicarbonate was added and stirred vigorously for 48 Hr. The cyclization was completed at this point. The organic layer was separated from the aqueous layer in a 1 L separatory funnel. The product was isolated from a silica gel column, eluting with dichloromethane-methanol-0.88 ammonia (96:2:2) to give (4) as an amorphous solid (6.0 g, 61.1% yield). 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 3.72-3.96 (m, 7H), 3.97-5.24 (dd, 2H, CH2 benzylic), 4.45 (dd, 2H, CH2 benzylic), 7.15-7.30 (m, 10H, ArH); MS (FAB) m/e 355 (MH+).
  • Ref.
    • (2) Williams, T. M.; Ciccarone, T. M.; MacTough, S. C. and et al. 2-Substituted piperazines as constrained amino acids. J. Med. Chem. 1996, 39, 1345-1348.
  • (2S,5S)-2-((Benzyloxy)methyl)-4-(phenylmethyl)-5-piperazinemethanol (5): A suspension of lithium aluminum hydride (0.9 g, 23.7 mmol) in anhydrous tetrahydrofuran (40 mL) was treated with a solution of piperazinedione 4 (2.1 g, 5.92 mmol) in anhydrous tetrahydrofuran (200 mL). The reaction mixture was heated at reflux for 24 Hr and then, stirred at room temperature for 12 Hr. Water (10 ml) was added followed by aqueous sodium hydroxide (1N, 10 mL) and water (10 mL). The mixture was filtered, and the filtrate was evaporated to give 5 (1.67 g, 86.4% yield) as a viscous oil. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 2.58 (dd, 2H, CH2), 2.61 (t, 1H, OH), 3.10 (dd, 2H, CH2), 3.25 (dd, 2H, CH2), 3.50 (dd, 2H, CH2), 3.74 (s, 2H, CH2), 4.41 (dd, 2H, CH2 benzylic), 7.20-7.30 (m, 10H, ArH).
  • (2S,5S)-Methyl 2-[(Benzyloxy)methyl]-5-(hydroxymethyl)-4-(phenylmethyl)-1-piperazine carboxylate (6)3: A solution of 5 (1.67 g, 5.11 mmol.) in acetonitrile (20 mL) was treated with a solution of methyl chloroformate (0.532 g, 5.63 mmol) in acetonitrile (10 mL) at 0° C. The mixture was stirred at ambient temperature for 30 min., and then aqueous sodium carbonate solution (15 mL) was added. The organic solvent was removed, and the aqueous residue was extracted with chloroform (3×10 mL). The combined organic extracts were washed with aqueous sodium carbonate solution (10 mL), dried, and evaporated to give 6 (1.52 g, 77.3% yield) as an oil. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 2.54 (dd, 2H, CH2), 2.45 (t, 1H, OH), 2.72 (dd, 2H, CH2), 3.51 (dd, 2H, CH2), 3.67 (dd, 2H, CH2), 3.69 (s, 3H, OMe), 3.81 (dd, 2H, CH2), 4.44 (dd, 2H, CH2 benzylic), 7.17-7.31 (10H, ArH).
  • (2S,5S)-Methyl 2-[(Benzyloxy)methyl]-5-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-4-(phenylmethyl)-1-piperazinecarboxylate (7)3: A solution of oxalyl chloride (0.545 mL, 6.24 mmol) in dichloromethane (10 mL) at −65° C. was treated with a solution of dimethyl sulfoxide (1.14 mL, 16.0 mmol) in dichloromethane (5 ml) maintaining the reaction temperature below −65° C. The mixture was stirred at −70° C. for 10 min, and then a solution of the piperazinemethanol (6: 2 g, 5.19 mmol) in dichloromethane (20 mL) was added at such a rate that the reaction temperature was maintained below −65° C. The reaction mixture was stirred at −65° C. for 3 Hr, and a solution of N-methylmorpholine (1.42 mL, 12.91 mmol) in dichloromethane (5 mL) was added. The mixture was stirred at −20° C. for 45 min and then washed with ice-cold hydrochloric acid (0.01 N. 100 mL and 50 mL), dried, evaporated, and placed on a high vacuum pump overnight. The residue was dissolved in methanol (10 mL) and was added to a solution of pyrrolidine (0.91 mL, 10.94 mmol) in methanol (10 mL) at −10° C., which had been adjusted to pH 6.0 by the addition of methanolic hydrogen chloride. Sodium cyanoborohydride (0.67 g, 10.66 mmol) and 4-Å molecular sieves (0.66 g) were added, and the mixture was stirred at ambient temperature for 18 Hr. The mixture was filtered, and the filtrate was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in aqueous sodium carbonate (1M, 25 mL) and extracted with dichloromethane (2×50 mL). The product was isolated from a silica gel column, eluting with dichloromethane-methanol (98:2) to give (7: 1.0 g, 23.0% yield). 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 1.75 (m, 4H, CH2CH2), 2.46 (m, 3H), 2.48 (m, 4H, CH2CH2), 2.55 (dd, 2H, CH2), 2.70-2.85 (m, 3H), 3.41 (dd, 2H, CH2), 3.69 (s, 3H, OMe), 4.10 (m, 1H), 4.20 (m, 1H), 4.41 (dd, 2H, CH2 benzylic), 7.10-7.31 (m, 10H, ArH), MS (FAB) m/e 438 (MH+).
    • (3) Naylor, A.; Judd, D. B.; Lloyd, J. E.; Scopes, D. I. C.; Hayes, A. G.; Birch, P. J. A potent new class of k-Receptor agonist: 4-subtituted 1-(arylacetyl)-2-[(dialkylamino)methyl]piperazines. J. Med. Chem. 1993, 36, 2075-2083.
  • (2S,5S)-Methyl 2-(Hydroxymethyl)-5-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazine carboxylate (8): A solution of 7 (0.25 g, 0.571 mmol) in ethanol (200 mL) was hydrogenated over 10% palladium on carbon (Degussa type E101 NE/W) at 50 psi for 7 days. Then, filtered through celite and filtrate was evaporated. (0.13 g, 0.5 mmol: 87% yield).
  • (2S,5S)-Methyl 4-[(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(hydroxy)methyl-5-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate (9): To a solution of 1,1′-carbonyldiimiazole (0.20 g, 1.26 mmol) in dichloromethane (10 mL) was added portionwise 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.25 g, 1.26 mmol) and the resulting solution stirred under nitrogen for 1 Hr, at room temperature. A solution of 8 (0.13 g, 0.5 mmol) in dichloromethane (10 mL) was added and the mixture at room temperature for 18 Hr. The reaction mixture was washed with sodium carbonate solution (2 N, 2×10 mL), dried, and evaporated to give a viscous oil. This material was dissolved in a mixture of tetrahydrofuran (5 mL) and water (5 mL) and treated with lithium hydroxide (42 mg, 1.0 mmol). The reaction mixture was removed, and the aqueous residue was extracted with dichloromethane (3×10 mL). The combined organic extracts were dried and evaporated to give a colorless gum which was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel, eluting with ethyl acetate-methanol (40:1) to give 9 (155 mg, 70%) as a colorless foam.
  • Utilizing the above-denoted intermediates, the following compounds were prepared.
  • Chiral Compounds
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00042
  • EXAMPLE 1 (R)-4-(Phenylmethyl)-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride [(R)-1 HCl]
  • The compound (R)-1 HCl was prepared following the literature procedure3 in 54% yield; mp 168-170° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.65 (4H, m), 1.95-3.00 (6H, m), 3.10-3.80 (9H, m), 4.35 (1H, m), 4.70 (1H, m), 7.00 (1H, m), 7.30 (7H, m); MS (FAB) 448 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C24H29Cl2N30.2HCl.H2O: C, 53.64; H, 6.19; N, 7.82. Found: C, 53.69; H, 5.88; N, 7.49.
  • EXAMPLE 2 (R)-1-[(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride [(R)-2HCl]
  • The compound was prepared by the catalytic hydrogenation of (R)-1 HCl following the procedure described in the above reference. The product was isolated as a free base as clear oil in 81% yield and the dihydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.67 (4H, m), 1.95-3.10 (6H, m), 3.10-3.80 (7H, m), 4.30 (1H, m), 4.65 (1H, m), 7.05 (1H, m), 7.35 (3H, m); MS (FAB) 356 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 3 (R)-4-Methanesulfonyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-piperazine hydrochloride [(R)-3a HCl]
  • To the solution of (R)-2 (712 mg, 2 mmol in 10 ml CH2Cl2), methanesulfonyl chloride (573 mg, 5 mmol) and pyridine (1 ml) were added at 0° C., stirred overnight at that temperature, the solution was washed with aq. 5% K2CO3 solution, extracted with dichloromethane, dried and evaporated solvent to give crude oil. This material was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel, eluting with dichloromethane-methanol-ammonia (100:5:1), to give the free base, which was dissolved into 2 ml of dichloromethane and HCl (3 ml, 1 M in Et2O) was added to afford a white salt (R)-3a HCl (600 mg, 69%): mp 130-132° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.61-1.85 (4H, m), 2.38-2.65 (6H, m), 2.72 (3H, s), 2.80-3.06 (2H, m), 3.15-3.36 (1H, m), 3.50-3.96 (4H, m), 4.484.93 (1H, m), 7.00-7.10 (1H, m), 7.25-7.40 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 434 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C18H25Cl2N3O3S.HCl.0.5 CH3OH.: C, 45.64; H, 5.59; N, 8.63. Found: C, 45.69; H, 5.58; N, 8.73.
  • EXAMPLE 4 (R)-4-t-Butyl-acetyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-piperazine [(R)-3b]
  • To the solution of (R)-2 (356 mg, 1 mmol in 10 ml acetone), t-butyl bromoacetate (234 mg, 1.2 mmol) and K2CO3 (207 mg, 1.5 mmol) were added at 0° C., stirred overnight at that temperature, the solution was washed with aq. 5% K2CO3 solution, extracted with dichloromethane, dried and evaporated solvent to give crude oil. This material was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel, eluting with dichloromethane-methanol-ammonia (100:5:1), to give (R)-3b (329 mg, 70%): 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.36 (9H, s), 1.91-2.37 (7H, m), 2.65-3.13 (7H, m), 3.584.20 (6H, m), 5.00 (1H, m), 7.12-7.21 (2H, m), 7.40 (1H, m). The compound was used directly into the following reaction.
  • EXAMPLE 5 (R)-4-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazineacetic acid dihydrochloride [(R)-3c 2HCl]
  • Compound (R)-3b (329 mg, 0.7 mmol) was dissolved into 5 ml THF/Et2O (1:1), and HCl (5 ml, 1 M in Et2O) was added, kept 12 hrs to afford a white salt (R)-3c HCl (275 mg, 61%): mp 190° C. (d). 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.85-2.20 (4H, m), 2.95-4.41 (17H, m), 5.18-5.35 (1H, m), 7.30-7.45 (1H, m), 7.56-7.72 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 414 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C19H25Cl2N3O3.2HCl.0.5H2O.: C, 45.16; H, 5.78; N, 8.32. Found: C, 44.91; H, 5.88; N, 8.56.
  • EXAMPLE 6 (R)-4-N-t-Boc-D-aspartic acid-β-benzyl ester-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-piperazine [(R)-3d]
  • To the solution of N-t-Boc-D-aspartic acid-β-benzyl ester (646 mg, 2 mmol) and HOBt (270 mg, 2 mmol in 10 ml CH2Cl2), DCC (413 mg, 2 mmol) was added at 0° C., stirred 1 h at that temperature, (R)-2 (356 mg, 1 mmol in 10 ml CH2Cl2) was added, stirred 24 hrs at room temperature, the solution was washed with aq. 5% K2CO3 solution, extracted with dichloromethane, dried and evaporated solvent to give crude oil. This material was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel, eluting with dichloromethane-methanol-ammonia (100:1:1), to give (R)-3d (628 mg, 95%), 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.35 (9H, s), 1.70-1.87 (4H, m), 2.32-3.16 (6H, m), 3.354.46 (6H, m), 4.80-5.68 (6H, m), 7.07-7.45 (8H, m). The compound was used directly into the reaction below.
  • EXAMPLE 7 (R)-4-Aspartic acid-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-piperazine dihydrochloride [(R)-3e 2HCl]
  • The compound (R)-3d was dissolved into 1 ml of HOAc, and HCl (1 ml, 2N) was added, standing 20 min, then hydrogenated at 1 atm., 10% Pd on carbon at room temperature for 1 h to afford a white salt (R)-3e (430 mg, 91.5%): mp 168° C. (d). 1H NMR (DMSO-d6) δ 1.92-2.16 (4H, m), 2.75-5.28 (18H, m), 2.72 (3H, s), 7.31-7.52 (3H, m), 8.45-8.80 (3H, m); MS (FAB) 471 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C21H28Cl2N4O4.2HCl: C, 46.34; H, 5.18; N, 10.29. Found: C, 45.52; H, 6.02; N, 9.73.
  • EXAMPLE 8 (R)-4-Acetyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-piperazine hydrochloride [(R)-3f HCl]
  • The compound was prepared as reported in the literature (J. Med. Chem. 1993, 36, 2075-2083) from (R)-2. the hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl to afford (R)-3f HCl in 88% yield; mp 153-155° C.; MS (FAB) 398 (M+H)+. Anal. Calcd for C19H25Cl2N3O2.HCl.H2O: C, 52.49; H, 6.03; N, 9.66. Found: C, 50.40; H, 6.23; N, 9.28.
  • EXAMPLE 9 (R)-4-(Diethoxyphosphonate)-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrolidinyl)methyl]-piperazine hydrochloride [(R)-3g HCl]
  • To a solution of (R)-2 (0.178 g, 0.5 mmol) in 10 mL of CH2Cl2 was added Et3N (0.101 g, 1.0 mmol) and diethylchlorophosphonate (0.174 g, 1.0 mmol) under a nitrogen atmosphere. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 13 h and then poured over aqueous 10% K2CO3. The organic layer was separated, dried over anhydrous Na2SO4, and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure to give the compound as a yellow oil. The oil was purified on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH, 95:5:2) and converted to hydrochloride salt by usual method to give (R)-3g HCl, 0.10 g (38%); mp 168-170° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.20 (6H, t, J=7.0 Hz), 1.64 (4H, m), 2.30-2.70 (6H, m), 2.85-3.15 (1H, m), 3.45-3.80 (4H, m), 3.60 (2H, brs), 3.98 (4H, m), 4.35 (1H, m), 4.70 (1H, m), 7.00 (1H, m), 7.30 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 492, 494 (M+H)+. Anal. Calcd for C21H32Cl2N3O4P.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 46.90; H, 6.37; N, 7.81. Found: C, 46.66; H, 5.90; N, 8.16.
  • EXAMPLE 10 (R)-4-Trifluoroacetyl-1-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-piperazine hydrochloride [(R)-3h HCl]
  • To a solution of (R)-2 (0.356 g, 1.0 mmol) in 10 mL of CH2Cl2 was added Et3N (0.202 g, 2.0 mmol) and trifluoroacetic anhydride (0.42 g, 2.0 mmol) in a nitrogen atmosphere. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 12 h and TLC showed staring material was still present, added another equivalent of trifluoroacetic anhydride and stirring was continued for additional 12 h. The reaction was worked up as above and the hydrochloride salt was prepared as usual to give (R)-3h HCl, 0.25 g (50%); mp 145-147° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.60 (4H, m), 2.20-2.75 (6H, m), 3.10 (1H, m), 3.45-3.80 (4H, m), 4.00 (1H, J=14.0 Hz, d), 4.25 (1H, m), 4.45 (1H, J=14.0 Hz, d), 4.70 (1H, m), 7.00 (1H, m), 7.28 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 452, 454 (M+H)+. Anal. Calcd for C19H22Cl2F3N3O2.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 45.85; H, 4.86; N, 8.44. Found: C, 46.26; H, 4.82; N, 8.33.
  • EXAMPLE 11 (R)-4-[(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxamide hydrochloride [(R)-3i HCl]
  • To a solution of (R)-2 (0.356 g, 1.0 mmol) in acetic acid (0.186 g, 3.0 mmol) and water was added KOCN (0.244 g, 3.0 mmol) and the reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 72 h. An aqueous 10% K2CO3 was added to the reaction mixture to bring the pH to near 12.0 and the product was extracted with CH2Cl2, washed with saturated salt solution, dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. The removal of solvent at reduced oressure gave the crude product which was purified on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH, 95:5:1) to give the desired product as a white solid. The hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etheial HCl to give (R)-3i HCl as a white solid, 0.15 g (31%); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.65 (4H, m), 2.10-3.20 (6H, m), 3.40-3.70 (4H, m), 3.95 (2H, m), 4.20 (2H, J=14.0 Hz, d, m), 4.70 (1H, m), 5.35 (2H, bs), 7.00 (1H, m), 7.25 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 399, 401 (M+H)+. Anal. Calcd for C18H24Cl2N4O2.HCl.H2O.0.125 CH2Cl2: C, 46.88; H, 5.91; N, 12.06. Found: C, 46.66; H, 5.50; N, 11.97.
  • EXAMPLE 12 (R)-4-[(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxaldehyde hydrochloride [(R)-3j HCl]
  • To a solution of (R)-2 (0.356 g, 1.0 mmol) in 10 mL of CH2Cl2 was added 1.0 mL of methylformate (excess) at 0° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere. The reaction mixture was stirred for 24 h and solvent was removed at reduced pressure to give the crude product. The compound was purified on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH, 95:5:1) and converted to the hydrochloride salt, (R)-3j HCl, 0.10 g (23%); mp 126° C. (d); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.62 (4H, m), 2.10-3.20 (6H, m), 3.35-3.85 (5H, m), 4.25 (3H, m), 4.60 (1H, m), 7.00 (1H, m), 7.26 (2H, m), 7.90 (1H, s); MS (FAB) 384, 386 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 13 (R)-4-[(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazine-sulfonamide hydrochloride [(R)-3k HCl]
  • To a solution of (R)-2 (0.356 g, 1.0 mmol) in 5 mL of p-dixane was added sulfamide4 (NH2SO2NH2, 0.96 g, 10 mmol) under a nitrogen atmosphere and the reaction mixture was heated to reflux for 2 h. The reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure and the residue was redissolved in CH2Cl2 and washed with aqueous 10% K2CO3, saturated salt solution, and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. The removal of solvent resulted the free base of the product which was purified on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH, 98:2:1). The hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl to give (R)-3k HCl, 0.10 g (21%); mp 183-185° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.68 (4H, m), 2.30-3.00 (6H, m), 3.15-4.00 (5H, m), 4.15-4.65 (3H, m), 4.85 (1H, m), 7.00 (1H, m), 7.31 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 435 (M+H)+. Anal. Calcd for C17H24Cl2N4O3S.HCl: C, 43.28; H, 5.34; N, 11.87. Found: C, 42.90; H, 5.35; N, 11.43.
  • Ref.
    • (4) Alker, D. et. al. J. Med. Chem. 1990, 33, 585.
    EXAMPLE 14 (R)-4-(4-Methyphenylsulfonyl)-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-Pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-piperazine hydrochloride [(R)-3l HCl]
  • To a solution of (R)-2 (0.356 g, 1.0 mmol) in 5 mL of CH2Cl2 was added p-toluenesulfonyl chloride (0.38 g, 2 mmol) followed by 0.5 mL of pyridine under a nitrogen atmosphere. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 16 h and then poured onto aqueous 10% K2CO3. The organic layer was separated and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. The removal of solvent gave the product which was purified on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH, 98:2:1). The hydrochloride salt was prepared to give (R)-3l HCl, 0.15 g (27%); mp 240° C. (d); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.65 (4H, m), 1.95-3.00 (6H, m), 2.38 (3H, s), 3.15-3.85 (5H, m), 4.45 (1H, m), 4.75 (1H, m), 6.95 (1H, m), 7.25 (4H, m), 7.50 (2H, J=8.0 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 510 (M+H)+. Anal. Calcd for C24H29Cl2N3O3S.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 52.32; H, 5.35; N, 7.63. Found: C, 52.23; H, 5.50; N, 7.51.
  • Racemic Compounds
  • Racemic compounds were prepared as illustrated by the following steps.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00043

    (R,S)-2-[(1-Pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride [(R,S)-4 HCl]
  • The compound was prepared following the literature procedure1 and isolated as hydrochloride salt.
  • (R,S)-4-(R═SO2CH3, CO2CH3, COCH3)-2-[(1-Pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride [(R,S)-5, 6, 7]
  • These compounds were also prepared according to the procedures described in the literature1 and each of the products were purified as free base before utilizing below.
  • EXAMPLE 15 (R,S)-4-Methanesulfonyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-piperazine hydrochloride [(R,S)-8a HCl] (General Procedure)
  • 1,1′-Carbonyldiimidazole (0.324 g, 2.0 mmol) was added to a stirred solution of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.41 g, 2.0 mmol) in 10 mL of CH2Cl2 at room temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere, and the resulting solution was continued stirring for additional 1 h. The resulting solution was then added to a stirred solution of (R,S)-5 (0.247 g, 1.0 mmol) in 10 mL of CH2Cl2 at 0° C. and the reaction mixture was stirred for further 20 h. The reaction mixture was diluted with CH2Cl2 and washed with aqueous 2M Na2CO3. The organic layer was dried and evaporated to dryness and the product was purified on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH, 98:2:1). The hydrochloride salt was prepared by redissolving the compound in CH2Cl2 and treating the solution with 1M etherial HCl to give (R,S)-8a HCl as a white solid, 0.20 g (32%); NMR (see R-3a); MS (FAB) 434 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C18H25Cl2N3O3S.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 45.13; H, 5.51; N, 8.77. Found: C, 45.46; H, 5.36; N. 8.71.
  • The following compounds were similarly prepared from (R,S)-5, 6, and 7:
  • EXAMPLE 16 (R,S)-4-Methanesulfonyl-1-[(4-methylsulfonylphenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]piperazine hydrochloride [(R,S)-8b HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid and the hydrochloride salt was recrystallized from CH3OH to give (R,S)-8b HCl in 60% yield; mp 185-188° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.65 (4H, m), 2.30-2.70 (6H, m), 2.80 (3H, s), 2.85-3.10 (3H, m), 3.00 (2H, m), 3.25 (1H, m), 3.50-3.95 (4H, m), 4.50 (1H, m), 4.80 (1H, m)), 7.40 (2H, J=7.5 Hz, d), 7.80 (2H, J=7.5 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 444 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C19H29N3O5S2.HCl: C, 47.54; H, 6.30; N, 8.75. Found: C, 46.03; H, 6.24; N, 8.80.
  • EXAMPLE 17 (R,S)-4-Methanesulfonyl-1-[(2-nitrophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]piperazine hydrochloride [(R,S)-8c HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 2-nitrophenylacetic acid in 65% yield as hydrochloride salt; mp 253-255° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.70 (4H, m), 2.40-3.10 (6H, m), 2.75 (3H, s), 3.45 (1H, m), 3.70-4.00 (4H, m), 4.054.30 (2H, m), 4.50 (1H, m), 4.72 (1H, m), 7.45 (3H, m), 8.05 (1H, J=8.0 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 411 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C18H26N4O5S.HCl: C, 48.37; H, 6.09; N, 12.54. Found: C, 48.36; H, 5.66; N, 12.29.
  • EXAMPLE 18 (R,S)-4-Methanesulfonyl-1-[(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]piperazine hydrochloride [(R,S)-8d HCl]
  • The compound was prepared as a hydrochloride salt from 4-trifluorometylphenylacetic acid in 82% yield; 182-185° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.65 (4H, m), 2.35-3.05 (6H, m), 2.71 (3H, s), 3.25 (1H, m), 3.50-3.95 (5H, m), 4.55 (1H, m), 4.85 (1H, m), 7.30 (2H, m), 7.50 (2H, J=7.8 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 434 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C19H26F3N3O3S.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 47.65; H, 5.89; N, 8.77. Found: C, 48.36; H, 5.80; N, 8.51.
  • EXAMPLE 19 (R,S)-4-Methanesulfonyl-1-[(3-indolylacetyl-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]piperazine hydrochloride [(R,S)-8e HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 3-indoleacetic acid and isolated as free base in 40% yield and converted to hydrochloride salt; mp 219-221° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.65 (4H, m), 2.10-3.00 (6H, m), 2.55 (3H, S), 3.10-3.45 (2H, m), 3.45-3.90 (4H, m), 4.05 (1H, m), 4.55 (1H, m), 4.90 (1H, m), 7.05 (3H, m), 7.25 (1H, m), 7.50 (1H, m), 8.95 (1H, bs); MS (FAB) 405 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C20H28N4O3S.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 58.09; H, 7.07; N, 13.55. Found: C, 58.37; H, 6.68; N, 13.30.
  • EXAMPLE 20 (R,S)-Methyl 4-[(4-methylsulfonylphenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride [(R,S)-9a HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid and the hydrochloride was prepared from 1M etherial HCl to give (R,S)-9a HCl in 46% yield; mp 225° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.60 (4H, m), 2.15-2.95 (6H, m), 2.98 (3H, s), 3.15 (2H, m), 3.35 (3H, m), 3.60 (3H, s), 3.95 (2H, m), 4.30 (1H, m), 4.72 (1H, m), 7.45 (2H, m), 7.75 (2H, J=7.5 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 424 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C20H29N3O5S.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 51.72; H, 6.62; N, 9.05. Found: C, 51.93; H, 6.47; N, 8.44.
  • EXAMPLE 21 (R,S)-Methyl 4-[(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride [(R,S)-9b HCl]
  • The compound was prepared as a hydrochloride salt from 4-trifluorometylphenylacetic acid to give (R,S)-9b HCl in 48%; mp 210° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.50 (4H, m), 1.95-2.30 (6H, m), 2.35-3.50 (4H, m), 3.65 (3H, S), 3.70-4.50 (5H, m), 7.45 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 414 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C20H26F3N3O3.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 52.86; H, 6.10; N, 9.25. Found: C, 53.03; H, 5.94; N, 8.94.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00044
  • Another minor product (R,S)-11) was isolated as a hydrochloride salt from this reaction in 10% yield; mp 190° C.; MS (FAB) 446 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 22 (R,S)-Methyl 4-[(3-indolyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]-1-piperazine-carboxylate hydrochloride [(R,S)-9c HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 3-indoleacetic acid and the hydrochloride salt was prepared to give (R,S)-9c HCl in 75% yield; mp 143° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.55 (4H, m), 1.90-2.52 (6H, m), 2.70-3.75 (9H, m), 3.35 (3H, S), 6.60 (2H, m), 6.85 (2H, m), 7.20 (1H, s), 7.65 (1H, brs); MS (FAB) 385 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 23 (R,S)-Methyl 4-[(2-nitrophenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-Pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]-1-piperazine-carboxylate hydrochloride [(R,S)-9d HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 2-nitrophenyacetic acid and hydrochloride was prepared from 1M etherial HCl to give (R,S)-9d HCl in 42% yield; mp 228° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.60 (4H, brs), 1.80-2.30 (4H, m), 2.70 (2H, m), 3.05 (2H, m), 3.60 (3H, s), 3.55-4.10 (4H, m), 4.35 (2H, J=14.0 Hz, dd), 5.10 (1H, m), 7.50 (3H, m), 8.05 (1H, J=7.5 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 391 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C19H26N4O5.HCl: C, 53.46; H, 6.37; N, 13.12. Found: C, 54.29; H, 6.38; N, 12.58.
  • EXAMPLE 24 (R,S)-Methyl 4-[(2-methoxyphenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolinyl)-methyl]-1-piperazine-carboxylate hydrochloride [(R,S)-9e HCl]
  • The compound was prepared as above from 2-methoxyphenylacetic acid to give (R,S)-9e HCl in 12% yield; mp 120° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 M, CDCl3) δ 1.65 (4H, m), 2.25-2.95 (6H, m), 3.10 (1H, m), 3.304.10 (5H, m), 3.60 (3H, s), 3.70 (3H, s), 4.40 (1H, m), 4.70 (1H, m), 6.84 (2H, m), 7.15 (3H, m); MS (FAB) 376 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C20H129N3O4.HCl.H2O: C, 55.87; H, 7.50; N, 9.77. Found: C, 55.78; H, 6.97; N, 9.42.
  • EXAMPLE 25 (R,S)-Methyl 4-[(2-aminophenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]-1-piperazine-carboxylate dihydrochloride [(R,S)-9f 2HCl]
  • The compound was prepared by the hydrogenation of (R,S)-9e HCl on 10% Pd/C following the procedure described in the literature1. The compound, (R,S)-9f 2HCl, was isolated as dihydrochloride in 84% yield; mp 195° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 2.00 (4H, m), 3.05-4.45 (16H, m), 3.75 (3H, s), 5.00 (1H, m), 7.45 (4H, brs); MS (FAB) 361 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C19H28N4O3.2HCl.H2O: C, 50.56; H, 7.15; N, 12.41. Found: C, 50.36; H, 7.26; N, 12.05.
  • EXAMPLE 26 (R,S)-4-Acetyl-1-[(4-methylsulfonylphenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]-piperazine hydrochloride [(R,S)-10a HCl]
  • The compound was prepared as above from 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid and the hydrochloride salt was prepared in usual fashion to give (R,S)-10a HCl in 45% yield; mp 145-147° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.90 (4H, m), 2.17 (3H, s), 2.65-3.80 (6H, m). 3.32 (3H, s), 3.854.45 (8H, m), 5.05 (1H, m), 7.65 (2H, J=8.0 Hz, d), 7.95 (2H, J=8.0 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 408 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 27 (R,S)-4-Acetyl-1-(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride [(R,S)-10b HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 4-trifluorometylphenylacetic acid and isolated as hydrochloride salt, (R,S)-10b HCl, in 30% yield; mp 110° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 2.00 (4H, m), 2.15 (3H, s), 2.70-3.25 (6H, m), 3.504.45 (8H, m), 5.05 (1H, m), 7.70 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 398 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 28 (R,S)-4-Acetyl-1-[(2-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride [(R,S)-10c HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 2-trifluorometylphenylacetic acid and the hydrochloride salt was made from 1M etherial HCl to give (R,S)-10c HCl in 57%; 220° C. (d); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.65 (4H, m), 2.05 (3H, s), 2.25-3.25 (6H, m), 3.40-4.10 (6H, m), 4.50 (2H, m), 4.70 (1H, m), 7.30 (2H, m), 7.60 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 398 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 29 (R,S)-4-Acetyl-1-[(3-nitrophenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]piperazine-carboxylate hydrochloride [(R,S)-10d HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 3-nitrophenylacetic acid and the hydrochloride salt, (R,S)-10d HCl was isolated as a white solid in 69% yield; mp 143-145° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.63 (4H, brs), 2.05 (3H, s), 2.20-2.80 (6H, m), 2.90-3.25 (2H, m), 3.50-3.90 (3H, m), 4.00 (1H, J=14.0 Hz, d), 4.45 (2H, m), 4.65 (1H, m), 7.45 (2H, m), 8.00 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 375 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C19H26N4O4.HCl.H2O: C, 53.21; H, 6.81; N, 13.06. Found: C, 53.51; H, 6.13; N, 12.91.
  • EXAMPLE 30 (R,S)-4-Acetyl-1-[(2-nitrophenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]piperazine-carboxylate hydrochloride [(R,S)-10e HCl]
  • The compound was prepared as above from 2-nitrophenylacetic acid to give (R,S)-10e HCl as white solid in 50% yield; mp 180° C. (d); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.63 (4H, m), 2.04 (3H, s), 2.20-2.85 (6H, m), 2.98-3.35 (3H, m), 3.604.25 (4H, m), 4.60 (2H, m), 7.35 (3H, m), 8.00 (1H, J=7.0 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 375 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C19H26N4O4.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 55.54; H, 6.62; N, 13.64. Found: C, 54.38; H, 6.35; N, 13.58.
  • EXAMPLE 31 (R,S)-4-Acetyl-1-[(4-nitrophenyl)acetyl]-3-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]piperazine-carboxylate hydrochloride [(R,S)-10f HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 2-nitrophenylacetic acid as before to give (R,S)-10f HCl in 52% yield; 146-148° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.68 (4H, m), 2.07 (3H, s), 2.20-2.75 (6H, m), 3.40-3.90 (3H, m), 4.05 (1H, J=13.5 Hz, d), 4.50 (2H, m), 7.35 (2H, J=8.0 Hz, d), 8.10 (2H, J=8.0 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 375 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C19H26N4O4.HCl.0.5H2O.0.125CH2Cl2: C, 53.36; 6.61; 13.01. Found: C, 53.16; H, 6.27; N, 13.36.
  • EXAMPLE 32 (R,S)-4-(Phenylmethyl)-1-[(4,5,-dichloro-2-nitrophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine dihydrochloride [(R,S)-12 2HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 4-phenylmethyl-2[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine (Ref. 1) and 4,5-dichloro-2-nitrophenylacetic acid following the method described above to give (R,S)-12 2HCl in 63% yield; mp 235° C. (d); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.66 (4H, m), 2.05-3.00 (8H, m), 3.45 (4H, m), 4.00 (5H, m), 4.60 (1H, m), 7.35 (6H, m), 8.15 (1H, s); MS (FAB) 493 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C24H29Cl2N4O3.2HCl: C, 50.99; 5.53; 9.91. Found: C, 50.55; H, 5.16; N, 9.44.
  • The preparation of compounds of formula IA (compounds 1a through 1qq) follow according to Schemes A, B, C, D, E and F.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00045
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00046
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00047
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00048
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00049
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00050
  • EXAMPLE 1a Methyl-4-[-2-glycyl-4-(trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate
  • Methyl-4-[(2-nitro-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate1 (Procedure A) (a): To a solution of 2-nitro-4-trifluorophenylacetic acid (2.8 g, 11.2 mmol) in 30 mL of dry CH2Cl2 under a nitrogen atmosphere was added HOBt (1.3 g., 9.6 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred at 0° C. and added solid EDCI (2.25 g, 11.75 mmol). Then, stirred for 30 minutes at 0° C. A solution of methyl-3-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate1 (2.0 g, 8.78 mmol) in 5 mL of dry CH2Cl2 was added followed by DIEA (1.68 mL, 9.64 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred for 24 h while warming to room temperature. The reaction mixture was then poured into water (50 mL) and stirred for 30 minutes. After dilution with CH2Cl2, the organic layer was separated, washed with saturated NaHCO3, salt solution, and water. Then, dried over Mg2SO4. The compound was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel, eluting with CH2Cl2:CH3OH: (98:2) to give the desired product as a free base (3.15 g, 78% yield). Then, proceed on to the next step. 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.76 (4H, m), 2.65 (4H, m), 3.02 (2H, m), 3.74 (s, 3H), 4.21 (4H, m), 7.56 (dd, J=2.4, 8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.85 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 8.4 (d, J=2.4 Hz, 1H); MS (FAB) m/z 459.
  • Methyl-4-[(2-amino-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(1pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride (b): Compound a (1.18 gm, 2.57 mmol) was dissolved in ethanol (50 mL) and heated to 55° C. Hydrazine hydrate (0.9 mL, 28.12 mmol) and 1 scoop of Raney Nickel was added to the reaction flask. Stir vigorously. Continue to add the Raney Nickel until all of the hydrazine is consumed (when the bubbling has stopped). Cool to 30° C. and filter through celite and wash with hot methanol. (Do not allow the Raney nickel to become dry!). Evaporate the solvent and generate an HCl salt (1.0 gm; 90.6%); m.p. 160-165° C. 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.76 (4H, m), 2.5-3.1 (7H, m), 3.74 (3H, s), 4.15 (2H, m), 4.55 (2H, m), 6.90 (1H, J=2.4 Hz, d), 6.95 (1H, J=2.4, 8.0 Hz, dd), 7.15 (1H, J=8.0 Hz, d). MS (FAB) m/z 429. Anal. Calc. For C20H27N4F3O3.HCl.H2O: C, 49.69; H, 6.21; N, 11.60. Found: C, 49.57; H, 6.04; N, 11.32.
  • To a solution of bromoacetic acid (0.356 g, 2.56 mmol.) and DIEA (1.0 mL, 5.74 mmol.) in CH3CN (15 mL) was added compound b and heated to 55° C. for 16 hr. Then, heated to 75° C. for 4 hr. The reaction was complete. Evaporate the solvent and re-dissolve in ethanol (25.0 mL). Add 0.1 M Na2CO3 (20 mL) and filter and wash with boiling ethanol (15 mL). Evaporate the filtrate and dissolve in isopropanol (10 mL). Add diethyl ether (5.0 mL) until precipitate forms. Filtered. A white solid is obtained (m.p. 165-170° C.; 0.3 g, 24.8% yield). 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) d 2.19 (4H, m), 2.95 (4H, m), 3.2-3.7 (4H, m), 3.74 (3H, s), 3.8-4.2 (4H, m), 4.7 (1H, m), 5.2 (1H, m), 6.86 (1H, J=2.4 Hz, d), 7.0 (2H, J=8.0 Hz, d). MS (FAB) m/z 487. Anal. Calc. For C22H29N4F3O5.0.5 C2H6O. 0.5H2O: C, 53.28; H, 6.37; N, 10.81. Found: C, 53.50; H, 6.25; N, 10.51.
  • EXAMPLE 1b Methyl-4-[(2-[N,N-bis-methylsulfonamido]-4-trifluoromethyphenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)-methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate dihydrochloride
  • To a solution of compound b (0.4 g, 0.933 mmol.) and triethylamine (0.26 mL, 1.86 mmol.) in CH2Cl2(10.0 mL) at 0° C. was added methanesulfonyl chloride (0.144 mL, 1.86 mmol.). The reaction was stirred for 16 hr. The reaction was diluted with CH2Cl2(40.0 mL), washed with saturated NaHCO3 solution and water. Then, dried over Mg2SO4. Then, isolated on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (98:2:2) to give the desired product as a free base (0.4 g, 73%). Evaporate the solvent and generate an HCl salt (0.14 gm; m.p. 155-160° C.). 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.76 (4H, m), 2.75-3.31 (11H, m), 3.47 (3H, s), 3.50 (3H, s), 3.72 (3H, s), 3.8-4.3 (5H, m), 4.55 (1H, m), 4.95 (1H, m), 7.5-7.9 (3H, Ar). MS (FAB) m/z 585. Anal. Calc. For C22H31N4F3O7S2.2HCl: C, 42.54; H, 5.19; N, 9.02. Found: C, 42.58; H, 5.23; N, 8.91.
  • EXAMPLE 1c Methyl-4-[(2-[N-methylsulfonamido]phenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • Methyl-4-[(2-nitro-phenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate (c): The compound was prepared from 2-nitro-phenylacetic acid following Procedure A and isolated on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (99:1:2) to give the desired product as a free base (3.15 g, 78%). Then, proceed on to the next step. 1H NMR (free base 300 MHz, CDCl3) d 1.75 (4H, m), 2.53 (4H, m), 3.02 (2H, m), 3.74 (s, 3H), 4.21 (4H, m), 7.4 (1H, ArH, m) 7.56 (1H, J=1.2 Hz, d), 7.61 (1H, J=1.2, 7.4 Hz, dd), 8.11 (1H, J=8.0 Hz, d).
  • Methyl-4-[(2-amino-phenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate (d): Then, compound c was dissolved in ethanol (200 mL) and Pd/C (Degussa; 10%; 3.0 g) were added into a Parr bottle (500 mL). Then, the bottle was attached to a Parr Shaker Hydrogenator at 50 psi for 6 hr. The reaction was complete. This was filtered through celite. Evaporate the solvent and proceed on to the final step.
  • Then, to a solution of the above compound d (0.15 g, 0.33 mmol.) and triethylamine (0.10 mL, 0.66 mmol.) in CH2Cl2 (10.0 mL) at 0° C. was added methanesulfonyl chloride (0.026 mL, 0.33 mmol.). The reaction was stirred for 16 hr. The reaction was diluted with CH2Cl2 (20.0 mL), washed with saturated NaHCO3 solution and water. Then, dried over Mg2SO4. Then, isolated on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH2Cl2: CH3OH:28% NOH (98:2:2) to give the desired product as a free base (0.1 g, 68%). Evaporate the solvent and generate an HCl salt (0.06 gm; m.p. 130-135° C.). 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.75 (4H, m), 2.2 (1H, m), 2.5-3.1 (6H, m), 3.01 (3H, s), 3.50 (2H, m), 3.73 (3H, s), 3.8-4.5 (5H, m), 5.02 (1H, m), 6.88-7.55 (3H, Ar). MS (FAB) m/z 439. Anal. Calc. For C20H30N4O5S2.HCl: C, 50.57; H, 6.58; N, 11.79. Found: C, 50.55; H, 6.64; N, 11.36.
  • EXAMPLE 1d Methyl-4-[(2-[N,N-bis-methylsulfonamido]phenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • To a solution of the compound d (0.70 g, 1.94 mmol.) and triethylamine (0.44 mL, 3.19 mmol.) in CH2Cl2(10.0 mL) at 0° C. was added methanesulfonyl chloride (0.247 mL, 3.19 mmol.). The reaction was stirred for 16 hr. The reaction was diluted with CH2Cl2 (20.0 mL), washed with saturated NaHCO3 solution and water. Then, dried over Mg2SO4. Then, isolated on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (98:2:2) to give the desired product as a free base (0.7 g, 70%). Evaporate the solvent and generate an HCl salt (0.75 g; m.p. 145-150° C.). 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.76 (4H, m), 2.2 (1H, m), 2.5-3.1 (6H, m), 3.44 (3H, s), 3.49 (3H, s), 3.71 (3H, s), 3.8-4.5 (5H, m), 4.50 (1H, m), 4.89 (1H, m), 7.23-7.75 (3H, Ar). MS (FAB) m/z 517. Anal. Calc. For C21H32N4O7S2.HCl: C, 46.05; H, 6.22; N, 10.09. Found: C, 45.60; H, 6.01; N, 10.13.
  • EXAMPLE 1e Methyl-4-[(2-[N-methylamino)sulfamyl]phenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • The compound Was prepared from (N-methylamino)sulfamyl phenyl acetic acid (a mixture of the ortho and para isomer) following Procedure A and isolated on a silica gel column [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (99:2:1): Rf=0.56] to give the desired product as a free base (0.70 g, 70%). Then, generate the HCl salt (m.p. 155-160° C.; 0.31 g). 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.75 (m, 4H), 2.53 (m, 4H), 2.66 (d, J=5.2 Hz, 3H), 2.82 (m, 3H), 3.25 (m, 1H), 3.72 (s, 3H), 3.84 (m, 2H), 4.15 (m, 2H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 4.85 (m, 1H), 7.45 (dd, J=4.0, 8.2 Hz, 2H) 7.79 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.83 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H); MS (FAB) m/z 439. Anal. Calc. For C20H30N4O5S.HCl: C, 50.13; H, 6.61; N, 11.36. Found: C, 50.57; H, 6.58; N, 11.79.
  • EXAMPLE 1f Methyl-4-[-4-[N-methylamino)sulfamyl]phenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • The compound was isolated from the above reaction on a silica gel column [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (99:1:2): Rf=0.62] to give the desired product as a free base. Then, generate the HCl salt (m.p. 135-140° C.; 6.0 mg). 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.74 (m, 4H), 2.53 (m, 4H), 2.66 (d, J=5.2 Hz, 3H), 2.82 (m, 3H), 3.25 (m, 1H), 3.71 (s, 3H), 3.84 (m, 2H), 4.15 (m, 2H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 4.85 (m, 1H), 7.48 (m, 2H, ArH) 7.73 (m, 2H, ArH); MS (FAB) m/z 439. Anal. Calc. For C20H30N4O5S.HCl: C, 50.13; H, 6.61; N, 11.36. Found: C, 50.57; H, 6.58; N, 11.7.
  • EXAMPLE 1g 4-Trifluoroacetyl-1-[(trans-3-furanacyrlate]-2-(R,S)-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • 4-Trifluoroacetyl-2-(R,S)-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl piperazine (e): To a solution of (R,S)2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride (1.0 g, 3.58 mmol) and Et3N (0.5 mL, 3.58 mmol) in 10 mL of CH2Cl2 was added trifluoroacetic anhydride (0.5 mL, 3.58 mmol) at 0° C. The reaction mixture is stirred at 0° C. for 5 h. The reaction mixture was evaporated under reduced pressure (due to the water solubility of this compound there was no aqueous work-up) and isolated on a silica gel column (solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (98:2:2) to give the desired product as a free base (0.18 g, 20%); 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) d 1.76 (m, 4H), 2.25-3.15 (m, 10H), 3.26 (t, 2H), 3.88 (m, 1H), 4.39 (t, 1H).
  • To a solution of trans-3-furanacyrlic acid (0.10 g, 0.74 mmol) in 5 mL of dry CH2Cl2 under a nitrogen atmosphere was added HOBt (0.10 g., 0.74 mmol). The reaction mixture is stirred at 0° C. and added solid EDCI (0.143 g, 0.75 mmol). Then, stirred for 30 minutes at 0° C. A solution of compound e (0.18 g, 0.67 mmol) in 5 mL of dry CH2Cl2 was added followed by DIEA (0.177 mL, 1.01 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred for 24 h while warming to room temperature. The reaction mixture was then poured into water (50 mL) and stirred for 30 minutes. After dilution with CH2Cl2, the organic layer was separated, washed with saturated NaHCO3, salt solution, and water. Then, dried over Mg2SO4. The compound was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel, eluting with CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (99:1:2) to give the desired product as a free base (m.p. 144-145° C.; 0.25 g, 95% yield). The hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etheral HCl. (0.1 g) 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.74 (m, 4H), 2.57 (m, 5H), 3.11 (m, 2H), 3.31 (m, 2H), 4.05 (m, 1H), 4.25 (m, 1H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 4.65 (m, 1H), 6.58 (d, J=3.3, 7.8 Hz, 2H), 7.44 (m, 1H), 7.64 (d, J=3.3 Hz, 2H); MS (FAB) m/z 386; Anal. Calcd. For C18H22N3F3O3.HCl: C, 51.25; H, 5.50; N, 9.96. Found: C, 51.44; H, 5.57; N, 9.86.
  • EXAMPLE 1h 4-Trifluoroacetyl-1-[(-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • To a solution of 4-trifluoromethyl-phenyl acetic acid (0.08 g, 0.39 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (5.0 mL) was added 1,1′ carbonyldiimidazole (0.06 g, 0.39 mmol) under a nitrogen atmosphere and stirred for 1 h. Cool to 0° C. and compound e (0.1 g, 0.39 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (5.0 mL) was added. Then, stirred for 16 h and the reaction mixture was then poured into a solution of ice-cold saturated NaHCO3 and stirred for 30 minutes. After dilution with CH2Cl2, the organic layer was separated, washed with saturated salt solution, and dried over Mg2SO4. The compound was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel, eluting with CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (99:1:2) to give the desired product as a free base (m.p. 140-145° C.; 0.08 g, 47% yield). The hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etheral HCl. (0.05 g) 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.75 (m, 4H), 2.55 (m, 5H), 2.69-3.2 (m, 4H), 3.8 (m, 1H), 3.83 (m, 2H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 4.65 (m, 1H), 7.38 (d, J=7.7 Hz, 2H), 7.64 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 2H); MS (FAB) m/z 452; Anal. Calcd. For C20H23N3F3O2.HCl.0.3Et2O: C, 49.96; H, 5.30; N, 8.24. Found: C, 49.62; H, 5.16; N, 7.84.
  • EXAMPLE 1i Methyl-4-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(4′-methylpiperazinecarboxylate)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with methyl-3 (R,S)-[(4′-methylpiperazinecarboxylate)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate; mp: (HCl salt) 160-165° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-1.8 (2H, m), 2.2-3.2 (8H, m), 3.3-3.5 (5H, m), 3.6 (3H, s), 3.7 (3H, s), 3.94.5 (3H, m), 4.74.8 (1H, m), 7.1 (1H, m), 7.4 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 487 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C21H28Cl2N4O5.HCl. H2O: C, 46.55; H, 5.77; N, 10.34. Found: C, 46.02; H, 5.93; N, 10.91.
  • EXAMPLE 1j Methyl-4-[(4-a,a,a-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[3-(S)-(4′-α,α,α-trifluoro methylphenylacetate)-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride (1j)
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 4-α,α,α-trifluoromethylphenyl-acetic acid with methyl-3-(R,S)-[3-(S)-hydroxy-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazine carboxylate; mp: (HCl salt) 98-100° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.6-3.1 (11H, m), 3.4-5.4 (12H, m), 7.1-7.7 (8H, m); MS (FAB) 616 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C29H31F6N3O5.HCl. H2O.0.25NH4Cl: C, 50.97; H, 5.16; N, 6.66. Found: C, 50.45; H, 5.07; N, 6.67.
  • EXAMPLE 1k Methyl-4-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethyl-3′,4′-dichlorophenyl acetate)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with methyl-3-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethanol)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate; mp: (HCl salt) 77-80° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.3-2.0 (5H, m), 2.0-2.5 (4H, m), 2.5-3.3 (5H, m), 3.7 (3H, s), 3.4-4.8 (3H, m), 3.8-4.9 (5H, m), 7.0 (2H, m), 7.3 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 632 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C30H33F6N3O4.
  • EXAMPLE 1l Methyl-4-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-3-(R)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethanol)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by aq. LiOH hydrolization of 1k; mp: (HCl salt)135-138° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.6-1.8 (4H, m), 3.7 (3H, s), 2.0-4.1 (15H, m), 4.3-4.8 (2H, m), 7.0 (1H, m), 7.3 (1H, m); MS (FAB) 444 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C20H27Cl2N3O4.HCl. H2O: C, 48.16; H, 6.06; N, 8.42. Found: C, 48.64; H, 6.05; N, 8.45.
  • EXAMPLE 1m Methyl-4-[(2-nitro-4-α,α,α-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidine methanol)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by aq. LiOH hydrolization of methyl-4-[(2-nitro-4-α,α,α-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidine methyl-2′-nitro-4′-α,α,α-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetate)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate; mp: (HCl salt)136-140° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.6-1.9 (3H, m), 3.7 (3H, d), 2.1-3.6 (12H, m), 3.94.9 (6H, m), 7.4 (1H, d), 7.8 (1H, d), 8.3 (1H, s); MS (FAB) 489 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C21H27F3N3O6.HCl: C, 48.05; H, 5.38; N, 10.67. Found: C, 47.81; H, 5.27; N, 10.49.
  • EXAMPLE 1n Methyl-4-[(4-methylsulphonylphenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethyl-4′-methylsulphonylphenylacetate)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 4-methylsulphonylphenylacetic acid with methyl-3-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethanol)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate; mp: (HCl salt) 133-135° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.4-2.5 (5H, m), 3.0 (3H, s), 2.6-3.3 (8H, m), 3.4-4.9 (15H, m), 7.4 (4H, m), 7.9 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 650 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C30H39S2N3O9.HCl.0.75NH4Cl: C, 49.61; H, 5.97; N, 7.23. Found: C, 50.07; H, 6.17; N, 7.26.
  • EXAMPLE 1o Methyl-4-[(4-methylsulphonylphenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethanol)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by aq. LiOH hydrolization of compound 1n; mp: (HCl salt) 130-135° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.6-1.9 (4H, m), 2.1-2.5 (2H, m), 2.5-3.4 (7H, m), 3.0 (3H, s), 3.44.2 (6H, m), 3.7 (3H, m), 4.2-5.0 (2H, m), 7.5 (2H, m), 7.9 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 454 (M+H)t; Anal. Calcd. for C21H31SN3O6.HCl.H2O: C, 49.65; H, 6.75; N, 8.27. Found: C, 50.19; H, 6.77; N, 8.26.
  • EXAMPLE 1p Methyl-4-[(2-amino-4-α,α,α-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-3-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidine methanol)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by Pd catalyzed hydrogenation of compound 1m; mp: (HCl salt)140-143° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.7-3.3 (12H, m), 3.7 (3H, s), 3.34.3 (11H, m), 6.9 (2H, m), 7.1 (1H, m); MS (FAB) 459 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C21H29F3N4O4.2HCl.CH3OH: C, 46.90; H, 6.26; N, 9.94. Found: C, 46.96; H, 6.14; N, 9.93.
  • EXAMPLE 1q Methyl-4-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-(3′,4′-dichlorophenyl acetate)-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxylate hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with methyl-3-(R,S)-[3-(S)-hydroxy-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]-1-piperazine carboxylate; mp: (HCl salt) 125-128° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.9-3.1 (9H, m), 3.4-3.8 (8H, m), 4.04.2 (3H, m), 4.5-5.2 (3H, m), 7.1 (2H, m), 7.4 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 618 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C27H29Cl4N3O5.HCl: C, 49.60; H, 4.62; N, 6.43. Found: C, 49.39; H, 4.65; N, 6.44.
  • EXAMPLE 1r 4-Acetyl-1-[3-(N-methylsulfonamido)phenyl]acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by methylsulphonylation of 4-acetyl-1-[3-amino)phenyl]acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine as clear oil, the dihydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl; mp: (HCl salt)140° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-1.7 (4H, m), 1.8-3.1 (13H, m), 3.44.9 (9H, m), 6.5 (2H, m), 7.0 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 423 (M+H)+. Anal. Calcd. for C20H30N4O4S.HCl. NH4Cl: C, 46.87; H, 6.88; N, 13.67. Found: C, 44.83; H, 7.18; N, 13.16.
  • EXAMPLE 1s 4-Acetyl-1-[(2-acetylamidophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by acetylation of 4-acetyl-1-[(2-aminophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt)173° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.3-1.8 (6H, m), 2.0 (3H, s), 2.1 (3H, 3), 2.2-3.4 (8H, m), 3.64.8 (6H, m), 6.9-7.2 (3H, m), 7.8 (1H, m); MS (FAB) 387 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C21H30N4O3.HCl.2H2O: C, 54.95; H, 7.69; N, 12.21. Found: C, 54.53; H, 6.91; N, 11.92.
  • EXAMPLE 1t 4-Acetyl-1-[(4-acetylamidophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by acetylation of 4-acetyl-1-[(4-aminophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt)165° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-1.7 (5H, m), 1.9-2.1 (6H, m), 2.2-3.1 (8H, m), 3.54.7 (6H, m), 7.0 (2H, m), 7.4 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 387 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C21H30O3N4.HCl. H2O: C, 57.20; H, 7.54; N, 12.71. Found: C, 57.05; H, 7.31; N, 12.74.
  • EXAMPLE 1u 4-Acetyl-1-[(4-methylsulfonyl]phenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-(4′-methylsulfonyl phenyl acetate)-1-(Pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-hydroxy-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt) 160-163° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.7-2.2 (7H, m), 2.3-3.2 (12H, m), 3.0 (6H, s), 3.5-4.1 (8H, m), 4.4-5.2 (4H, m), 7.4 (4H, m), 7.8 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 620 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C29H37S2N3O8.HCl: C, 53.00; H, 5.98; N, 6.39. Found: C, 52.26; H, 6.00; N, 6.37.
  • EXAMPLE 1v 4-Acetyl-1-[(4-α,α,α-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-(4′-α,α,α-trifluoro methylphenyl acetate)-1-(Pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 4-α,α,α-trifluoromethyphenyl acetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-hydroxy-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt) 134-136° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.6-3.2 (15H, m), 3.4-4.1 (5H, m), 4.3-5.2 (3H, m), 7.3 (4H, m), 7.5 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 599 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C29H31F6N3O4.HCl.0.5NH4Cl: C, 52.55; H, 5.17; N, 7.40. Found: C, 52.05; H, 5.56; N, 7.90.
  • EXAMPLE 1w 4-Acetyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-(3′,4′-dichlorophenyl acetate)-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-hydroxy-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt)122-125° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.6-1.9 (3H, m), 2.1 (3H, s), 2.1-3.9 (14H, m), 4.0-5.3 (3H, m), 7.1 (2H, m), 7.4 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 602 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C27H29Cl4N3O4.HCl: C, 50.84; H, 4.74; N, 6.59. Found: C, 49.33; H, 4.76; N, 6.85.
  • EXAMPLE 1x 4-Acetyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethyl-3′,4′ dichlorophenylacetate)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethanol)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt)107-110° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-2.0 (3H, m), 2.0-2.2 (3H, d), 2.2-3.3 (9H, m), 3.54.1 (8H, m), 4.4-4.9 ((2H, m), 7.1 (2H, m), 7.4 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 616 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C28H31Cl4N3O4.HCl. NH4Cl: C, 47.68; H, 5.14; N, 7.94. Found: C, 47.80; H, 5.38; N, 9.05.
  • EXAMPLE 1y 4-Acetyl-1-[(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-2(R,S)-[2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethyl-4′-trifluoromethylphenylacetate)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethanol)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt) 110-113° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-3.3 (12H, m), 2.1 (3H, s), 3.54.1 (9H, m), 4.34.9 (1H, m), 7.3 (4H, m), 7.5 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 614 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C30H33F6N3O4.HCl.0.5NH4Cl: C, 53.24; H, 5.36; N, 7.24. Found: C, 53.86; H, 5.45; N, 6.91.
  • EXAMPLE 1z 4-Acetyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidine methanol)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by aq. LiOH hydrolization of compound 1x; mp: (HCl salt)123-125° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.6-2.0 (4H, m), 2.1 (3H, m), 2.2-3.4 (10H, m), 3.44.0 (5H, m), 4.4-5.0 (2H, m), 7.1 (2H, m), 7.4 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 428 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C20H27Cl2N3O3.HCl: C, 51.68; H, 6.07; N, 9.04. Found: C, 49.84; H, 6.08; N, 9.03.
  • EXAMPLE 1aa 4-Acetyl-1-[(4-methylsulphonylphenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S) [(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethyl-4′-methylsulphonylphenylacetate)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 4-methylsulphonylphenylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethanol)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt)145-148° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-2.0 (3H, m), 2.1 (3H, m), 3.0 (6H, s), 2.5-3.3 (9H, m), 3.64.2 (9H, m), 4.5 (1H, m), 7.5 (4H, m), 7.9 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 634 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C30H39S2N3O8.HCl.0.25NH4Cl: C, 52.71; H, 6.05; N, 6.66. Found: C, 52.02; H, 6.19; N, 6.59
  • EXAMPLE 1bb 4-Acetyl-1-[(4-methylsulphonylphenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethanol)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by aq. LiOH hydrolization of compound 1aa; mp: (HCl salt) 138-140° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.6-2.0 (4H, m), 2.1 (3H, m), 2.2-3.0 (5H, m), 3.1 (3H, s), 3.14.0 (10H, m), 4.4-5.0 (2H, m), 7.5 (2H, m), 7.9 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 438 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C21H31SN3O5.HCl.H2O: C, 51.26; H, 6.96; N, 8.54. Found: C, 50.36; H, 6.92; N, 8.90.
  • EXAMPLE 1cc 4-Acetyl-1-[(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethanol)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by aq. LiOH hydrolization of compound 1y; mp: (HCl salt)123-125° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.6-2.2 (4H, m), 2.1 (3H, s), 2.2-4.0 (15H, m), 4.5-5.0 (2H, m), 7.4 (2H, m), 7.6 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 428 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C21H28F3N3O3.HCl.NH4Cl: C, 48.75; H, 6.43; N, 10.83. Found: C, 47.46; H, 6.04; N, 12.40.
  • EXAMPLE 1dd 4-Formyl-1-[(2-N-methylsulfamylphenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 2-(N-methylaminosulfonyl)phenyl acetic acid with 4-formyl-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt) 150° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.7 (4H, m), 2.2-3.2 (11H, m), 3.44.0 (4H, m), 4.2-5.4 (4H, m), 7.0 (1H, m), 7.4 (2H, m), 7.6 (1H,), 8.0 (1H, m); MS (FAB) 409 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C19H28O4N4S.HCl.0.5NH4Cl: C, 48.38; H, 6.62; N, 13.36. Found: C, 48.08; H, 6.46; N, 13.33.
  • EXAMPLE 1ee 4-Carbonylimidazole-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 1,1′-carbonyldiimidazole with 1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt) 148° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-1.7 (4H, m), 2.1-2.5 (5H, m), 2.6-3.4 (4H, m), 3.5-4.8 (7H, m), 6.9-7.4 (4H, m), 8.0 (1H, m); MS (FAB) 450 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C21H25Cl2N5O2.2HCl. H2O: C, 46.60; H, 5.40; N, 12.94. Found: C, 45.41; H, 5.33; N, 12.73.
  • EXAMPLE 1ff 4-Allyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of allyl bromide with 1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine in 81% yield; mp: (HCl salt)157-160° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.4-2.0(6H, m), 2.3-3.0 (6H, m), 3.1-3.8 (4H, m), 4.34.8 (1H, m), 4.9-5.1 (2H, m), 5.7-5.9 (1H, m), 7.0-7.3 (3H, m); MS (FAB) 396 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd for C20H27Cl2N30.2HCl: C, 51.19; H, 6.23; N, 8.95. Found: C, 50.89; H, 6.42; N, 8.65.
  • EXAMPLE 1gg 4-Acetyl-1-[(2-pyridyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 2-pyridylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt) 127-130° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ1.4-1.7 (4H, m), 2.0 (3H, s), 2.2-3.2 (9H, m), 3.4-4.8 (6H, m), 6.8-7.5 (3H, m), 8.4 (1H, m); MS (FAB) 331 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C18H26N4O2.2HCl.0.5NH4Cl: C, 50.27; H, 7.03; N, 14.65. Found: C, 50.86; H, 6.47; N, 15.79.
  • EXAMPLE 1hh 4-Formyl-1-[(2-pyridyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 2-pyridinylacetic acid with 4-formyl-2-(R,S)-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt) 125-128° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-1.7 (4H, m), 2.1-3.6 (10H, m), 3.7-4.9 (5H, m), 6.9-7.3 (2H, m), 7.6 (1H, m), 8.0 (1H, m), 8.6 (1H, m); MS (FAB) 317 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C17H24N4O2.2HCl.NH4Cl: C, 46.11; H, 6.83; N, 15.82. Found: C, 46.37; H, 6.51; N, 16.35.
  • EXAMPLE 1ii Methyl-4-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-3-(S)-[(2-(S)-pyrrolidinemethanol)methyl]-1-piperazinecarboxlate hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by aq. LiOH hydrolization of 1k; mp: (HCl salt)137-140° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-2.0 (4H, m), 3.7 (3H, s), 2.1-3.7 (14H, m), 3.84.9 (3H, m), 7.1 (1H, m), 7.3 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 444 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C20H27Cl2N3O4.HCl.0.5NH4Cl: C, 47.33; H, 5.96; N, 9.66. Found: C, 47.55; H, 6.11; N, 9.39.
  • EXAMPLE 1jj 4-Methanesulfonyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-methanesulfonate-1-(pyrrolidinyl) methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared from 1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-[(3-hydroxy-1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine dihydrochloride1 (0.25 g, 0.56 mmol), methanesulfonyl chloride (0.43 mL, 5.56 mmol), triethylamine (2.3 mL, 16.53 mmol) and CH2Cl2 (20 mL) at 0° C. for 6 h. After dilution with saturated NaHCO3 solution (20 mL) and washed with water (20 mL). Then, dried over MgSO4. The compound was purified by flash chromatography on silica gel, eluting with CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (99:1:2) to give the desired product as a free base (0.28 g; 94% yield) and a hydrochloride salt was generated (0.067 g; m.p. 130-132° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 2.10 (m, 1H), 2.29 (m, 1H), 2.59 (m, 4H), 2.89 (s. 3H), 3.01 (s, 3H), 3.2-3.5 (m, 2H), 3.60-3.9 (m, 4H), 4.90 (m, 1H), 5.15 (m, 1H), 7.12 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 7.43 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H); MS (FAB) 528 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C19H27Cl2N3O6S2.HCl: C, 40.40; H, 5.00; N, 7.44. Found: C, 40.29; H, 5.07; N, 7.04.
  • EXAMPLE 1kk 4-Methylsulphonyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-(3′,4′dichloro phenyl acetate)-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with 4-methylsulphonyl-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-(hydroxy)-1-(pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt)145-148° C.; 1H NMR (freebase, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-1.9 (2H, m), 2.2-3.0 (7H, m), 2.7 (3H, s), 3.5-4.0 (8H, m), 4.9-5.2 (3H, m), 7.1 (2H, m), 7.4 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 638 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C26H29Cl4N3O5S.HCl.0.5NH4Cl: C, 44.52; H, 4.60; N, 7.00. Found: C, 45.66; H, 4.72; N, 7.61.
  • EXAMPLE 1ll 4-Methylsulphonyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(3-(S)-hydroxy-1-pyrrolidinyl) methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by aq. LiOH hydrolization of 1kk; mp: (HCl salt) 150-153° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-2.3 (4H, m), 2.4-3.2 (7H, m), 2.8 (3H, s), 3.4-4.0 (5H, m), 4.5-5.2 (3H, m), 7.1 (1H, m), 7.4 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 450 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. For C18H25Cl2N3O4S.HCl.0.25NH4Cl: C, 43.22; H, 5.44; N, 9.10. Found: C, 43.23; H, 5.16; N, 9.8
  • EXAMPLE 1mm 4-Methylsulphonyl-1-[(4-α,α,α-triflouromethylphenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-(4′-α,α,α-triflouro methylphenyl acetate)-1-(pyrrolidinyl) methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 4-(α,α,α-triflouromethyl)phenyl acetic acid with 4-methyl sulphonyl-2-(R,S)-[3-(S)-hydroxy-1-(pyrrolidinyl) methyl]piperazine; mp: (HCl salt) 120-123° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.8-2.2 (4H, m), 2.4-3.3 (8H, m), 2.7 (3H, s), 3.64.0 (6H, m), 4.8-5.2 (2H, m), 7.4 (4H, m), 7.6 (4H, m); MS (FAB) 636 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. For C28H31F6N3O5S. HCl: C, 50.04; H, 4.80; N, 6.25. Found: C, 50.34; H, 4.80; N, 6.09.
  • EXAMPLE 1nn 4-Methylsulphonyl-1-[(4-α,α,α-triflouromethylphenyl)acetyl]-2-(R,S)-[(3-(S)-hydroxy-1-pyrrolidinyl)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by aq. LiOH hydrolization of 1 mm; mp: (HCl salt) 145° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.5-2.1 (3H, m), 2.3-3.4 (9H, m), 2.8 (3H, s), 3.74.0 (5H, m), 4.3-5.0 (2H, m), 7.4 (2H, m), 7.6 (2H, m); MS (FAB) 450 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C19H26F3N3O4S. HCl: C, 46.96; H, 5.60; N, 8.65. Found: C, 46.45; H, 5.66; N, 8.69.
  • EXAMPLE 1oo 4-Acetyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(S)-[(3′-(S)-hydroxy-1-pyrrolidine)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(3′-(S)-hydroxypyrrolidine)methyl]piperazine. Then, this racemic mixture was separated on a Chiralpak AD column using 100% acetonitrile as the eluant. Then, from the 2-(S), 3′-(S) enantiomer a HCl salt was generated (1.0 gm.); mp: (HCl salt)130-135° C.; [a]20+25.560 (0.85%; w/v MeOH). 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.74 (1H, m), 2.13 (3H, s), 2.2 (1H, m), 2.3-3.2 (10H, m), 3.45-3.71 (3H, m), 4.11 (1H, d) 4.21-4.74 (2H, m), 4.55 ((1H, m), 7.10 (1H, J=8.25 Hz, d), 7.41 (2H, J=8.28 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 414 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C19H25Cl2N3O3.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 49.65; H, 5.77; N, 8.91. Found: C, 49.58; H, 5.65; N, 9.13.
  • EXAMPLE 1pp 4-Acetyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(R)-[(3′-(R)-hydroxy-1-pyrrolidine)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(3′-(R)hydroxy-1-pyrrolidine)methyl]piperazine. Then, this racemic mixture was separated on a Chiralpak AD column using 100% acetonitrile as the eluant. Then, from the 2-(R), 3′-(R) enantiomer a HCl salt was generated (0.9 gm.); mp: (HCl salt)130-135° C.; [a]20 −30.49° (0.88%; w/v MeOH). 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.74 (1H, m), 2.13 (3H, s), 2.2 (1H, m), 2.3-3.2 (10H, m), 3.45-3.71 (3H, m), 4.11 (1H, d) 4.21-4.74 (2H, m), 4.55 ((1H, m), 7.10 (1H, J=8.25 Hz, d), 7.41 (2H, J=8.28 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 414 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C19H25Cl2N3O3.HCl: C, 50.62; H, 5.81; N, 9.32. Found: C, 49.94; H, 5.84; N, 8.97.
  • EXAMPLE 1qq 4-Acetyl-1-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)acetyl]-2-(S)-[(3′-(R)-hydroxy-1-pyrrolidine)methyl]piperazine hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared by coupling of 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid with 4-acetyl-2-(R,S)-[(3′-(R)-hydroxy-1-pyrrolidine)methyl]piperazine. Then, this racemic mixture was separated on a Chiralpak AD column using 100% acetonitrile as the eluant. Then, from the 2-(S), 3′-(R) enantiomer a HCl salt was generated (1.05 gm); mp: (HCl salt)130-135° C.; [a]20+28.80 (0.75%; w/v MeOH). 1H NMR (free base, 300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.74 (1H, m), 2.13 (3H, s), 2.2 (1H, m), 2.3-3.2 (10H, m), 3.45-3.71 (3H, m), 4.11 (1H, d) 4.21-4.74 (2H, m), 4.55 ((1H, m), 7.10 (1H, J=8.25 Hz, d), 7.41 (2H, J=8.28 Hz, d); MS (FAB) 414 (M+H)+; Anal. Calcd. for C19H25Cl2N3O3.HCl: C, 50.62; H, 5.81; N, 9.32. Found: C, 50.19; H, 5.86; N, 9.06.
  • Ref.
    • Naylor, A.; Judd, D. B.; Lloyd, J. E.; Scopes, D. I. C.; Hayes, A. G.; Birch, P. J. J. Med. Chem. 1993, 36, 2075-2083 and references cited in there.
    • U.S. Pat. No. 5,116,842; Naylor et al; 1992.
  • Compounds of Formula II
  • General procedure for DCC/pyr coupling. With stirring at 25° C. under N2, DCC (2.06 eq) and CH2Cl2 were added to a mixture of the acid (2 eq) and pyridine (2.06 eq) in CH2Cl2. After 1-2 min, a solution of the amine (1 eq) in CH2Cl2 was added, and the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 overnight. The final concentration of the mixture is around 0.1-0.3 mM with respect to the amine. Sat'd. NaHCO3 (2 mL) was added to destroy excess active esters before the mixture was filtered through celite, and the DCU was washed with CH2Cl2. The filtrate was then partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2, which was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. Toluene was added to azeotrope off pyridine before the crude product was chromatographed and converted to the HCl salt.
  • Compounds having the following structures were prepared:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00051
      • (±)-1, X=—OMe
      • (±)-2, X=—NO2
      • (±)-3, X=—OMe, R1=—H, R2=3,4-Cl2-phenyl
      • (±)-4, X=—OH, R1=—H, R2=3,4-Cl2-phenyl
      • (±)-5, X=—OCH2CO2H, R1=—H, R2=3,4-Cl2-phenyl
      • (±)-6, X=—OMe, R1=R2=phenyl
      • (±)-7, X=—OH, R1=R2=phenyl
      • (±)-8, X=—NO2, R1=—H, R2=2-NO2-4,5-Cl2-phenyl
      • (±)-9, X=—NO2, R1=—H, R2=3,4-Cl2-phenyl
      • (±)-10, X=—NH2, R1=—H, R2=3,4-Cl2-phenyl
      • (±)-11, X=—NO2, R1=—H, R2=4-methylsulfonylphenyl
      • (±)-12, X=—N(CH2CO2tBu)2, R1=—H, R2=3,4-Cl2-phenyl
      • (±)-13, X=—N(CH2CO2H)2, R1=—H, R2=3,4-Cl2-phenyl
      • (±)-14, X=—N(CH2CO2Et)2, R1=—H, R2=3,4-Cl2-phenyl
      • (±)-15, X=—NHPO3Et2, R1=—H, R2=3,4-Cl2-phenyl
      • (±)-16, X=—N(CH2)2PO3Et2, R1=—H, R2=3,4-Cl2-phenyl
  • Intermediates (±)-1 and (±)-2 were prepared via reported methods from the appropriate starting materials.5 Compounds (±)-3 and (±)-4 are known compounds prepared via reported methods.5 Compounds (±)-5 through (±)-16 were prepared by DCC coupling of either (±)-1 or (±)-2 to an arylacetic acid followed by demethylation or reduction to allow peripheralization.
  • Ref.
    • (5) Rajagopalan, P. et al. Bioorg. Med. Chem. Letters 1992, 2, 721-726.
      Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00052
  • Intermediates 17 and 18 were prepared via known methods from 6-methoxy-1-tetralone and 1-tetralone, respectively. Intermediates 17 and 18 were coupled to 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid to produce (±)-19 and (±)-20.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00053
  • Intermediates (±)-21 and (±)-23 were prepared via similar chemistry from 1-benzosuberone and (±)-trans-2-bromo-1-indanol.1 Compounds (±)-22, (±)-25 (Niravoline),6 and (±)-27 are known compounds prepared via reported chemistry.1 Compounds (±)-24 through (±)-29 were prepared by DCC coupling to the appropriate arylacetic acid.
  • Ref.
    • (6) Bellissant, E. et al. J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 1996, 278, 232-242.
  • Representative examples of formula II follow.
  • EXAMPLE 33 2-{7-[(±)-trans-1-(N-3,4-dichlorophenylacetamido-N-methylamino)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphthoxy]}acetic acid ((±)-5)
  • With stirring at 25° C. under N2, t-butyl bromoacetate (0.35 mL, 2.38 mmol) was added to a mixture of (±)-4 (0.688 g, 1.59 mmol) and K2CO3 (0.5 g, 3.6 mmol) in DMF (8 mL), and the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 overnight before the mixture was evaporated under high vacuum. The residue was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2 (2×100 mL), which was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. The t-butyl ester intermediate was flash column chromatographed twice eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:2% MeOH and CH2Cl2:2% NH3:1% MeOH, respectively. The t-butyl ester was then deprotected in a mixture of THF (4 mL) and conc. HCl (2 mL) with stirring at 25° C. overnight and at 50° C. for 1 h before the mixture was evaporated. The residue was then dissolved in a mixture of trifluoroacetic acid (2 mL), 4 N HCl (2 mL), and anisole (1 drop), and stirred at 25° C. for 2.5 days before the mixture was evaporated. The oily residue was triturated with Et2O and sonicated to yield (±)-5.HCl (0.259 g, 31%): m.p. (HCl salt) 138° C. (dec); 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.7-2.1 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.24.8 (complex, 13H, 6-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.79 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 5.98 (d, J=10.3 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 6.40 (s, 1H, aromatic), 6.82 (m, 1H, aromatic), 7.12 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.39 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.63 (m, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 491. Anal. (C, H, N)C25H28N2O4Cl2HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 34 2,2-Diphenyl-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-7-methoxy-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-6)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling method from (±)-1 (1.453 g, 5.58 mmol), diphenylacetic acid (2.369 g, 11.16 mmol), DCC (2.373 g, 11.50 mmol), and pyridine (0.93 mL, 11.5 mmol). The product was flash column chromatographed eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:1% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and crystallized from MeOH-Et2O to yield (±)-6.HCl (1.7 g, 63%): m.p. (HCl salt)>250° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.8-2.0 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.2-3.9 (complex, 9H, 4-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.79 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.48 (s, 3H, —OCH3), 5.66 (s, 1H, —CH—), 6.1 (d, J=9.4 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 6.23 (s, 1H, aromatic), 6.77 (d of d, J=2.4 Hz and 8.4 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.09 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.2-7.5 (complex, 10H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 455. Anal. (C, H, N) C30H34N2O2.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 35 2,2-Diphenyl-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-7-hydroxy-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-7)
  • With stirring in dry ice-acetone under N2, 1.0 M BBr3 in CH2Cl2 (19.7 mL) was added at a fast drop rate to a solution of (±)-6 (1.491 g, 3.28 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (20 mL), and the mixture was allowed to slowly warm to 25° C. under N2 as the dry ice sublimed. After 6.5 h, the mixture was quenched with MeOH with ice-H2O cooling and diluted with CH2Cl2 (50 mL). The mixture was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2. Some yellowish precipitate was extracted into CH2Cl2 by adding some MeOH. The organic fraction was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. The product was flash colum chromatographed eluting with CHCl3:2% NH3:2% MeOH to yield (±)-7 (0.426 g, 30%). Part of the free base was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O: 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ 1.5-1.8 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 1.8-2.9 (complex, 9H, 4-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.55 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 5.21 (s, 1H, —CH—), 5.83 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 6.22 (s, 1H, aromatic), 6.46 (m, 1H, aromatic), 6.78 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7-7.4 (complex, 10H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 441. Anal. (C, H, N)C29H32N2O2.HCl.H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 36 2-(2-Nitro-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-7-nitro-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-8)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling method from (±)-2 (0.5790 g, 2.103 mmol), 2-nitro-4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (1.0512 g, 4.204 mmol), DCC (0.8948 g, 4.34 mmol), and pyr (0.35 mL, 4.3 mmol). After stirring at 25° C. overnight, more 2-nitro-4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (1.0510 g, 4.203 mmol), DCC (0.8946 g, 4.34 mmol), and CH2Cl2 (10 mL) were added, and after 5 h, the reaction was worked up according to the general procedure. The crude product was purified by gravity column eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and washed with hot MeOH to yield (±)-8.HCl (0.4948 g, 43% yield): m.p. (HCl salt)>250° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ1.8-2. (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.24.6 (complex, 11H, 5-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.9 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.1 (d, J=10.2 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 7.53 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.89 (s, 1H, aromatic), 7.91 (s, 1H, aromatic), 8.12 (d of d, J=2.2 Hz and 8.5 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 8.4 (s, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 507. Anal. (C, H, N)C23H24N4O5Cl2.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 37 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-7-nitro-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-9)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from (±)-2 (1.8173 g, 6.600 mmol), 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid (2.7066 g, 13.20 mmol), DCC (2.8057 g, 13.60 mmol), and pyr (1.10 mL, 13.6 mmol). The product was purified by flash column eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:1% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with Et2O—HCl and washed with hot MeOH to yield (±)-9.HCl (2.49 g, 76%): m.p. (HCl salt) 255-257° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) 81.8-2 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 24.2 (complex, 11H, 5-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.83 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.1 (d, J=9.8 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 7.3-7.7 (complex, 5H, aromatic), 8.06 (d of d, J=2.4 Hz and 8.6 Hz, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 462. Anal. (C, H, N)C23H25N3O3Cl2HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 38 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-7-amino-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-10)
  • With stirring at 55° C., Raney nickel (50% slurry in H2O) was added in small portions to a mixture of (±)-9-(2.10 g, 4.54 mmol) and hydrazine hydrate (4 mL) in EtOH (60 mL) until all hydrazine was decomposed in 30 min. The mixture was filtered through celite, and the Raney nickel was washed with hot MeOH (120 mL). The filtrate was evaporated and dried in vacuo before the residue was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2, which was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. The product was purified by gravity column eluting with CHCl3:2% NH3:0.5% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with Et2O—HCl to yield (±)-10.HCl (0.3 g, 14%, unoptimized): m.p. (HCl salt)>250° C.; 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ 1.64 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 1.9-3.8 (complex, 11H, 5-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.59 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 5.8 (d, J=9.7 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 6.29 (s, 1H, aromatic), 6.43 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 6.8 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.17 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.3 (m, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 432. Anal. (C, H, N)C23H27N3OCl2.2HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 39 2-(4-Methylsulfonylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-7-nitro-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-11)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from (±)-2 (0.3414 g, 1.240 mmol), 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (0.5309 g, 2.478 mmol), DCC (0.5288 g, 2.563 mmol), and pyr (0.21 mL, 2.55 mmol). After stirring at 25° C. overnight, more of 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (0.5307 g, 2.477 mmol), DCC (1.1356 g, 5.504 mmol), and CH2Cl2 (13 mL) were added, and the mixture was worked up according to the general procedure after another night of stirring. The product was purified by gravity column eluting with CHCl3:2% NH3:1% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with Et2O—HCl and washed with hot MeOH to yield (±)-11.HCl (0.4455 g, 76%): m.p. (HCl salt) 284-285° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.96 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.14.3 (complex, 11H, 5-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.88 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.24 (s, 3H, —SO2CH3), 6.13 (d, J=10 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 7.51 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.68 (m, 3H, aromatic), 7.9 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 2H, aromatic), 8.08 (d of d, J=2.6 Hz and 8.5 Hz, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 472. Anal. (C, H, N)C24H29N3O5S.HCl 0.25CH2Cl2.
  • EXAMPLE 40 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[±]-trans-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]-7-[N,N-bis-(t-butoxycarbonylmethyl)-amino]-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl}acetamide ((±)-12)
  • With stirring in ice-H2O under N2, t-butyl bromoacetate (0.34 mL, 2.32 mmol) was added dropwise to a mixture of (±)-10 (0.4014 g, 0.928 mmol) and NEt(iPr)2 (0.81 mL, 4.64 mmol) in dry THF (10 mL). After 10 min, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 overnight before more t-butyl bromoacetate (0.30 mL) was added at 25° C. After stirring overnight, more NEt(iPr)2 (0.40 mL) and t-butyl bromoacetate (0.30 mL) were added, and after one more night of stirring, the mixture was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2. The aqueous fraction was extracted with more CH2Cl2, and the combined organic fraction was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. The crude product was purified by gravity column eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:1% MeOH before part of the free base was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O with stirring in ice-H2O. The residue was sonicated in hexane to yield (±)-12.2HCl (0.1610 g, 25%, unoptimized): m.p. (HCl salt) 143° C. (dec); 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ 1.39 (s, 9H, t-butyl), 1.43 (s, 9H, t-butyl), 1.65 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 1.94.1 (complex, 15H, 7-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.58 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 5.8 (m, 1H, —CH—), 6.2-7.4 (complex, 6H, aromatic). MS (FAB) 660. Anal. (C, H, N)C35H47N3O5Cl2.2HCl.0.5CH3CN.
  • EXAMPLE 41 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[±]-trans-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]-7-[N,N-bis-(carboxymethyl)amino]-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl}acetamide ((±)-13)
  • A solution of (±)-12 (0.35 g, 0.5 mmol) in 1:1 AcOH and 3 N HCl (8 mL) with some anisole (2 drops) was stirred at 25° C. overnight before conc. HCl (0.5 mL) was added, and the mixture was warmed to 40° C. for 1 h. Then some anisole (4 drops) was added, and the mixture was stirred at 25° C. for 5 h before it was evaporated. The residue was sequentially evaporated from iPrOH and PhCH3 before it was sonicated with Et2O to yield (±)-13.HCl (0.2360 g, 81%): m.p. (HCl salt) 160° C. (dec); 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.93 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.24.3 (complex, 15H, 7-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.79 (s, 3H, —NCH3—), 5.93 (d, J=10.7 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 6.37 (s, 1H, aromatic), 6.68 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.00 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.40 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.63 (m, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 490 (M+1-CH2CO2H). Anal. (C, H, N)C27H31N3O5Cl2.1HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 42 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1-trans-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]-7-[N,N-bis-(ethoxycarbonylmethyl)-amino]-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl}acetamide ((±)-14)
  • With stirring in ice-H2O under N2, ethyl bromoacetate (0.47 mL, 4.21 mmol) was added dropwise to a mixture of (±)-10 (0.3640 g, 0.842 mmol) and NEt(iPr)2 (0.88 mL, 5.05 mmol) in dry THF (6 mL). After 10 min, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 overnight before it was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2. The aqueous fraction was extracted with more CH2Cl2, and the combined organic fraction was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. The product was purified by gravity column eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:1% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and washed with Et2O to yield (±)-14.HCl (0.27 g, 47%): m.p. (HCl salt) 128° C. (dec); 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.2 (m, 6H, 2-CH3), 1.9 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.24.4 (complex, 19H, 9-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.78 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 5.9 (d, 1-10.3 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 6.14 (s, 1H, aromatic), 6.49 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 6.91 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.39 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.6 (m, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 605. Anal. (C, H, N)C31H39N3O5Cl2.1.25HCl.0.3CH3CN.
  • EXAMPLE 43 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-7-(N-diethylphosphoramidato-amino)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-15)
  • With stirring in ice-H2O under N2, diethyl chlorophosphate (0.57 mL, 3.92 mmol) was added dropwise to a mixture of (±)-10 (0.3393 g, 0.785 mmol) and NEt(iPr)2 (0.82 mL, 4.71 mmol) in dry THF (6 mL). After 10 min, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 overnight before the mixture was evaporated and dried in vacuo. The residue was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2. The aqueous fraction was extracted with more CH2Cl2, and the combined organic fraction was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. The product was purified by gravity column eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:1.5% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and sonicated in Et2O to yield (±)-15.HCl (0.4205 g, 89%): m.p. (HCl salt) 247-249° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.2 (m, 6H, 2-CH3), 1.95 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.24.1 (complex, 15H, 7-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.75 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 5.98 (d, J=10.3 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 6.7 (s, 1H, aromatic), 6.9 (m, 1H, aromatic), 7.03 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.3 (d of d, J=2 Hz and 8.2 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.6 (m, 2H, aromatic), 7.92 (d, J=9.7 Hz, —NHP). MS (FAB) m/z 568. Anal. (C, H, N)C27H36N3O4PCl2HCl 0.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 44 2-(34-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[±]-trans-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]-7-[N-2-(diethylphosphoryl)ethyl-amino]-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl}acetamide ((±)-16)
  • With stirring in ice-H2O under N2, diethyl 2-bromoethylphosphonate (0.8601 g, 3.52 mmol) was added to a mixture of (±)-10 (0.3042 g, 0.704 mmol) and NEt(iPr)2 (0.74 mL, 4.2 mmol) in dry THF (4 mL). After 10 min, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 for 2.5 days before more diethyl 2-bromoethylphosphonate (0.8546 g) and NEt(iPr)2 (0.74 mL, 4.2 mmol) were added. After stirring for 14 more days, the mixture was evaporated to dryness and dried in vacuo before the residue was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2. The aqueous fraction was extracted with more CH2Cl2, and the combined organic fraction was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. The product was purified by gravity column eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:1% MeOH and then by radial chromatography eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3. The product was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and solidified by evaporation from CH2Cl2 and sonication with Et2O to yield (±)-16.HCl (0.2466 g, 52%): m.p. (HCl salt) 151° C. (dec); 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.24 (t, J=7 Hz, 6H, 2-CH3), 1.93 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 24.3 (complex, 19H, 9-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.8 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 5.96 (d, J=10.2 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 6.69 (br s, 1H, aromatic), 6.87 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.11 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.43 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.64 (m, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 596. Anal. (C, H, N) C29H40N3O4PCl2.2HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 45 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-6-methoxy-7-(N-benzyl-N-methylaminosulfonyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-19)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from (±)-17 (0.6213 g, 1.40 mmol), 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.5764 g, 2.81 mmol), DCC (0.5951 g, 2.88 mmol), and pyr (0.23 mL, 2.88 mmol). The product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:1% MeOH and further purified by radial chromatography eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3. The product was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O to yield (±)-19.HCl (0.3 g, 32%): m.p. (HCl salt) 150° C. (dec); 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) 1.91 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.2 4.1 (complex, 11H, 5-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.55 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 2.77 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.88 (s, 3H, —OCH3), 4.2 (s, 2H, —CH2Ph), 6.0 (d, J=9.7 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 7.10 (s, 1H, aromatic), 7.2-7.4 (complex, 7H, aromatic), 7.55 (m, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 630. Anal. (C, H, N) C32H37N3O4Cl2S.HCl.0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 46 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-7-(N-benzyl-N-methylaminosulfonyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-20)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from (±)-18 (0.4530 g, 1.095 mmol), 3,4-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.4485 g, 2.19 mmol), DCC (0.4677 g, 2.27 mmol), and pyr (0.18 mL, 2.26 mmol). The product was purified by flash column eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3 and then by radial chromatography eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3. The product was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and then washed with hot MeOH to yield (±)-20.HCl (0.33 g, 47%): m.p. (HCl salt) 251-254° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.97 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.3-4.2 (complex, 13H, 6-CH2— and 1-CH—), 2.49 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 2.90 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.17 (d, J=10.4 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 7.2-7.8 (complex, 11H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 600. Anal. (C, H, N)C31H35N3SO3Cl2.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 47 2-(2-Nitro-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-indan-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-24)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from (±)-23 (0.4265 g, 1.971 mmol), 2-nitro-4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.9859 g, 3.943 mmol), DCC (0.8350 g, 4.047 mmol), and pyr (0.33 mL, 4.06 mmol). The crude product was purified by silica gel column eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and crystallized from MeOH to yield (±)-24.HCl (0.3630 g, 38%, first crop): m.p. (HCl salt) 284-287° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.8-2.1 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.84 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3-4.4 (complex, 9H, 4-CH2— and 1-CH—), 6.37 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 7.08 (br s, 1H, aromatic), 7.3 (m, 3H, aromatic), 7.92 (s, 1H, aromatic), 8.41 (s, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 448. Anal. (C, H, N) C22H23N3O3Cl2.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 48 2-(2-Nitro-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-indan-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-26)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from (±)-23 (0.3229 g, 1.492 mmol), 2-nitro-4-trifluoromethylphenylacetic acid (0.5579 g, 2.24 mmol), DCC (0.5512 g, 2.67 mmol), and pyr (0.19 mL, 2.31 mmol). The crude product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and crystallized from MeOH-Et2O to yield (±)-26.HCl (0.3643 g, 50%): m.p. (HCl salt) 249-250° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.8-2.1 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.89 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 34.6 (complex, 9H, 4-CH2— and 1-CH—), 6.40 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 7.1 (br s, 1H, aromatic), 7.3 (m, 3H, aromatic), 7.83 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 8.17 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 8.41 (s, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 448. Anal. (C, H, N) C23H24N3O3F3.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 49 2,2-Diphenyl-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-indan-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-28)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from (±)-23 (0.2615 g, 1.209 mmol), diphenylacetic acid (0.5123 g, 2.41 mmol), DCC (0.5138 g, 2.49 mmol), and pyr (0.20 mL, 2.5 mmol). The crude product was purified by gravity column eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and crystallized from MeOH to yield (±)-28.HCl (0.3815 g, 71%): m.p. (HCl salt)>300° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6; the cis-trans rotamers are observed in about 3.6 to 1 ratio. Only peaks for the major rotamer are reported.) δ1.88 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.75 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 34.2 (complex, 7H, 3-CH2— and 1-CH—), 5.61 (s, 1H, —CH—), 6.5 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H, —CH—), 6.88 (d, J=6.5 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.1-7.4 (complex, 13H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 411. Anal. (C, H, N) C28H30N2O.HCl.0.75H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 50 2-(4-Methylsulfonylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(±)-trans-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-indan-1-yl]acetamide ((±)-29)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from (±)-23 (0.3271 g, 1.51 mmol), 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (0.6464 g, 3.017 mmol), DCC (0.6438, 3.12 mmol), and pyr (0.25 mL, 3.1 mmol). The product was purified by gravity column eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and crystallized from MeOH-Et2O to yield (±)-29.HCl (0.5295 g, 78%): m.p. (HCl salt) 246-248° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.8-2 (br s, 4H, —CH2Cl2—), 2.81 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 2.94.2 (complex, 9H, 4-CH2— and 1-CH—), 3.21 (s, 3H, —SO2CH3), 6.4 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7 (m, 1H, aromatic), 7.3 (m, 3H, aromatic), 7.58 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 2H, aromatic), 7.9 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 413. Anal. (C, H, N)C23H28N2SO3.HCl.0.25H2O.
  • The preparation of a compound of Formula IIA is shown in Example 2a.
  • EXAMPLE 2a (Z)-(±)-trans-[(7-Amino-2-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphth-1-yl)acetamido]4-oxo-butenoic acid
  • Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00054
  • To a solution of 7-amino compound (1)1 (0.266 g, 0.614 mmol) in anhydrous THF (4.5 mL) under a nitrogen atmosphere was added a solution of maleic anhydride (0.0602 g, 0.614 mmol) in anhydrous TH (0.53 mL). The reaction mixture was stirrred at toom temperatature for 20 h and the resulting solid was filtered, washed with THF and ether, and dried in vacuo. The solid was then suspended in hot waer, filtered, and dried to give 2, 0.267 g (82%); mp 221-223° C.; MS (FAB) 530 (M+1); 1H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.50-1.93 (m, 2H), 2.00-3.10 (m, 9H), 2.66 (s, 3H), 3.83 (m, 2H), 5.80 (m, 1H), 6.22 (m, 2H), 7.10 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 7.26 (s, 1H), 7.35 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.48 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 1H), 7.55-7.65 (m, 2H). Anal. (C, H, N) C27H29N3O4Cl2.0.5H2O.
  • Ref.
    • 1. U.S. Pat. No. 5,744,458
  • Compounds of Formula III
  • Compounds having the following structrues were prepared.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00055
  • Compounds 1-5 were prepared by the method described in Chang, A.-C. Ph.D. Thesis, University of Minnesota-Twin Cities, 1995.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00056
  • Compounds 9-19 were prepared from the appropriate arylacetic acids via DCC/pyr coupling, followed by reduction, deprotection, and/or derivatization via known chemistry. Intermediate 8 was prepared via the method described in Chang, A.-C. Ph.D. Thesis, University of Minnesota-Twin Cities, 1995.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00057
  • Intermediate 20 was prepared via minor modifications of known methods.7,8 Compounds 23 (EMD60400) and 24 (EMD61753) are known compounds that were synthesized in-house via minor modifications of reported methods.9 Compounds 21, 22 and 25-27 were prepared by DCC coupling, following by reduction where applicable.
  • Ref.
    • (7) Costello, G. F. et al. J. Med. Chem. 1991, 34, 181-189.
    • (8) Naylor, A. et al. J. Med. Chem. 1994, 37, 2138-2144.
    • (9) Gottschlich, R. et al. Bioorg. Med. Chem. Letters 1994, 4, 677-682.
    EXAMPLE 51 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-[N-(S-aspartic acid-a-amide-S-aspartic acid-a-amido)-3-aminophenyl]-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide (6)
  • With stirring in ice-H2O under N2, 1,3-dicyclohexylcarbodiimide (DCC, 0.353 g, 1.711 mmol) and dry CH2Cl2 (2 mL) were added to a mixture of 5-t-butyl ester (0.311 g, 0.538 mmol), N-Boc-L-aspartic acid-b-t-butyl ester (0.495 g, 1.711 mmol), and 1-hydroxybenzotriazole (HOBT, 0.232 g, 1.717 mmol) in dry CH2Cl2 (8 mL). After 5 min, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 overnight before H2O (1 mL) was added, and the mixture was filtered through celite. The 1,3-dicyclohexylurea (DCU) was washed with CH2Cl2 (18 mL). The filtrate was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2, which was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. After flash column chromatography eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:2% MeOH, the protected intermediate (0.411 g, 90%) was dissolved in 3N HCl (4 mL), AcOH (4 mL) with anisole (2 drops), and stirred at 25° C. overnight. The mixture was then evaporated to dryness, and evaporation from iPrOH then yielded ADL-01-0010-7: 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.1 (br m, 1H, —CH—). MS (FAB) m/z 636. Anal. (C, H, N) C29H35N5O7Cl2.1.5HCl.0.25iPrOH.
  • EXAMPLE 52 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-[N-(bis-methylsulfonamido)-3-aminophenyl]-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl]acetamide (7)
  • With stirring at 25° C., a solution of methanesulfonyl chloride (MsCl, 0.25 mL, 3.2 mmol) in dry CH2Cl2 (0.75 mL) was added to a mixture of ADL-01-0007-3 (0.225 g, 0.554 mmol) and Et3N (1 mL, 7 mmol) in dry CH2Cl2 (4 mL), and the mixture was stirred at 25° C. fitted with a drying tube. After 5 h, more CH2Cl2 (6 mL), MsCl (0.5 mL), and Et3N (2 mL) were added, and the mixture was stirred at 25° C. overnight before it was partitioned between CH2Cl2 (50 mL) and sat'd NaHCO3. The aqueous fraction was extracted with more CH2Cl2 (25 mL), and the combined organic fraction was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. Acetonitrile was used to azeotrope off Et3N before the product was gravity column chromatographed twice eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:2% MeOH. The pure product was then treated with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O to yield 7HCl (0.131 g, 39%, unoptimized): m.p. (HCl salt) 145° C. (dec); 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ 1.7 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.4-3.8 (complex, 8H, 4-CH2—), 2.7 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.37 (s, 6H, 2-SO2CH3), 6.1 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.1-7.4 (complex, 7H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 562. Anal. (C, H, N)C23H29N3O5S2Cl2.HCl.0.75H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 53 2-(2-Nitrophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-nitrophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (10)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from 8 (1.4886 g, 5.97 mmol), 2-nitrophenylacetic acid (2.1619 g, 11.93 mmol), DCC (2.5402 g, 12.31 mmol), and pyridine (1.00 mL, 12.36 mmol). The crude product was converted to the HCl salt with Et2O—HCl without chromatography and crystallized from MeOH-Et2O. The first crop was recrystallized again from MeOH-Et2O to yield 10.HCl (1.3663 g, 51%): m.p. (HCl salt) 258-259° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.97 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.91 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.114.45 (complex, 8H, 4-CHR2—), 6.17 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.51-8.25 (complex, 8H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 413. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H24N4O5.HCl.0.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 54 2-(2-Aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-aminophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (9)
  • With stirring at 55° C., Raney nickel was added in small quantities to a mixture of 10 (0.9857 g, 2.3899 mmol) and hydrazine hydrate (55%, 2 mL) in EtOH (30 mL) until gas evolution stopped in about 10 min. The mixture was then filtered through celite, and the Raney nickel was washed with hot MeOH (100 mL). The filtrate was evaporated and dried in vacuo before the residue was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2, which was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. The product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CHCl3:2% NH3:2% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with Et2O—HCl to yield 9.3HCl (0.3159 g, 29%, unoptimized): m.p. (HCl salt) 219-222° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.98 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.87 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.2-4.3 (complex, 8H, 4-CH2—), 6.1 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.11-7.45 (complex, 8H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 353. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H28N4O.3HCl.0.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 55 2-(N-Diethyl phosphoramidate-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(N-diethyl phosphoramidate-3-aminophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (11)
  • With stirring in ice-H2O under N2, diethyl chlorophosphate (0.53 mL, 3.67 mmol) was added to a mixture of 9 (0.2394 g, 0.6792 mmol) and NEt(iPr)2 (0.77 mL, 4.40 mmol) in dry THF (5 mL). After 10 min, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 for 3.5 days before it was diluted with CH2Cl2, evaporated, and dried in vacuo. The residue was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2. The aqueous fraction was extracted with more CH2Cl2, and the combined organic fraction was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. The product was chromatographed eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:2% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and crystallized from iPrOH-Et2O to yield 11.HCl (0.2364 g, 53%): m.p. (HCl salt) 184-186° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.2 (m, 12H, 4-CH3), 1.96 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.81 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 34 (complex, 16H, 8-CH2—), 6.05 (m, 1H, —CH—), 6.7-7.3 (complex, 9H, aromatic and 1 NH), 8.08 (d, J=9.4 Hz, 1H, NHP). MS (FAB) m/z 625. Anal. (C, H, N) C29H46N4O7P2.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 56 2-(N-Bis-sulfonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(N-bis-sulfonamido-3-aminophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (12)
  • With stirring at 0° C. under N2, MsCl (0.61 mL, 7.87 mmol) was added to a mixture of 9 (0.2774 g, 0.787 mmol) and Et3N (2.2 mL, 15.7 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (8 mL). After 10-15 min, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 overnight before the mixture was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2. The aqueous fraction was extracted with more CH2Cl2, and the combined organic fraction was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. Acetonitrile was added to azeotrope off Et3N. The product was flash-column chromatographed eluting with CH2Cl2: 2% NH3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O to yield 12.HCl (0.3564 g, 65%): m.p. (HCl salt) 180° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.76 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 34.3 (complex, 8H, 4-CH2—), 3.53 (s, 12H, 4-SO2CH3), 6.25 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.3-7.6 (complex, 8H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 665. Anal. (C, H, N) C25H36N4O9S4.HCl.MeOH.
  • EXAMPLE 57 2-(2-Nitro-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-nitrophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (13)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from 8 (0.3690 g, 1.4801 mmol), 2-nitro-4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.7301 g, 2.920 mmol), DCC (0.6213 g, 3.01 mmol), and pyridine (0.24 mL, 3.01 mmol). The crude product was converted to the HCl salt with Et2O—HCl without chromatography and crystallized from MeOH to yield 13.HCl (0.3232 g, 42%): m.p. (HCl salt) 165° C. (dec); 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.93 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.14.3 (complex, 6H, 3-CH2—), 4.4 (s, 2H, benzylic methylene), 6.2 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.7-7.8 (m, 2H, aromatic), 7.9 (s, 1H, aromatic), 8.14 (s, 1H, aromatic), 8.27 (d, J=7.7 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 8.43 (s, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 481. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H22N4O5Cl2.HCl.0.5MeOH.
  • EXAMPLE 58 2-(4-Methylsulfonylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-nitrophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (14)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling procedure from 8 (0.5138 g, 2.061 mmol), 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (0.8825 g, 4.119 mmol), DCC (0.8771 g, 4.251 mmol), and pyridine (0.34 mL, 4.245 mmol). The crude product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CHCl3:2% NH3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and crystallized from MeOH to yield 14.HCl (0.4695 g, 47%): m.p. (HCl salt) 276-277° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.92 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.2 (s, 3H, —SO2CH3), 3.2-4.3 (complex, 8H, 4-CH2—), 6.25 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.61 (d, J=7.2 Hz, 2H, aromatic), 7.75 (m, 2H, aromatic), 7.89 (d, J=7 Hz, 2H, aromatic), 8.12 (s, 1H, aromatic), 8.25 (m, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 446. Anal. (C, H, N) C22H27N3O5S.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 59 2-(N-Butyloxycarbonyl-4-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-nitrophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (18)
  • This compound was prepared via the general DCC/pyr coupling method from 8 (1.9948 g, 8.001 mmol), N-Boc-4-aminophenylacetic acid (3.0589 g, 12.173 mmol), DCC (2.6602 g, 12.89 mmol), and pyridine (1.04 mL, 12.9 mmol). The crude product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CH2Cl2: 2% NH3:1% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and crystallized from MeOH to yield 18.HCl (0.4891 g, 12%, first crop): m.p. (HCl salt) 170° C. (dec); 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.49 (s, 9H, t-butyl), 2.01 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.83 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.1-4.15 (complex, 8H, 4-CH2—), 6.27 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.17 (d, J=8 Hz, 2H, aromatic), 7.39 (d, J=8 Hz, 2H, aromatic), 7.7 (m, 2H, aromatic), 8.09 (s, 1H, aromatic), 8.23 (d, J=6 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 9.3 (s, 1H, —NHBoc). MS (FAB) 483. Anal. (C, H, N) C26H34N4O5.HCl.0.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 60 2-(4-Aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-nitrophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (15)
  • The product from Example 59 (2.9211 g, 6.053 mmol) and anisole (2 drops) were mixed in AcOH (10 mL) and 4N HCl (10 mL) and stirred at 25° C. overnight, fitted with a drying tube. The mixture was adjusted to pH 13 with 1N NaOH with stirring in ice-H2O and then extracted with CH2Cl2 (2×70 mL). The combined organic fraction was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. The product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CHCl3:2% NH3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with Et2O—HCl to yield 15.HCl (0.5531 g, 22%, unoptimized): m.p. (HCl salt) 200° C. (dec); 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.98 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.86 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.24.3 (complex, 8H, 4-CH2—), 6.25 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.16 (d, J=7.4 Hz, 2H, aromatic), 7.33 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 2H, aromatic), 7.7 (m, 2H, aromatic), 8.08 (s, 1H, aromatic), 8.23 (m, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 383. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H26N4O32HCl 0.75H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 61 2-(N-Bis-sulfonamido-4-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-nitrophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (16)
  • With stirring in ice-H2O under N2, a solution of MsCl (1.56 mL, 20.17 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (6 mL) was added dropwise over 2-3 min to a mixture of 15 (1.5430 g, 4.0344 mmol) and Et3N (5.6 mL, 40 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (24 mL). After 10 min, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 overnight before the mixture was partitioned between CH2Cl2 and sat'd NaHCO3. The aqueous fraction was extracted with more CH2Cl2, and the combined organic fraction was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. Acetonitrile was added to azeotrope off Et3N before the crude product was flash column chromatographed eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3. The product was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and washed with hot MeOH to yield 16.HCl (1.3091 g, 56%, first crop): m.p. (HCl salt) 257-259° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.99 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.87 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.154.3 (complex, 8H, 4-CH2—), 3.51 (s, 6H, 2-SO2CH3), 6.25 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.4 (m, 4H, aromatic), 7.7 (m, 2H, aromatic), 8.1 (s, 1H, aromatic), 8.21 (m, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 539. Anal. (C, H, N) C23H30N4O7S2.HCl.0.5CH2Cl2.
  • EXAMPLE 62 2-(N-Bis-sulfonamido-4-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-aminophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (17)
  • This compound was prepared from 16 (1.0729 g, 1.992 mmol), Raney nickel, and hydrazine hydrate (2 mL) in EtOH (30 mL). The conditions were similar to those used for the preparation of 9. The product was gravity column chromatographed eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3, and the pure fractions were converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O to yield 17.HCl (0.1194 g, 11%, unoptimized): m.p. (HCl salt) 252-255° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.86 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.14.2 (complex, 8H, 4-CH2—), 3.54 (s, 6H, 2-SO2CH3), 6.1 (m, 1H, —CH—), 6.8-7.5 (complex, 8H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 509. Anal. (C, H, N) C23H32N4O5S2.1.75HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 63 2-(N-Bis-sulfonamido-4-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(N-diethyl phosphoramidate-3 aminophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (19)
  • With stirring in ice-H2O under N2, diethyl chlorophosphate (0.84 mL, 5.81 mmol) was added to a mixture of 17 (0.7383 g, 1.4514 mmol) and NEt(iPr)2 (1.5 mL, 8.7 mmol) in dry THF (15 mL). After 10 min, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 overnight before more THF (15 mL), NEt(iPr)2 (0.76 mL), and diethyl chlorophosphate (0.42 mL) were sequentially added. After 3 h, the mixture was quenched with H2O, diluted with CH2Cl2, evaporated, and dried in vacuo. The residue was partitioned between CH2Cl2 and sat'd NaHCO3. The aqueous fraction was extracted with more CH2Cl2, and the combined organic fraction was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. The crude product was flash column chromatographed eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:1.5% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and crystallized from MeOH to yield 19.HCl (0.3274 g, 33%): m.p. (HCl salt) 245-247° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.193 (t, J=7 Hz, 6H, 2-CH3), 1.95 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.81 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.14.1 (complex, 12H, 6-CH2—), 3.52 (s, 6H, 2-SO2CH3), 6.1 (m, 1H, —CH—), 6.79 (d, J=7.3 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 6.91 (s, 1H, aromatic), 6.99 (d, J=7.7 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.23 (t, J=7.8 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 7.36 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H, aromatic), 7.44 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 2H, aromatic), 8.09 (d, J=9.4 Hz, 1H, —NHP). MS (FAB) m/z 645. Anal. (C, H, N) C27H41N4O8S2P.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 64 2-(2-Nitrophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)]ethyl}acetamide (21)
  • With stirring at 25° C. under N2, DCC (0.160 g, 0.79 mmol) was added to a mixture of 2-nitrophenylacetic acid (0.140 g, 0.79 mmol) and pyridine (0.064 mL, 0.79 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (1.5 mL). After 3 min, a solution of 20 (0.160 g, 0.72 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (1.5 mL) was added, followed by NEt(iPr)2 (0.375 mL, 2.15 mmol). The mixture was stirred at 25° C. under N2 overnight before sat'd NaHCO3 was added, and the mixture was filtered through celite. The DCU was washed with a little CH2Cl2, and the filtrate was partitioned between sat'd NaHCO3 and CH2Cl2, which was dried (MgSO4), filtered through celite, and evaporated. Toluene was added to azeotrope off pyridine. The product was flash column chromatographed eluting with CHCl3:2% NH3:2% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and crystallized from MeOH to yield 21.HCl (0.14 g, 47%): m.p. (HCl salt) 226-227° C.; 1H NM (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.8-2.4 (m, 2H, —CH2), 2.86 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 34.5 (complex, 8H, 4-CH2—), 5.5 (m, 1H, —CHOH), 6.1 (m, 1H, —CH—), 73-7.8 (complex, 8H, aromatic), 8.11 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 384. Anal. (C, H, N)C21H25N3O4.HCl.0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 65 2-(2-Nitro-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)]ethyl}acetamide (22)
  • This compound was prepared from 20 (0.2 g, 0.91 mmol), 2-nitro-4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (0.45 g, 1.8 mmol), DCC (0.37 g, 1.8 mmol), NEt(iPr)2 (0.48 mL, 2.7 mmol), and pyridine (0.15 mL, 1.8 mmol). The conditions are similar to those for the preparation of 21. The product was column chromatographed eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3:1% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and crystallized from iPrOH to yield 22.HCl (0.060 g, 14%): m.p. (HCl salt) 231-233° C. (dec); 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.8-2.4 (m, 2H, —CH2—), 2.85 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.14.5 (complex, 8H, 4-CH2—), 5.5 (m, 1H, —CHOH), 6.1 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.2-7.5 (m, 5H, aromatic), 7.88 (s, 1H, aromatic), 8.42 (s, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 452. Anal. (C, H, N)C21H23N3O4Cl2.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 66 2-(4-Methylsulfonylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)]ethyl}acetamide (25)
  • This compound was prepared from 20 (0.2 g, 0.91 mmol), 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (0.41 g, 1.8 mmol), DCC (0.37 g, 1.8 mmol), pyridine (0.15 mL, 1.8 mmol), and NEt(iPr)2 (0.48 mL, 2.7 mmol). The conditions are similar to those for the preparation of 21. After stirring at 25° C. overnight, more pyridine (0.075 mL, 0.9 mmol) and DCC (0.18 g, 0.9 mmol) were added, and the reaction was worked up the next day. The product was purified by radial chromatography eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3: 1% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and washed with hot iPrOH to yield 25.HCl (0.15 g, 36%): m.p. (HCl salt) 240-241° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.8-2.4 (m, 2H, —CH2—), 2.8 (d, 3H, —NCH3 of cis and trans amide rotamers), 3.23 (s, 3H, —SO2CH3), 3.1-4.5 (m, 8H, 4-CH2—), 5.5 (m, 1H, —CHOH), 6.15 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.2-7.5 (m, 5H, aromatic), 7.55 (m, 2H, aromatic), 7.85 (m, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 417. Anal. (C, H, N)C22H28N2O4S.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 67 2-(2-Nitro-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)]ethyl}acetamide (26)
  • With stirring at 25° C. under N2, DCC (0.39 g, 1.9 mmol) was added to a mixture of 2-nitro-4-trifluoromethylphenylacetic acid (0.47 g, 1.9 mmol) and pyridine (0.15 mL, 1.9 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (10 mL). After 5 min, a solution of 20 (0.4 g, 1.8 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (5 mL) was added. After 2 h, more DCC (0.1 g, 0.5 mmol) was added, and the mixture was stirred at 25° C. overnight before more 2-nitro-4-trifluoromethylphenylacetic acid (0.045 g, 0.18 mmol) and DCC (0.1 g, 0.5 mmol) were added After 2 h, the reaction was worked up as in the preparation of 21. The product was purified by radial chromatography eluting with CH2Cl2:2% NH3 before it was converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in Et2O and precipitated from CH2Cl2 to yield 26.HCl (0.050 g, 5.4%): 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.8-2.4 (m, 2H, —CH2—), 2.87 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.1-4.5 (complex, 8H, 4-CH2—), 5.5 (m, 1H, —CHOH), 6.1 (m, 1H, —CH—), 7.2-7.5 (m, 5H, aromatic), 7.82 (d, J=7.7 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 8.16 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H, aromatic), 8.42 (s, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 452. Anal. (C, H, N)C22H24F3N3O4.HCl.0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 68 2-(2-Amino-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)]ethyl}acetamide (27)
  • This compound was prepared from 26 (0.14 g, 0.31 mmol), Raney nickel, and hydrazine hydrate (0.2 mL) in EtOH (14 mL). The conditions were similar to those used for the preparation of 9. The product was purified by radial chromatography eluting with CHCl3:2% NH3:2% MeOH before it was converted to the HCl salt with Et2O—HCl to yield 27.HCl (0.11 g, 77%): 1H NMR (DMSO-d6) δ 1.8-2.2 (m, 2H, —CH2—), 2.88 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.1-4.5 (complex, 9H, 4-CH2— and 1-CHOH), 6.2 (m, 1H, —CH—), 6.8-7.5 (complex, 8H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 423. Anal. (C, H, N)C22H26N3O2F3.HCl.2.5H2O.
  • Compounds of Examples 69-91 were prepared from the appropriate arylacetic acids/acid chlorides via EDCI/DIPEA or DCC/pyridine couplings, followed by reduction, deprotection, and/or derivatization via known chemistry. Intermediate A was prepared via the method reported in J. Med. Chem., 34, 1991 pp. 181-189, Costello, G. F. et al.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00058
  • General Procedure for EDCI/DIPEA Coupling.
  • To a solution of acid (1.1 eq.) and 1-Hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (HOBT; 1.1 eq.) in dry CH2Cl in an ice-bath under N2 was added 1-(3-Dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (EDCI; 1.1 eq.). The mixture was stirred for 30 minutes. A solution of the amine (1.0 eq.) in dry methlylene chloride was added drop-wise followed by N,N-Diisopropylethyamine (DIPEA; 1.5 eq.). The solution was allowed to stir at room temperature overnight. The reaction was quenched with sat. sodium bicarbonate and separated from methylene chloride. The organic layer was dried (Na2SO4), filtered through Celite, and evaporated. The crude product was chromatographed and converted to the HCl salt.
  • EXAMPLE 69 2,2-Diphenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • To a solution of Diphenylacetic acid (1.5 g; 7.3 mmol) and pyridine (11.0 mL; 12.2 mmol) in 20 mL of dry methylene chloride at 25 degrees under N2 was added 1,3 dicyclohexylcarbodiimide, DCC (2.0 g; 9.8 mmol). After 5 minutes, 28 (1.0 g; 4.9 mmol) in 20 mL of dry methlylene chloride was added and the mixture was stirred overnight. TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol with 2% ammonia) indicated all of the starting material was consumed. The reaction was quenched with sat. sodium bicarbonate and filtered through a Celite plug. The plug was rinsed with methylene chloride and the aqueous layer was extracted with methylene chloride. The combined organic layers were dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give 2.2 g of a light brown solid. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 8% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 1.7 g (88%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 29 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0(br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.7(s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.2(br m, 1H, —CH—), 7.1-7.5(complex, 15H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 398. Anal. (C, H, N) C27H30N2O.HCl.0.75H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 70 N′,N′-Diphenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]urea
  • To a 0 degree solution of 28 (500 mg; 2.4 mmol) and triethylamine (731 mL; 5.2 mmol) in 10 mL of dry methylene chloride under N2 was added a solution of Diphenylcarbamyl chloride (629 mg; 2.7 mmol) in 5 mL of dry methylene chloride. The solution was warmed to room temperature and stirred overnight. TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol with 2% ammonia) indicated the starting material was consumed. The reaction solution was concentrated to a residue, which was pre-adsorbed onto silica and purified using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 7% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 350 mg (36%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 30 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.5(s, 3H, —NCH3), 5.8(br, m, 1H, —CH—), 7.1-7.5(complex, 15H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 399. Anal. (C, H, N) C26H29N3O.HCl.0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 71 2-(2-Nitrophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the procedure described in the preparation of 29 from 28 (0.6 g; 2.9 mmol), 2-nitrophenylacetic acid (0.8 g; 4.4 mmol), DCC (1.2 g; 5.8 mmol), and pyridine (00.1 mL; 1.4 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 7% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 0.2 g (20%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 31 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR(HCl salt, DMSO-d6) 2.0(br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9(s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.1(br, m, 1H, —CH—)7.3-8.1(complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 367. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H25N3O3.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 72 2-(2-Nitro-4.5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (1.4 g; 6.9 mmol), 2-nitro 4,5-dichlorophenylacetic acid (1.9 g; 7.6 mmol), HOBT (1.0 g; 7.6 mmol), EDCI (1.4 g; 7.6 mmol), and pyridine (0.8 mL; 10.3 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 2.0 g (60%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 32 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR(HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br, s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.1 (br, m, 1H, —CH—), 7.2-7.6 (complex, 5H, aromatic), 7.9 (s, 1H, aromatic), 8.4 (s, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 436. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H23N3O3Cl2.HCl.0.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 73 2-(4-Methylsulfonylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (432 mg; 2. mmol), 4-Methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid (500 mg; 2.3 mmol), HOBT (341 mg; 2.5 mmol), EDCI (483 mg; 2.5 mmol), and DIPEA (0.550 mL; 3.1 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 4% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 160 mg (19%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 33 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br, s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.2 (s, —SO2CH3), 6.1 (br, m, 1H, —CH—), 7.3-7.5 (complex, 5H, aromatic), 7.6 (br, d, 2H, aromatic), 7.9 (br, d, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 400. Anal. (C, H, N) C22H28N2O3S.HCl.0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 74 2-(2-Methoxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (500 mg; 2.4 mmol), 2-Methoxyphenylacetic acid (610 mg; 3.6 mmol), HOBT (495 mg; 3.6 mmol), EDCI (700 mg; 3.6 mmol), and DIPEA (0.850 mL; 4.8 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 7% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 822 mg (96%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 34 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ 1.8 (br, s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.8 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.8 (s, 3H, OCH3), 6.1 (br, m, 1H, —CH—), 6.8-7.4 (complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 352. Anal. (C, H, N) C22H28N2O2.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 75 2-(3-Indolyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (500 mg; 2.4 mmol), Indole-3-acetic acid (641 mg; 3.6 mmol), HOB (494 mg; 3.6 mmol), EDCI (700 mg; 3.6 mmol), and DIPEA (0.637 mL; 3.6 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 7% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 761 mg (88%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 35 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CD3OD) δ 2.1 (br, s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.8 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.3 (br, m, 1H, —CH—), 7.1-7.7 (complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 361. Anal. (C, H, N) C23H27N3O.HCl.1.0H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 76 2-(α,α,α-Trifluoro-p-tolyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (200 mg; 0.9 mmol), (α,α,α-Trifluoro-p-tolyl) acetic acid (239 mg; 1.1 mmol), HOBT (157 mg; 1.1 mmol), EDCI (223 mg; 1.1 mmol), and DIPEA (0.203 mL; 1.1 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 2% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 354 mg (93%) of pure product which was treated with 11.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 36 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 1.8 (br, s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 3.0 (s, 3H, NCH3), 6.4 (br, m, 1H, CH), 7.2-7.6 (complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 390. Anal. (C, H, N) C22H25N2OF3.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 77 2-(2-Nitro-α,α,α-Trifluro-4-tolyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (500 mg; 2.4 mmol), (2-Nitro-α,α,α-trifluro-4-tolyl) acetic acid (728 mg; 2.9 mmol), OBT (395 mg; 2.9 mmol), EDCI (559 mg; 2.9 mmol), and DIPEA (0.510 mL; 2.9 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 10% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 786 mg (74%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 37 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) d 2.0 (br, s, 4H, —CH2CH2), 2.9 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.3 (br, m, 1H, CH), 7.1-7.5 (complex, 4H, aromatic), 7.8-7.9 (br, m, 2H, aromatic), 8.3-8.4 (br, s, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 435. Anal. (C, H, N) C22H24N3O3F3.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 78 2-(1-[4-Chlorobenzoyl)-5-methoxy-2-methyl indole)-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (100 mg; 0.4 mmol), (1-[p-chlorobenzoyl)-5-methoxy-2-methyl indole-3-acetic acid (189 mg; 0.5 mmol), HOBT (73 mg; 0.5 mmol), EDCI (101 mg; 0.5 mmol), and DIPEA (128 mL; 0.7 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 200 mg (79%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 38 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 1.6-1.8 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.3 (b, s, 3H, —CH3), 2.9 (br, s, —NCH3), 3.8 (br, s, 3H, —OCH3), 6.7 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.1-7.6 (complex, 12H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 509. Anal. (C, H, N) C32H35N3O3Cl.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 79 2-(4-Nitrophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (1.5 g; 7.3 mmol), 4-Nitrophenylacetic acid (2.0 g; 11.0 mmol), HOBT (1.4 g; 11.0 mmol), EDCI (2.1 g; 11.0 mmol), and DIPEA (2.5 mL; 14.6 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 2.5 g (93%) of pure product which was treated with 11.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 39 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 1.6 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.8 (br, s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.4 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.1-7.5 (complex, 7H, aromatic), 8.0 (br, d, 2h, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 367. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H25N3O3.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 80 2-(3-Nitrophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-Phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (1.5 g; 7.3 mmol), 3-Nitrophenylacetic acid (2.0 g; 11.0 mmol), HOBT (1.4 g; 11.0 mmol), EDCI (2.1 g; 11.0 mmol), and DIPEA (2.5 mL; 14.6 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 2.6 g (100%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 40 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (br, s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.3 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.2-7.6 (complex, 6H, aromatic), 7.8 (br, d, 1H, aromatic), 8.1-8.2 (complex, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 367. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H25N3O3.HCl.0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 81 2-(2-Pyridyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (350 mg; 1.7 mmol), 2-Pyridylacetic acid hydrochloride (326 mg; 1.8 mmol), HOBT (253 mg; 1.8 mmol), EDCI (360 mg; 1.8 mmol) and DIPEA (0.644 mL; 3.7 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 400 mg (72%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 41 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ 1.7-1.9 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2), 2.8 (br, s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.0-6.2 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.1-7.8 (complex, 8H, aromatic), 8.5 (br, d, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 323. Anal. (C, H, N) C20H25N3O.2HCl.0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 82 2-(3-Pyridyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (120 mg; 0.5 mmol), 3-Pyridylacetic acid hydrochloride (110 mg; 0.6 mmol), HOBT (85 mg; 0.6 mmol), EDCI (120 mg; 0.6 mmol), and DIPEA (0.280 mL; 1.5 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 6% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 142 mg (76%) of pure product which was treated with 11.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 42 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ2.1 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (br, s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.2-6.3 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.2-7.3 (complex, 5H, aromatic), 7.8-7.9 (br, t, 1H, aromatic), 8.6-8.9 (complex, 3H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 323. Anal. (C, H, N) C20H25N3O.2HCl.1.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 83 2-((±)-6-Methoxy-a-methyl-2-napthalene)-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (200 mg; 0.9 mmol), (±)-6-Methoxy-α-methyl-2-naphaleneacetic acid (217 mg; 1.0 mmol), HOBT (142 mg; 1.0 mmol), EDCI (201 mg; 1.0 mmol), and DIPEA (0.256 mL; 1.4 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 2% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 130 mg (33%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 43 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 1.4 (d, 3H, —CH3), 2.9 (br, s, —NCH3), 3.9 (s, —OCH3), 5.5 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.0-7.7 (complex, 11H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 416. Anal. (C, H, N) C27H32N2O2.HCl. 0.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 84 2-(α,α,α-Trifluoro-3-tolyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (200 mg; 0.9 mmol), (α,α,α-Trifluoro-m-tolyl) acetic acid (214 mg; 1.0 mmol), HOBT (142 mg; 1.0 mmol), EDCI (201 mg; 1.0 mmol), and DIPEA (0.256 mL; 1.4 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 6% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 250 mg (67%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 44 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (br, s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.4 (br, m, 1H), 7.1-7.7 (complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 390. Anal. (C, H, N) C22H25N2OF3.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 85 2-(4-Pyridyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (120 mg; 0.5 mmol), 4-Pyridylacetic acid hydrochloride (150 mg; 0.8 mmol), HOBT (117 mg; 0.8 mmol), EDCI (166 mg; 0.8 mmol), and DIPEA (0.202 mL; 1.1 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride to afford 172 mg (92%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 45 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 2.1 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (br, s, —NCH3), 6.3 (br, m, —CH), 7.2-7.3 (complex, 5H, aromatic), 7.8 (br, s, 2H, aromatic), 8.6 (br, s, 2H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 323. Anal. (C, H, N) C20H25N3O.1.5HCl.0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 86 2-(α,α,α-Trifluoro-2-tolyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (200 mg; 0.9 mmol), (α,α,α-Trifluoro-o-tolyl)acetic acid (239 mg; 1.1 mmol), HOBT (157 mg; 1.1 mmol), EDCI (223 mg; 1.1 mmol), and DIPEA (0.203 mL; 1.1 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 4% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 339 mg (82%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 46 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H—CH2CH2—), 2.9 (br, s, —NCH3), 6.3 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.1-7.7 (complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 390. Anal. (C, H, N) C22H25N2OF3.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 87 2-((S)-(±)-4-Isobutyl-a-methylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (200 mg; 0.9 mmol), (S)-(±)-4-Isobutyl-α-methylphenylacetic acid (217 mg; 1.0 mmol), HOBT (142 mg; 1.0 mmol), EDCI (201 mg; 1.0 mmol), and DIPEA (0.256 mL; 1.4 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 2% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 240 mg (66%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 47 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 0.8 (d, 6H, —(CH3)2), 1.4 (d, 2H, —CH3), 2.0 (br, m, —CH2CH2—), 2.3-2.4 (d, 2H, —CH2—), 2.9 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 5.6 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.0 (br, q, 4H, aromatic), 7.3 (br, s, 5H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 392. Anal. (C, H, N)C26H36N2O.HCl.0.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 88 2-(3,4,5-Trimethoxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • This compound was prepared via the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from 28 (250 mg; 1.2 mmol), 3,4,5-Trimethoxyphenylacetic acid (304 mg; 1.3 mmol), HOBT (181 mg; 1.3 mmol), EDCI (256 mg; 1.3 mmol), and DIPEA (0.318 mL; 1.8 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 500 mg (100%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 48 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ 1.7 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.7 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.8 (d, 9H, —OCH3), 6.0-6.2 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 6.4 (s, 2H, aromatic), 7.1-7.3 (complex, 5H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 412. Anal. (C, H, N) C24H32N2O4.HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 89 2-(2-Aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • Raney-Nickel (50% slurry in water) was added to a mixture of 31 (2.30 g; 6.1 mmol), 2.2 mL (61.9 mmol) of hydrazine hydrate and 45 mL of abs. EtOH at 55 degrees to maintain a regular gas evolution. After 45 min., TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol w/ 2% ammonia) indicated that all of the starting material was consumed. The mixture was filtered through a Celite plug and rinsed with copious amounts of hot methanol. The filtrates were combined and concentrated in vacuo to afford 270 mg of a waxy solid. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 8% methanol:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 2.01 g (97%) of desired product. The pure product was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to yield 49 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.1 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.2 (complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 321. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H27N3O.2HCl.0.75H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 90 2-(2-N,N-Dimethylsulfonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • To a solution of 49 (400 mg; 1.1 mmol) in 50 ml of dry methylene chloride was added 429 mL of triethylamine and MsCl (913 mL; 11.8 mmol) dissolved in 6 mL of dry methylene chloride. The dark red solution was allowed to stir overnight. TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol w/ 2% ammonia) indicates the starting material is consumed. The reaction solution was quenched with sat. sodium bicarbonate and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with methylene chloride and the combined organic layers were dried over anh. sodium sulfate, filtered and the solvent was concentrated in vacuo to give 700 mg of a dark brown residue. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 7% methanol:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 580 mg (97%) of desired product. The pure product was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to yield 50 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.7 (br, s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.5 (br, s, (—SO2CH3)2), 6.2 (br, d, 1H, —CH), 7.2-7.5 (complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 493. Anal. (C, H, N) C23H31N3O5S2.HCl.0.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 91 2-(N-Methylsulfonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • To a solution of 50 (500 mg; 1.0 mmol) in 6 mL of 2:1 MeOH:THF was added 4.0 mL of 1.0M NaOH. The solution was stirred for 20 min., after which TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol w/ 2% ammonia) indicates the reaction is complete. The reaction was quenched with 10% HCl and washed with water and brine. The organic layer was dried over anh. sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give 381 mg of a brown solid. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 4% methanol:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 326 mg (80%) of desired product. The pure product was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to yield 51 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (br, s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.0 (s, 3H, —SO2CH3), 6.3 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.0-7.2 (complex, 8H, aromatic), 7.5 (br, d, 1H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 415. Anal. (C, H, N) C22H29N3O3S.HCl.0.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 92 2-(2-Amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • To a solution of 32 (495 mg; 1.0 mmol) in 25 mL of abs. EtOH was added 50 mg of 10% Pd/C. The mixture was placed on a Parr apparatus under 10 psi of hydrogen. After 1 h, TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol) indicates no starting material remains. The mixture was filtered through a Celite plug and basified with aq. ammonium hydroxide. The solvent was concentrated in vacuo to get a residue which was dissolved in EtOAc and washed repeatedly with water. The organic layer was dried over anh. sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to give 200 mg of crude free base. The crude product was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether and dried in a vacuum oven at 80 degrees overnight to recover 120 mg (30%) of 52 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 1.6-1.7 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.7 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 5.9-6.1 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.1-7.2 (complex, 7H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 406. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H25N3OCl2.HCl.1.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 93 2-(N,N-Dimethysulfonamido-2-amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • Same procedure as 50 using 223 mg (0.54 mmol) of 52, 0.5 mL (6.4 mmol) of MsCl, 2.0 mL (14.3 mmol) of triethylamine and 25 mL of dry methylene chloride. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 3% MeOH:methylene chloride to yield 150 mg (49%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 53 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.8 (s, 3H, NCH3), 3.3 (d, 6H, —(SO2CH3)2), 6.2 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.0-7.1 (complex, 2H, aromatic), 7.3 (complex, 5H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 562. Anal. (C, H, N) C23H29N3O5S2Cl2. HCl. 0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 94 2-(2-Amino,α,α,α-Trifluoro-4-toly)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • Same procedure as 49 using 710 mg (1.6 mmol) of 37, 0.5 mL (16.3 mmol) of hydrazine hydrate in 50 mL of EtOH. The recovered product, 650 mg (98% crude recovery) was not purified any further. A small amount of the desired product was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to form 54 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9. (br, s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.3 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.2-7.5 (complex, 8H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 405. Anal. (C, H, N) C22H26N3OF3 1.5 HCl.
  • EXAMPLE 95 2-(2-N,N-Dimethylsulfonamido-2-amino-α,α,α-trifluoro-4-tolyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • Same procedure as 50 using 100 mg (0.24 mmol) of 54, 0.2 mL (2.4 mmol) of MsCl, 0.8 mL (6.3 mmol) of triethylamine and 13 mL of dry methylene chloride. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride to yield 110 mg (80%) of desired product. A small amount of compound was treated with 1.0M HCl in diethyl ether to give 55 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.3 (d, 6H, —(SO2CH3)2), 6.3 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.1-8.0 (complex, 8H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 497. Anal. (C, H, N) C24H30N3OF3S2.HCl.0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 96 2-(N-Methylsulfonamido-2-amino-α,α,α-trifluro-4-tolyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • Same procedure as 51 using 51 mg (0.1 mmol) of 55, 30 mL of 1.0M NaOH and 1.9 mL of 2:1 MeOH:THF. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to yield 27 mg (63%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to form 56 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (br, s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.1 (br, s, 3H, —SO2CH3), 7.1-7.3 (complex, 8H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 483. Anal. (C, H, N) C23H28N3O3SF3.HCl.0.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 97 2-(2-Aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • Same procedure as 49 using 2.6 g (7.1 mmol) of 40, 2.5 mL (80.2 mmol) of hydrazine hydrate in 70 mL of EtOH. The recovered product, 1.8 g was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 9% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to yield 1.1 g (47%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to give 57 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ 1.7-1.9 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.7 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.1 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 6.5-6.8 (complex, 3H, aromatic), 7.0 (m, 2H, aromatic), 7.3 (complex, 4H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 337. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H27N3O.2HCl.0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 98 2-(4-Aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • Same procedure as 49 using 2.3 g (6.3 mmol) of 39, 2.4 mL (75.4 mmol) of hydrazine hydrate in 70 mL of EtOH. The recovered product, 1.7 g was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 3% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to yield 1.53 g (73%) of pure product. A small amount of compound was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to give 58 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ 1.8 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.7 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.1 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 6.7 (m, 2H, aromatic), 7.0 (d, 2H, aromatic), 7.3 (complex, 5H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 337. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H27N3O.2HCl.0.75H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 99 2-(N,N-Dimethylsulfonamido-3-aminophenyl-N-meth yl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]-acetamide
  • Same procedure as 50 using 500 mg (1.5 mmol) of 57, 1.1 mL (14.8 mmol) of MsCl, 3.0 mL (22.2 mmol) of triethylamine and 8.0 mL of dry methylene chloride. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 4% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to yield 308 mg (42%) of pure product. A small amount of compound was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to give 59 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ 1.8 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.8 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.4 (s, 6H, (—SO2CH3)2), 6.1 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.0-7.5 (complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 493. Anal. (C, H, N) C23H31N3O5S2.HCl
  • EXAMPLE 100 (2-(N,N-Dimethylsulfonamido-4-aminophenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide)
  • Same procedure as 50 using 400 mg (1.2 mmol) of 58, 0.55 mL (7.1 mmol) of MsCl, 1.6 mL (11.8 mmol) of triethylamine and 12.0 mL of dry methylene chloride. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 5% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to yield 395 mg (68%) of pure product. The compound was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to give 60 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ 1.8 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.8 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 3.4 (s, 6H, (—SO2CH3)2), 6.1 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 7.0-7.5 (complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 493. Anal. (C, H, N) C23H31N3O5S2.HCl.0.25H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 101 2-(2-Hydroxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-Pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • To a solution of 34 (700 mg; 1.8 mmol) in 10 mL of dry methylene chloride @ 78° C. was added 10.8 mL (10.8 mmol; 1.0M solution of BBr3 in methylene chloride) over 15 minutes. The reaction mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature and stir overnight. TLC (95:5 methylene chloride: MeOH w/ 2% ammonia) indicated no starting material remained. The reactionn was quenched with the addition of MeOH at 0 degrees. After 30 minutes, 3N HCl was added and the mixture was stirred for 30 minutes (white precipitate seen). The mixture was made neutral with sat. bicarbonate and extracted with methylene chloride (3×100 MmL). The organic layer was dried over anh. sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give 610 mg of crude product. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 3% MeOH:methylene chloride to yield 500 mg (82%) of pure product. The product was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to give 61 as the HCl salt. 1H NMR (free base, CDCl3) δ1.7 (br, m, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (s, 3H, —NCH3), 6.1 (br, m, 1H, —CH), 6.8-7.4 (complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 338. Anal. (C, H, N) C21H26N2O2.HCl.0.5H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 102 N-Methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-((3S)-3-hydroxypyrrolidine-1-yl)ethyl]-3,4,5-trimethoxyphenylacetamide HCl
  • To a solution of 3,4,5-trimethoxyphenylaetic acid (1.0 g, 4.43 mmol) in 10 mL of CH2Cl2 under a nitrogen atmosphere was added pyridine (0.12 g, 1.5 mmol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (Hunig's Base) (0.57 g, 4.43 mmol). The reaction mixture was cooled to 0° C. and DCC (1.37 g, 6.65 mmol) was added in one portion. The reaction mixture was stirrred at this temperature and a solution of the diaminel (0.65 g, 3.0 mmol) in 10 mL of CH2Cl2 was added and the stirring was continued while warming to room temperature for 20 h. The reaction mixture was poured onto an aqueous saturated solutoin of NaHCO3 and the mixture was stirred for 30 min. The organic layer was separated and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. After removal of the solvent, the product was purifed on a silica gel column [solvent system: CHCl3:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (98:2:2)]. The free base was converted to the hydrochloride salt from 1M etherial HCl and recrystallized form CH2Cl2:Et2O (1:1) to give a HCl 0.64 g (46%) as light pink solid; mp 230-232° C.; 1H-NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 2.20 (m, 4H), 2.85 (s, 3H), 3.004.30 (m, 5H), 3.70 (ms, 9H), 4.50 (m, 2H), 5.30 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 6.50 (m, 3H), 7.28 (m, 5H). Anal. Calcd for C24H32N2O5.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 61.40; H, 7.19; N, 5.97. Found: C, 61.36; H, 6.84; 8.96; N, 5.91.
  • The structure of the compound is shown hereunder.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00059
  • The preparation of compounds 3a through 3ddd of formula MA follow according to Schemes G, H, I, J, K, L, M, and N.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00060
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00061
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00062
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00063
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00064
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00065
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00066
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00067
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00068
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00069
  • EXAMPLE 3a 2-(2-N-Methylsulfonamido-4,5-dichlorophenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • 2-(N,N-Dimethylsulfonamido-2-amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (for preparation see U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955) 130 mg; 0.22 mmol was treated with 0.2 mL of 10 M NaOH in 3.0 mL of 2:1 MeOH:THF as described in the preparation of 3rr. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 4% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to give 100 mg (95%) of desired product which was treated with 1.0 M HCl to aford 3a as a tan solid. Mp 140-142° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.8 (s, 3H, NCH3), 3.1 (s, 3H, SO2CH3), 3.6-3.8 (m, 2H), 4.04.3 (q, 2H), 6.0-6.2 (dd, 1H), 7.2-7.6 (complex, 5H, aromatic), 7.7-7.9 (d, 2H), 9.5 (s, NH). MS (FAB) m/z 483. Anal. (C, H, N) Calcd. for C22H29N3O3Cl2S.HCl 0.25H2O: C, 50.73; H, 5.42; N, 8.07. Found: C, 49.32; H, 5.52; N, 7.58.
  • EXAMPLE 3b N-[(4-Trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl)]ethyl}acetamido]glycine hydrochloride
  • To a stirred solution of bromoacetic acid (0.75 g, 5.42 mmol) in anhydrous CH3CN (20 mL) was added N,N-diisopropylethylamine (1.41 g, 11.0 mmol) under a nitrogen atmosphere. After addition of 2-(2-Amino-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl)]ethyl}acetamide1 (2.0 g, 4.93 mmol) in anhydrous CH3CN (10 mL) to the reaction mixture, it was heated to 70° C. for 6 days. TLC [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (95:5:2)] of the reaction mixture showed that still some starting material was present. The reaction mixture was cooled to room temperature and solvent was evaporated to dryness. The residue was partioned between CH2Cl2 and water, organic layer was separated, dried over anhydrous Na2SO4, and evaporated to dryness to give the crude mixture. The residue was crystallized from acetone and acetonitrile (1:1) to give the desired compound as a white solid 0.6 g which was still contaminated with minor amounts of the starting material.
  • The product 3b was finally purified on Chromatotran (precoated silica plate) using solvent acetone:water (9:1) and recrystallized from acetonitrile to give the product as a white solid, 0.35 g (15%); mp 228-230° C. (d); MS (FAB) 464 (M+1); 1H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 2.16 (m, 4H), 2.88 (s, 3H), 3.474.00 (m, 9H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 4.95 (m, 1H), 6.34 (d, J=9.0 Hz. 1H), 6.82 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.02 (s, 1H), 7.18 (d, J=7.7 Hz, 1H), 7.55 (m, 5H). Anal. Calcd. for C24H28F3N3O3.0.25H2O: C, 61.59; H, 6.14; N, 8.98. Found: C, 61.54; H, 6.10; N, 9.36.
  • Ref.
      • U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955 (1997).
    EXAMPLE 3c 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1R,S)-1-(3-sulfamidophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • A solution of compound 11 (203 mg, 0.5 mmol) and sulfamide (480 mg, 5 mmol) in dioxane (15 ml) was refluxed for 4 hours in oil bath. After removal of dioxane, the residue was partitioned between NaOH (1N, 50 ml) and CHCl3 (50 ml). The aqueous layer was extracted with CHCl3 (2×25 ml), and the combined extract was washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4). Silica column chromatography of crude material gave a pure product that was converted to hydrochloric acid salt with HCl/ether (164 mg, 64%). Mp: 198-200° C. Spectral data: 1H NMR (DMSO-d6) 1.97 (m, 4H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.12 (m, 2H), 3.52-3.66 (m, 3H), 3.72 (d, J=16.5 Hz, 1H), 4.014.10 (m, 2H), 6.04 (d, J=11.0 Hz, 1H), 6.88 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (s, 1H), 7.17 (m, 1H), 7.29 (m, 1H), 7.55 (d, J=4.5 Hz, 1H), 9.10 (s, 1H). Fab MS (MH+): 485. Anal. Calcd For C21H26N4O3Cl2S.HCl: C, 48.33; H, 5.21; N, 10.74. Found: C, 48.31; H, 5.21; N, 10.59.
  • EXAMPLE 3d 2-(4-Trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-[3-[(methylsulfonyl)amino]phenyl]-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • 4-Trifluormethylphenyl acetic acid was condensed with (1S)-1-[2-(methylamino)-2-(3-nitrophenyl)-ethyl]pyrrolidine following the methods described in the literature1 to give the intermediate, 3-nitro-derivative in 95% yield, 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.68 (m, 4H), 2.35-3.30 (m, 6H), 2.71 (s, 3H), 3.85 (m, 2H), 6.20 (m, 1H), 7.49 (m, 7H), 8.10 (s, 1H). The nitro group was reduced again following the method described in literature (Raney Ni/hydrazine hydrate) to corresponding 3-amino derivative in nearly quantitative yield.
  • To a solution of the above 3-amino compound (2.9 g, 7.15 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (30 mL) was added triethyl amine (3.62 g, 35.76 mmol) and the reaction mixture was cooled to in an ice-bath. Methane sulfonyl chloride (2.46 g, 21.45 mmol) was added dropwise in 15 min and the ice-bath was removed. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 72 h. The reaction mixture was quenched with addition of water, organic layer was separated, washed with water, saturated NaHCO3, saturated salt solution, and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. Removal of solvent gave 3-N-(bis-methylsulfonamide) derivative as a foam which was used directly into the following reaction.
  • The above compound (4.0 g, 7.12 mmol) was dissolved in CH3OH:THF (2:1, 32 mL) and stirred at room temperature. Sodium hydroxide (10 M aqueous solution) (1.29 g, 32.26 mmol) was added and stirred at room temperature for 20 min [TLC, solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (95:5:2)]. Reaction mixture was neutralized with the addition of 1N HCl and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure. The residue was redissolved in ethyl acetate, washed with saturated NaHCO3, saturated salt solution, and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. Removal of the solvent under reduced pressure gave a yellow foam which was purified on a silica gel column [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (95:5:2)]. The hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl and recrystallized from 2-propano:ether (1:1) to give 3d as a cream colored solid in 45% yield; mp 173-175° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.65 (m, 4H), 2.30-3.15 (m, 6H), 2.67 (s, 3H), 2.86 (s, 3H), 3.80 (m, 2H), 6.05 (m, 1H), 7.00-7.25 (m, 4H), 7.35 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 2H), 7.50 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H). Anal. Calcd. for C23H28F3N3O3S.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 55.22; H, 5.72; N, 7.94. Found: C, 52.17; H, 5.61; N, 7.96.
  • EXAMPLE 3e 2-(4-Methanesulfonylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-[3-[(methylsulfonyl)amino]phenyl]-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide methanesulfonate
  • The compound was prepared from 4-methylsulfonylphenyl acetic acid following the procedure described for 3d. The methane sulfonic acid salt was recrystallized from CH2Cl2:ether to give 3e as a beige colored solid in 32% yield; mp 140-142° C.; 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 2.00 (m, 4H), 2.40 (s, 3H), 2.78 (s, 3H), 2.97 (s, 3H), 3.20 (s, 3H), 3.404.10 (m, 6H), 3.94 (d, J=5.5 Hz, 2H), 6.10 (m, 1H), 7.00 (d, J=5.8 Hz, 1H), 7.15 (s, 1H), 7.20 (t, J=6.0 Hz, 1H), 7.35 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 1H), 7.50 (d, J=12.5 Hz, 2H), 7.85 (d, J=12.0 Hz, 2H). Anal. Calcd. for C23H31N3O5S2.CH3SO3H. 2.0H2O: C, 46.06; H, 6.28; N, 6.71. Found: C, 45.99; H, 6.03; N, 6.55.
  • EXAMPLE 3f 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-[3-[(methylsulfonyl)amino]phenyl]-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-([1S]-1-[3-(bis-methylsulfonyl)amino]phenyl]-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide1 (1.8 g, 3.2 mmol) was dissolved in CH3OH:THF (2:1, 90 mL) and added 10 M NaOH solution (0.58 g, 14.5 mmol). The reaction was followed by TLC [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (95:5:2)] and worked up as described in case of 3d to give the crude product as a foam. The compound was purified on a silica gel column [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (95:5:2)] and the hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl. Recrystallization of the salt from CH2Cl2:ether (1:1) gave 3f as a beige colored solid, 0.57 g (35%); mp 240-242° C. Anal. Calcd. for C22H27Cl2N3O3S.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 50.29; H, 5.47; N, 8.00. Found: C, 50.63; H, 5.26; N, 7.66
  • EXAMPLE 3g 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-[3-(diethyl Phosphoryl)amino]phenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1 S]-1-(3-aminophenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}-acetamide1 (0.411 g, 1.011 mmol) was dissolved in anhydrous THF (8 mL) and cooled in an ice-bath under a nitrogen atmosphere. Diisopropylethylamine (1.06 mL, 6.07 mmol) was added followed diethyl chlorophosphate (0.58 mL, 4.045 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 48 h, quenched with the addition of water, and evaporated to dryness. The residue was partitioned between CH2Cl2 and saturated NaHCO3 solution. The organic layer was separated, dried over anhydrous sodium sulphate, and evaoparted under reduced pressure to give the crude product. The compound was purified on a silica gel column [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (99:1:2)] and converted to the hydrochloride salt from 1M etherial HCl to give 3g, 0.44 g (81%); mp 140-142° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.18 (t, J=8.0 Hz, 3H), 1.95 (m, 4H), 2.77 (s, 3H), 3.004.20 (m, 12H), 6.05 (m, 1H), 6.75 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 6.88 (s, 1H), 7.00 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 7.25 (m, 2H), 7.53 (m, 2H), 8.05 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C25H34Cl2N3O4P.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 51.07; H, 6.17; N, 7.15. Found: C, 50.91; H, 5.93; N, 6.97.
  • EXAMPLE 3h
  • 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-[3-[(4-oxo-butenoate)]amino]phenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-(3-aminophenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}-acetamide1 (0.0.347 g, 0.855 mmol) was dissolved in anhydrous THF (8 mL) under a nitrogen atmosphere and added a solution of maleic anhydride (0.084 g, 0.855 mmol) in anhydrous THF (1 mL) at room temperature. The reaction mixture was stirred at this temperature for 24 h and the resulting solid was filtered, washed with THF and ether. The solid was dried under vacuum to give 3h, (0.274 g, 63%); mp 174-176° C.; MS 504 (m/z); 1H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.79 (m, 4H), 2.72 (s, 3H), 2.85-3.85 (m, 6H), 5.95 (m, 1H), 6.10 (m, 1H), 6.25 (m, 1H), 6.95 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.28 (m, 2H), 7.55 (m, 4H). Anal. Calcd. for C25H27Cl2N3O4.0.25H2O: C, 59.00; H, 5.45; N, 8.26. Found: C, 58.69; H, 5.18; N, 8.01.
  • EXAMPLE 3i 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{(1S)-1-[3-(3-(((iso-butoxycarbonyl)-methyl)aminocarbonyl)propionamido)phenyl]-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • A solution of compound 1 (222 mg, 0.546 mmol) in CH2CL2 (10 ml) at 0° C. was treated with succinic anhydride (82 mg, 0.819 mmol). The mixture was allowed to warm up to room temperature and stirred for 18 hours. The solvent was removed by rotary evaporation and the residue was recrystallized from ethyl acetate and hexane (249 mg, 89%).
  • A mixture of the above compound (246 mg, 0.486 mmol), 1-hydroxybenzotriazole monohydrate (98 mg, 0.729 mmol), and p-toluenesulfonic acid salt of 2-methylpropyl glycine (221 mg, 0.729 mmol) in THF (5 ml) was treated with Et3N (0.102 ml, 0.729 mmol), followed by dicyclohexylcarbodiimide (150 mg, 0.729 mmol) in THF (2 ml). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 48 hours, cooled in ice bath, and filtered. The filtrate was concentrated, dissolved in ethyl acetate, and the solution was washed with aqueous NaHCO3 (saturated), water, brine, dried (Na2SO4). After concentration, the residue was allowed to pass through a silica column eluted with 2% MeOH in CH2Cl2 (2% ammonia). 216 mg of the desired product was obtained (72%) and part of the product was converted to the hydrochloric acid salt (compound 3i, 67 mg). Mp: 85° C. (decomposed). Spectral data: 1H NMR (DMSO-d6) δ 0.86 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 6H), 1.84 (m, 1H), 1.97 (m, 4H), 2.40-2.50 (m, 4H), 2.77 (s, 3H), 3.14 (m, 1H), 3.47-3.70 (m, 3H), 3.75-3.83 (m, 5H), 3.984.14 (m, 2H), 6.06 (d, J=10.0 Hz, 1H), 6.93 (d, J=7.7 Hz, 1H), 7.30 (m, 2H), 7.50-7.57 (m, 4H), 8.37 (bs, 1H). Fab MS (MH+): 485. Anal. Calcd for C31H40N45Cl2.HCl.1.2H2O: C, 54.94; H, 6.46; N, 8.27. Found: C, 54.94; H, 6.43; N, 8.28.
  • EXAMPLE 3j 2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{(1R,S)-1-[3-(3-(((hydroxycarbonyl)-methyl)aminocarbonyl)propionamido)phenyl]-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • A solution of compound 3i (144 mg, 0.233 mmol) in ethanol (3 ml) and water (1 ml) was cooled in ice bath and treated with NaOH (1N, 0.7 ml) slowly. After stirring at room temperature for 1 hour, the solution was adjusted to pH=5 with 6N HCl. The mixture was stirred for 2 hours and then concentrated. The residue was separated by reversed phase TLC plate to give the final product (114 mg, 80%). Mp: 158° C. (decomposed). Spectral data: 1H NMR (DMSO-d6) δ 1.65 (bs, 4H), 2.40-2.64 (m, 4H), 2.70 (s, 3H), 3.11 (m, 2H), 3.33 (m, 2H), 3.71 (m, 3H), 3.86 (d, J=16.0 Hz, 1H), 5.81 (dd, J=9.9, 4.9 Hz, 1H), 6.94 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H), 7.23 (t, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.48-7.56 (m, 4H), 8.17 (bs, 1H), 9.95 (s, 1H). Fab MS (MH+): 563. Anal. Calcd for C27H32N4O5Cl2.HCl.0.75H2O: C, 52.79; H, 5.68; N, 9.12. Found: C, 52.83; H, 5.92; N, 9.10.
  • EXAMPLE 3k 2-[(2-N-Phenylsulfonamido)-phenyl)]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide methane sulfonate
  • 2-(2-Aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (for preparation see U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955) 1.2 g (3.55 mmol) was stirred in 30 mL of dry CH2Cl2 at 0° C. Triethylamine (0.5 mL; 3.55 mmol) and benzenesulfonyl chloride (0.45 mL; 3.55 mmol) in 10 mL of dry CH2Cl2 were added. After the addition the reaction solution was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred overnight. TLC (90:10 methylene chloride:methanol w/ 2% ammonia) indicated the reaction was incomplete. 0.22 mL (1.7 mmol) of the chloride and 0.25 mL (1.7 mmol) of the base were added at 0° C. The solution was stirred for 24 h at room temperature before it was complete. The reaction was quenched with sat. sodium bicarbonate and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give 1.9 g of crude product which was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 7% MeOH:methylene chloride w/ 2% ammonia to yield 1.2 g of bis-alkylated product which was hydrolyzed using the same preparation as 3rr to afford 900 mg (53%) of desired product which was treated with 1.0 eq. of methanesulfonic acid to give 3k as a tan solid. mp 205-207° C.; 1H NMR (mesylate salt, CDCl3) δ 1.8 (br m, 1H), 2.1 (br d, 2H), 2.2 (br t, 2H), 2.8 (s, 3H, NCH3), 3.1 (t, 1H), 4.0-4.3 (d, 2H), 6.2 (dd, 1H), 7.0 (d, 2H), 7.1 (m, 2H), 7.30 (complex, 5H, aromatic), 7.4 (d, 1H), 7.5 (d, 1H), 7.9 (d, 2H), 9.0 (s, 1H), 10.3(br, NH). MS (FAB) m/z 477. Anal. (C, H, N) Calcd. for C27H31N3O3S CH3SO3H: C, 58.62; H, 6.15; N, 7.32. Found: C, 58.66; H, 6.20; N, 7.27.
  • General procedure for the preparation of N-methyl sulfamoyl derivatives of phenyl acetic acids
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00070
  • To a stirred ice-cold chlorosulfonic acid (43.82 g, 0.376 mol) under anhydrous condition was added dropwise methyl phenylacetate (6.23 g, 0.042 mol). When addition was completed, the reaction mixture was then stirred at room temperature and the progress of the reaction was monitored by TLC [solvent: hexane:ethyl acetate (4:1)] [In this case the reaction was over in 30 min and however depending upon the substitution (X=H) of the aromatic ring, reaction may take from 12 to 72 h at room temperature]. Reaction mixture was then carefully poured on ice-water and the product was extracted with ether several times. The combined etherial solution was washed with water, saturated salt solution, and dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate. Removal of ether under reduced pressure resulted in a mixture of 2- and 4-chlorosulfonyl compounds (63-85% yields) (chlorosulfonation was also depended upon the directing effects of the X group) which were used directly into next reaction.
  • To a stirred solution of methyl amine (19.5 ml, 2 M in THF, 0.039 mol) at 0° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere was added a solution of above chlorosulfonyl derivative (3.25 g, 0.013 mo) in anhydrous THF (10 mL). Reaction mixture was stirred 15 min at this temperature and 1-4 h at room temperature by this time TLC [solvent: hexane:ethyl acetate (4:1)] showed no starting material was present. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was partioned between ethyl acetate and water. The organic layer was separated washed with saturated salt solution, dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, and evaporated to dryness to give methyl sulfonamide derivative (90-96% yield). In most cases this product was pure enough to proceed to next step, otherwise purified on a silica gel column before the hydrolysis of the ester.
  • The methyl sulfonamide ester (3.0 g, 12.34 mmol) was suspended in 3N aqueous HCl and heated to reflux with stirring for 24 h. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was re-dissolved in CH2Cl2, filtered, and concentrated to a small volume. Addition of either ether or hexane gave compound A in 80-95% yield and these acids were used in the condensation reactions.
  • EXAMPLE 3l 2-[3-(N-Methylsulfamoyl)-4-chlorophenyl]-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • To a solution of 3-(N-methylsulfamoyl)-4-chlorophenyl acetic acid (prepared from 4-chlorophenyl acetic acid, 1.58 g, 6.0 mmol) in anhydrous CH2Cl2 (20 mL) under a nitrogen atmosphere was add N-hydroxybezotriazole (0.81 g, 6.0 mmol). Reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 15 min then cooled in an ice-bath and added 1-(3-diethylaminoprpyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (1.165 g, 6.0 mmol). Stirring was continued at ice-bath temperature for 30 min then added a solution of (1S)-1-[(2-methylamino-2-phenyl)ethyl]pyrrolidine1 (1.02 g, 5.0 mmol) in anhydrous CH2Cl2 (10 mL) followed by N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.79 g, 6.1 mmol). Reaction mixture was continued stirring for 48 h [TLC, solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (95:5:2)]. After addition of more CH2Cl2, the organic phase was washed with water, saturated sodium bicarbonate solution, saturated salt solution, and dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate. Removal of the solvent under reduced pressure gave the crude product which was coverted to the hydrochloride salt from 1M etherial HCl. The salt was re-crystallized from 2-prppanol to give 31 as off-white solid, 1.52 g (62%); 285-287° C.; 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 2.01 (m, 4H), 2.50 (d, J=4.5 Hz, 3H), 2.87 (s, 3H), 3.17 (m, 2H), 3.64 (m, 3H), 3.90 (d, J=10.0 Hz, 1H), 4.14 (d, J=10.5 Hz, 2H), 6.20 (m, 1H), 7.28-7.45 (m, 4H), 7.55-7.65 (m, 3H), 7.90 (d, J=3.5 Hz, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C22H28ClN3O3S.HCl.0.75H2O: C, 52.85; H, 6.15; N, 8.40. Found: C, 52.84; H, 5.89; N, 8.40.
  • EXAMPLE 3m 2-(3-Sulfamoyl-4-chlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide methanesulfonate
  • Prepared from 3-sulfonamido-4-chlorophenyl acetic acid following the above procedure and the free base was converted to methanesulfonic acid salt. Recrystallization from 2-propanol gave 3m as a white solid in 51% yield; mp 220-222° C.; MS (FAB) 436 (M+1); 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 2.00 (m, 4H), 2.36 (s, 3H), 2.76 (s, 3H), 3.20 (m, 2H), 3.50-3.80 (m, 4H), 3.94 (bs, 2H), 6.15 (m, 1H), 7.25 (d, J=6.0 Hz, 1H), 7.30-7.65 (m, 6H), 7.88 (d, J=2.5 Hz, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C21H26ClN3O3S.CH3SO3H: C, 49.66; H, 5.68; N, 7.90. Found: C, 49.69; H, 5.63; N, 7.78.
  • EXAMPLE 3n 2-(3-Sulfamoyl-4-chlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-[3-[(methylsulfonyl)amino]phenyl]-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide methanesulfonate
  • (S)-1-[2-(Methylamino)-2-(3-nitrophenyl)ethyl]pyrrolidine1 was condensed with 3-sulfonamido-4-chlorophenyl acetic acid following the general procedure described in 83% yield. The catalytic reduction of the 3-nitro group was done with PtO2 to give the 3-amino intermediate. Bis-mesylation of the 3-amino group followed by selective removal one of the mesyl group as described for 3d resulted in the desired compound in 28% yield. Methanesulfonic acid salt was prepared in 71% yied to give 3n; mp 170-173° C.; MS (FAB) 543 (M+1); 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.98 (m, 4H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.44 (d, J=5.0 Hz, 3H), 2.77 (s, 3H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.10-4.15 (m, 6H), 3.90 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 6.20 (m, 1H), 7.00-7.75 (m, 6H), 7.90 (d, J=2.0 Hz, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C23H31ClN4O5S2.CH3SO3H.0.5H2O: C, 44.47; H, 5.60; N, 8.64. Found: C, 44.26; H, 5.53; N, 8.45.
  • EXAMPLE 3o 2-[3-(N-Methylsulfamoyl)-4-fluorophenyl]-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • Prepared from 3-methylsulfonamido-4-fluorophenyl acetic acid following the above procedure to give 3o as a white solid in 85% yield; mp 278-280° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.73 (m, 4H), 2.61 (bs, 3H), 2.68 (s, 3H), 2.90-3.20 (m, 2H), 3.55-3.90 (m, 3H), 4.75 (b, 1H), 6.05 (m, 1H), 7.05-7.60 (m, 7H), 7.72 (bd, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C22H28FN3O3S.HCl: C, 56.22; H, 6.22; N, 8.94. Found: C, 56.22; H, 6.24; N, 8.86.
  • EXAMPLE 3p AND 3r 2-[2&4-(N-Methylsulfamoyl)-phenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • Compounds 3p and 3r were prepared using the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure of (1S)-N-methyl-2-pyrrolidino-1-phenethylamine (1.3 g; 6.34 mmol), a mixture of 2 and 4 substituted reversed sulfamides acids (1.6 g; 6.98 mmol), HOBT (943 mg; 6.9 mmol), EDCI (1.33 g; 6.98 mmol) and DIPEA (1.32 mL; 7.60 mmol). After 24 hours, TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol with 2% ammonia) indicates the reaction is complete. After the standard work-up, the crude product was purified using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 10% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 1.6 g of a mixture of the 2 and 4 substituted sulfamide products. The mixture was separated using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 2% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia on a chromatotran to afford 14 mg (0.5%) of the 2-substituted compound 3p and 20 mg (0.7%) of the 4-substituted compound 3r, which were converted to the HCl salt with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether. 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCL3) δ 1.7(br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.4-2.6 (m, 2H), 2.6 (d, 3H, NHCH3), 2.8 (s, 3H, NCH3), 3.0-3.3 (t, 2H), 3.8 (d, 2H), 6.0-6.2 (dd, 1H), 7.2-7.4 (complex, 5H, aromatic), 7.5-7.7 (m, 2H), 7.8 (s, 2H). MS (FAB) m/z 415.
  • EXAMPLE 3q 3-(N-Methylsulfamoyl)-phenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • Compound 3q was prepared using the HOBT/EDCI coupling procedure described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,885,955 with 3-SO2NHCH3 phenyl acetic acid (A) 2.23 g; 9.73 mmol, (1S)-N-methyl-2-pyrrolidino-1-phenethylamine (1.90 g; 9.26 mmol), HOBT (1.31 g; 9.73 mmol), EDCI (1.85 g; 9.73 mmol) and DIPEA (3.38 mL; 19.46 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 8% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to give 1.40 g (40%) of desired product which was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to afford 3q as the HCl salt. mp>250° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3 with 3 drops of CD3OD) δ 2.0-2.2 (br, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.6 (s, 3H, NHCH3), 2.8 (s, 3H, NCH3), 3.4-3.5 (d, 2H), 6.3-6.4 (dd, 1H), 7.2 (d, 2H), 7.3-7.4 (complex, 5H, aromatic), 7.5 (t, 1H), 7.6 (d, 1H), 7.7 (d, 1H), 7.8 (s, 1H). MS (FAB) m/z 415. Anal. (C, H, N) Calcd. for C22H29N3O3S.HCl: C, 58.46; H, 6.69; N, 9.30. Found C, 59.34; H, 6.62; N, 9.19.
  • EXAMPLE 3s 2-[N-Methylsulfamoyl)-4-bromo-phenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl acetamide hydochloride
  • Compound 3s was prepared using the HOBT/EDCI coupling procedure described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,885,955 using 2-SO2NHCH3, 4-bromorphenyl acetic acid (2.3 g; 7.40 mmol), (1S)-N-methyl-2-pyrrolidino-1-phenethylamine (1.4 g; 7.08 mmol), HOBT (1.0 g; 7.46 mmol), EDCI (1.4 g; 7.46 mmol) and DIPEA (1.5 mL; 8.95 mmol). The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 8% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to give 500 mg (30%) of 3s as the desired product which was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to afford the HCl salt. mp>280° C.; MS (FAB) m/z 494. Anal. (C, H, N) Calcd. for C22H28N3O3S Br HCl 0.5H2O: C, 49.77; H, 5.51; N, 7.91. Found: C, 48.86; H, 5.36; N, 7.67.
  • Ref.
    • 2. Gottschlich R. et. Al. BioOrg. Med. Chem. Lett., 4, 677-682 (1994)
    EXAMPLE 3w (Z)-4-[2-(2-Amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-Pyrrolidinyl]ethyl]acetamido]4-oxo-butanoic acid
  • To a solution of 2-(2-Amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide1 (0.86 g, 2.0 mmol) in anhydrous THF under a nitrogen atmosphere was added succinic anhydride (0.25 g, 2.5 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 96 h and added excess of anhydrous ether. The resulting solid was filtered off, washed with ether and dried to give crude product. The compound was purified on a silica gel column (acetone:water, 9:1). The desired compound was re-dissolved in CH2Cl2, filtered, and concentrated to a small volume. Addition of ether resulted the solid which was filtered, washed with ether, and dried to give 3w (0.32 g, 30%); mp 168-170° C.; 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 2.03 (m, 4H), 2.36 (m, 1H), 2.66 (m, 2H), 2.81 (s, 3H), 2.80-2.95 (m, 2H), 3.10 (m, 1H), 3.40 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.67 (d, J=14.5 Hz, 1H), 4.18 (t, J=12.0 Hz, 1H), 6.40 (d, J=11.5 Hz, 1H), 7.20 (m, 3H), 7.45 (m, 3H), 8.00 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C25H29Cl2N3O4S2.0.5H2O: C, 58.26; H, 5.87; N, 8.15. Found: C, 58.08; H, 5.75; N, 7.96.
  • EXAMPLE 3x (Z)-4-[2-(2-Amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]-ethyl]acetamido]4-oxo-2-butenoic acid
  • To a solution of 2-(2-amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide1 (0.8 g, 1.85 mmol) in anhydrous THF (10 mL) under a nitrogen atmosphere was added maleic anhydride (0.181 g, 1.85 mmol) and the stirred at room temperature for 4 days. After addition of anhydrous ether, the resulting solid was sonicated and filtered. Recrystallization of the solid from CH2Cl2:ether (1:1) gave 3x (0.51 g, 52% yield); mp 158-160° C. (d); 1H NMR (200, MHz, CDCl3) δ 2.00 (m, 4H), 2.72 (s, 3H), 2.75-3.20 (m, 2H), 3.35 (d, J=12.5 Hz, 1H), 3.85 (d, J=13.0 Hz, 1H), 3.904.20 (m, 2H), 6.10 (d, J=12.5 Hz, 1H), 6.25 (m, 2H), 7.15 (m, 3H), 7.44 (m, 3H), 8.00 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C25H27Cl2N3O4.0.25H2O: C, 59.00; H, 5.45; N, 8.26. Found: C, 59.20; H, 5.57; N, 7.90.
  • EXAMPLE 3y (E) Ethyl 4-[2-(2-amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl]acetamido]4-oxo-2-butenoate hydrochloride
  • To a solution of fumaric acid monoethyl ester (1.30 g, 9.02 mmol) in anhydrous CH2Cl2 (20 mL) under a nitrogen atmosphere was added DCC (1.86 g, 9.03 mmol) followed by pyridine (0.43 mL, 5.31 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 30 min then added a solution of 2-(2-amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide1 (2.30 g, 5.31 mmol) in anhydrous CH2Cl2 (10 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at this temperature for 72 h, filtered and evaporated to dryness to give the crude product. The compound was purified on a silica gel column [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (99:1:2)] to give the free base of the desired product. The hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl and recrystallized from CH2Cl2:ether (1:1) to give 3y (2.0 g, 60%); mp 165-167° C. (d); 1H NMR (300, MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.28 (t, J=7.0 Hz, 3H), 2.00-2.40 (m, 4H), 2.89 (s, 3H), 2.96 (m, 2H), 3.28 (m, 1H), 3.50 (m, 2H), 3.954.10 (m, 4H), 4.21 (q, J=7.1 Hz, 2H), 4.50 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 6.33 (d, J=10.0 Hz, 1H), 6.89 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 7.10-7.40 (m, 5H), 7.93 (d, J=15.3 Hz, 1H), 8.43 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C27H31Cl2N3O4.HCl.H2O: C, 55.25; H, 5.84; N, 7.16. Found: C, 55.63; H, 5.73; N, 6.94.
  • EXAMPLE 3z (Z)-4-[2-(2-Amino-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]-ethyl]acetamido]4-oxo-2-butenoic acid
  • The compound 3z was prepared from 2-(2-amino-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide1 following the above in 40% yield; mp 153-155° C. (d); MS (FAB) 504 (M+1); 1H NMR (200, MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 2.01 (m, 4H), 2.85 (s, 3H), 2.85-3.30 (m, 2H), 3.40 (d, J=14.5 Hz, 1H), 3.95 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 4.10 (m, 2H), 6.30 (m, 3H), 7.18 (m, 3H), 7.38 (m, 4H), 8.15 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C26H28F3N3O4.0.75H2O: C, 60.40; H, 5.75; N, 8.13. Found: C, 60.07; H, 5.50; N, 7.91.
  • EXAMPLE 3aa (Z)-4-[2-(2-Aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl]-ethyl]acetamido]4-oxo-2-butenoic acid hemimaleate
  • The compound 3aa was prepared from 2-(2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide1 following the above in 93% yield; mp 149-1511C; Anal. Calcd. for C25H29N3O4.0.5C4H4O4.H2O: C, 63.39; H, 6.50; N, 8.21. Found: C, 63.37; H, 6.20; N, 8.22.
  • EXAMPLE 3bb 2-(N,N-Bisacetic acid-2-amino-α,α,α-trifluro-4-tolyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • 2-(2-Amino,α,α,α-trifluoro-4-toly)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]-acetamide (for the preparation see U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955) 2.0 g; 4.93 mmol was dissolved in 50 ml of dry THF at 0° C. DIPEA (5.15 mL; 29.6 mmol) and t-butyl bromoacetate (3.64 ml; 24.65 mmol) were added 15 minutes apart. The reaction was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 4 days. TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol with 2% ammonia) indicated the reaction is incomplete. Added 1.67 mL (9.58 mmol) of DIPEA to the reaction. After 24 hours the reaction mixture was concentrated to a residue. The residue was dissolved in methylene chloride and washed with sat. sodium bicarbonate and brine. The organic layer was dried (anh. Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give a yellow oil. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 8% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 1.2 g (61%) of bis-alkylated material which was used in the next step [1H NMR, (Free base, CDCl3) δ 1.4 (s, 9H, t-butyl), 1.5 (s, 9H, t-butyl), 1.7-1.9 (m, 4H), 3.2 (s, 3H, NCH3), 3.6-3.7 (dd, 4H), 4.3-4.8 (q, 4H), 5.7-5.9 (dd, 1H), 6.0 (d, 1H), 6.4 (d, 1H), 6.6 (s, 1H), 6.9-7.2 (m, 2H), 7.4 (complex, 3H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 633. The bis-alkylated compound (1.2 g; 1.89 mmol) was stirred in 33 mL of glacial acetic acid with 4 drops of anisole. After 60 hours, the reaction was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in acetonitrile and added drop-wise to a solution of 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether. The precipitate was collected by filtration and dried at 40° C. under vacuum to yield 960 mg (93%) of 3bb as a tan solid. mp 166-169° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.6 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (s, 3H, NCH3), 3.8 (q, 4H0, 4.1-4.3 (d, 2H), 4.74.9 (m, 3H), 6.6 (br d, 1H), 7.1 (s, 1H), 7.4 (d, 1H), 7.6 (d, 1H), 7.7-8.0 (complex, 5H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 521. Anal. (C, H, N) Calcd. for C26H30N5O3F3.2HCl.H2O: C, 58.46; H, 6.69; N, 9.30. Found: C, 58.40; H, 6.65; N, 9.21.
  • EXAMPLE 3cc 3-(2-N-Methylsulfonamido)-phenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • Compound 3cc was prepared using the same procedure as described in the preparation of compound (2-N-Methylsulonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (for the preparation see U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955). Compound 3-(N,N-Dimethylsulfonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (1.0 g; 2.02 mmol), 10 mL of 10 M NaOH and 30 mL of 2:1 MeOH:THF. The crude product was clean by TLC and 1H NMR (760 mg; 90%). The product was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to give 3cc as the HCl salt; mp 155-160° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (Free base, CDCl3) δ 1.7 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.5 (br d, 2H), 2.8 (s, 3H, NCH3), 2.9 (s, 3H, SO2CH3), 3.7 (d, 2H), 6.0-6.1 (dd, 1H), 7.0-7.4 (complex, 9H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 415. Anal. (C, H, N) Calc. for C22H29N3O3S HCl: C, 58.46; H, 6.69; N, 9.30. Found: C, 58.40; H, 6.65; N, 9.21.
  • EXAMPLE 3dd 2-(O-Butylacetate)-phenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl acetamide hydrochloride
  • 2-(2-Hydroxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (for preparation see U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955) 1.3 g; (3.80 mmol) was dissolved in 10 mL of dry THF and added to a 0° C. slurry of NaH (95%, 100 mg; 4.03 mmol) in dry THF. The mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature for 30 minutes, then cooled to 0° C. Ethyl bromoacetate (0.44 mL; 4.03 mmol) was added drop-wise over a few minutes. After 30 minutes, the mixture was warmed to room temperature and stirred for 5 days. TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol with 2% ammonia) indicated the reaction was complete. The reaction was quenched with sat. ammonium chloride and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in methylene chloride and separated from water. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried (anh. Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give 1.61 g of crude product, which was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 9% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 1.0 g (70%) of 3dd as a desired product, which was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to give the HCl salt. mp 184-187° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3) δ 1.2 (t, 3H), 1.7-1.9 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.0 (br d, 2H), 2.2-2.5 (m, 2H), 2.8-3.0 (m, 2H), 3.0 (s, 3H, NCH3), 3.3-3.5 (t, 1H), 4.04.1 (m, 2H), 4.2 (q, 2H), 6.2-6.3 (dd, 1H), 6.8 (d, 1H), 6.9-7.1 (t, 1H), 7.2-7.5 (complex, 7H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 424. Anal. (C, H, N) Calcd. for C25H32N2O4.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 65.14; H, 7.22; N, 6.08. Found: C, 63.70; H, 7.00; N, 6.09.
  • EXAMPLE 3ee 2-[Phenoxy-acetyl]methylamino-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide]hydrochloride
  • 2-(2-Hydroxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (for the preparation see U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955) 960 mg; 2.83 mmol was dissolved in 6.0 mL of dry THF and added to a slurry of NaH (95%) 79 mg; 3.12 mmol in dry THF at 0° C. The mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 30 minutes, then cooled to 0° C. when t-butyl bromoacetate (0.42 ml; 2.83 mmol) in 2 mL of dry THF was added drop-wise. The solution was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred overnight. TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol w/ 2% ammonia) indicated the reaction was complete. The reaction was quenched with saturated ammonium chloride and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in methylene chloride and separated from water. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried (anh. Na2SO4), filtered, and evaporated to give a brown residue. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 1% to 8% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 900 mg (70%) of desired compound; 1H NMR (Free base, CDCl3), δ 1.4 (s, 9H, t-butyl), 2.7-2.9 (br s, 4H), 2.7 (s, 3H), 3.8 (s, 2H), 4.5 (s, 2H), 6.1-6.2 (dd, 1H), 6.7-6.8 (d, 2H), 6.9-7.0 (t, 3H), 7.1-7.4 (complex, 5H, aromatic), MS (FAB) m/z 452, which was used in the next step by adding 4.0 mL of 4N HCl, 4 drops of anisole and stirring overnight at room temperature. TLC indicated the reaction was incomplete. The solution was heated to 50° C. for 24 hours. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo and the residue was azeotroped with toluene. The crude product was dissolved in triturated with diethyl ether to give 730 mg (93%) of 3ee as the free acid; mp 105-108° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 1.9-2.4 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.9 (s, 3H, NCH3)3.84.1 (m, 3H), 4.5-4.7 (d, 2H), 6.2 (dd, 1H), 6.8 (d, 1H), 6.9 (t, 1H), 7.1-7.3 (complex, 7H, aromatic). MS (FAB) m/z 396. Anal (C, H, N) Calc. for C23H28N2O4. HCl 0.75H2O: C, 63.81; H, 6.75; N, 6.47. Found C, 61.87; H, 6.84; N, 6.19.
  • EXAMPLE 3ff 2-[4-Trifluoromethylphenyl]-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-3-hydroxy-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • The compound 3ff was prepared from N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-((3S)-3-hydroxypyrrolidine-1-yl)ethyl]-2-aminophenylacetamide2 and 4-trifluoromethylphenyl acetic acid in 54% yield; mp 217-219° C. (d); 1H NMR (free base, 200, MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.88 (m, 2H), 2.35 (m, 3H), 2.85 (s, 3H), 2.50-3.35 (m, 4H), 3.98 (m, 2H), 4.10 (m, 1H), 6.00 (m, 1H), 7.30 (m, 5H), 7.55 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 2H), 7.77 (d, J=9.5 Hz, 2H). Anal. Calcd. for C22H25F3N2O2.HCl: C, 59.66; H, 5.92; N, 6.32. Found: C, 59.45; H, 5.68; N, 5.98.
  • EXAMPLE 3gg 2-(2-Pyridyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-3-hydroxy-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide dihydrochloride
  • The compound 3gg was prepared as above from 2-pyridyl acetic acid in 38% yield; mp 180-182° C. (d); 1H NMR (free base, 200, MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.78 (m, 2H), 2.10-2.65 (m, 3H), 2.75 (s, 3H), 2.88-3.20 (m, 4H), 3.95 (d, J=13.0 Hz, 1H), 4.10 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 4.20 (m, 1H), 6.05 (m, 1H), 7.20 (m, 7H), 7.60 (t, J=7.0 Hz, 1H), 8.35 (d, J=6.5 Hz, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C20H25N3O2.2HCl.0.25H2O: C, 57.63; H, 6.65; N, 10.8. Found: C, 57.73; H, 6.79; N, 9.83.
  • EXAMPLE 3hh 2-(5-Bromo-3-pyridyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-pyrrolidinyl ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • Compound 3hh was prepared using the general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955 with, (1S)-N-methyl-2-pyrrolidino-1-phenethylamine (200 mg; 0.98 mmol), 5-bromo-3-pyridylacetic acid (231 mg; 1.07 mmol), HOBT (145 mg; 1.07 mmol), EDCI (204 mg; 1.07 mmol), and DIPEA (0.26 mL; 1.47 mmol). The reaction solution was allowed to stir at room temperature overnight. TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol with 2% ammonia) indicated the reaction was complete. The reaction was quenched with sat. sodium bicarbonate and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with brine and dried (anh. Na2SO4), filtered and evaporated. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 4% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to afford 337 mg (85%) of pure product which was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to give 3hh as the HCl salt; mp 228-230° C.; 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) 82.0 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.8 (s, 3H, NCH3), 4.1-4.2 (br m, CH2), 6.1-6.2 (br d, 1H, CH), 7.2-7.5 (complex, 5H, aromatic), 8.0-8.1 (br s, 1H, pyridyl), 8.5 (s, 1H, pyridyl), 8.6 (s, 1H, pyridyl); MS (FAB) m/z 401. Anal. (C, H, N) Calcd. for C20H24N3OBr.HCl: C, 54.75; H, 5.74; N, 9.58. Found: C, 54.66; H, 5.71; N, 9.41.
  • EXAMPLE 3ii 2-(5-Bromo-3-pyridyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-3-hydroxy-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • The compound 3ii was prepared from 5-bromo-3-pyridyl acetic acid following the procedures described above in 44% yield; mp 144-146° C.; 1H NMR (free base, 200, MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.66 (m, 2H), 2.00-2.50 (m, 3H), 2.77 (s, 3H), 2.88-3.40 (m, 4H), 3.80 (d, J=13.0 Hz, 1H), 3.95 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 4.35 (m, 1H), 6.15 (m, 1H), 7.20 (m, 5H), 7.75 (s, 1H), 8.50 (s, 1H), 8.85 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C20H24BrN3O2.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 51.79; H, 5.65; N, 9.06. Found: C, 51.96; H, 5.55; N, 8.76.
  • EXAMPLE 3jj 2-(9-Anthracenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • The compound 3jj was prepared from 9-anthracene carboxylic acid as above in 34% yield; mp 273-275° C.; 1H NMR (200, MHz, CDCl3) δ 2.00 (m, 4H), 2.67 (s, 3H), 3.00 (m, 1H), 3.45 (m, 1H), 3.88 (m, 1H), 4.40 (m, 2H), 5.80 (m, 1H), 7.43 (m, 8H), 7.88 (m, 5H), 8.38 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C28H28N2O.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 74.82; H, 6.61; N, 6.23. Found: C, 75.00; H, 6.60; N, 6.26.
  • EXAMPLE 3kk 2-(2-Carboxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • To a solution of (S)-1-[(2-methylamino-2-phenyl)ethyl]pyrrolidine1 (1.0 g, 5.21 mmol) in anhydrous THF (5 mL) under a nitrogen atmosphere was added homophthalic anhydride (0.845 g, 5.21 mmol) and the reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 4 days. The resulting solid was filtered, washed with THF and HCl salt was prepared by usual fashion to give 3kk (1.0 g, 50%); mp 230-232° C. (d); MS (FAB) 367 (M+1); 1H NMR (200, MHz, DMSO-d6) 82.07 (m, 4H), 2.92 (s, 3H), 3.30-3.98 (m, 5H), 4.00 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 4.18 (m, 1H), 4.43 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 6.15 (m, 1H), 7.30-7.65 (m, 8H), 8.00 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C22H26N2O3.HCl: C, 65.58; H, 6.75; N, 6.96; Cl, 8.81. Found: C, 65.52; H, 6.81; N, 7.04; Cl, 8.81.
  • EXAMPLE 3ll [2-(2-Phenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-Phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamido]2-oxo-glycine hydrochloride
  • To a suspension of 3ff was condensed with glycine t-butyl ester hydrochloride following the general procedure to give the intermediate in 55% yield. The t-butyl group was removed by 4N HCl to give the desired product which was recrystallized from acetonitrile to give 3ll in 93% yield; mp 235-236° C.; MS (FAB) 424 (M+1); 1H NMR (200, MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.95 (m, 4H), 2.72 (s, 3H), 3.35-4.25 (m, 1H), 6.18 (m, 1H), 7.20-7.65 (m, 8H), 8.70 (m, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C24H29N3O4.HCl.0.75H2O: C, 60.88; H, 6.71; N, 8.87. Found: C, 60.97; H, 6.65; N, 8.91.
  • EXAMPLE 3mm Methyl N-[2-(2-pheny)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamido]2-oxo-glycinate hydrochloride
  • To a solution of 3ff (0.50 g, 1.05 mmol) in anhydrous methanol (50 mL) was added Dowex®50Wx4-400 (H+) resin (5.0 g, pre-washed with methanol). The reaction mixture was the stirred with refluxing under a nitrogen atmosphere for 48 h. The resin was removed by filtration washed with excess of hot methanol and the combined mehanolic solution was evaporated to dryness. The residue was redissolved in CH2Cl2 and concentrated to a small volume and addition of anhydrous ether resulted the compound 3 mm (0.12 g, 24%); mp 204-206° C.; MS (FAB) 438 (M+1); 1H NMR (200, MHz, CDCl3), δ 1.85-2.45 (m, 6H), 2.75-3.25 (m, 2H), 2.92 (s, 3H), 3.75 (s, 3H), 3.804.25 (m, 7H), 6.25 (bs, 1H), 7.15-7.77 (m, 9H). Anal. Calcd. for C25H31N3O4.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 62.75; H, 6.85; N, 8.78. Found: C, 62.65; H, 6.87; N, 8.60.
  • EXAMPLE 3nn 2-(3,4-Dihydroxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared from 3,4-dihydroxyphenyl acetic acid in 12% yield; mp 227-229° C. (d); 1H NMR (300, MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.90 (m, 4H), 2.70 (s, 3H), 3.05-3.20 (m, 2H), 3.35 (bs, 2H), 3.45-3.70 (m, 4H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 6.12 (m, 1H), 6.45 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H), 6.62 (m, 2H), 7.18 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 7.32 (m, 3H), 8.73 (bs, 1H), 8.83 (bs, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C21H26N2O3.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 63.79; H, 7.01; N, 7.08. Found: C, 63.59; H, 6.89; N, 7.15.
  • EXAMPLE 3oo 2-(3,4-Dimethoxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared from 3,4-dimethoxyphenyl acetic acid in 65% yield; mp; 240-242° C.; 1H NMR (300, MHz, CDCl3) δ 2.00-2.35 (m, 4H), 2.85 (s, m, 5H), 3.26 (m, 1H), 3.18 (s, m, 7H), 4.05 (m, 4H), 6.36 (m, 1H), 6.81 (m, 2H), 6.93 (s, 1H), 7.19 (m, 2H), 7.36 (m, 3H). Anal. Calcd. for C23H30N2O3.HCl: C,; H, 7.01; N, 7.08. Found: C, 63.59; H, 6.89; N, 7.15.
  • EXAMPLE 3pp 2-(2-Methanesulfonamidophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-methanesulfon-amidophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide Hydrochloride
  • (1) 2-(2-Nitrophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-nitrophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide
  • A solution of 2-nitrophenylacetic acid (1.99 g, 11.0 mmol) and 1-hydroxybenzotriazole (1.49 g, 11.0 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (50 ml) was cooled in an ice bath. To this slurry was added EDCI, and the solution turned brown clear after 30 minutes at room temperature. A solution of (2s)-1-[2-(methylamino)-2-(3-nitrophenyl)ethyl]pyrrolidine1 (2.49 g, 10.0 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (5 ml) was added, followed by DIPEA. The solution was stirred in ice bath for 30 minutes and then at room temperature for 18 hours. The reaction was quenched by adding saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (20 ml) and stirred for 10 minutes. After separation, the organic layer was washed with water, brine, dried (Na2SO4). The solvent was removed via rotary evaporation and the brown residue was purified by silica column chromatography [2% MeOH/CH2Cl2 (2% NH3)] to give the product (2.4 g, 58%).
  • (2) 2-(2-Aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1R,S)-1-(3-aminophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • A suspension of above compound (475 mg, 1.15 mmol) and Raney nickel (50% slurry in water) in ethanol (10 ml) was heated at 50° C. and treated with a solution of hydrazine hydrate (360 ml, 11.5 mmol) in ethanol (2 ml). Upon addition of the reagent, effervescent occurred. The mixture was then stirred at 50° C. for 0.5 h. After cooling, the mixture was filtered through a bed of celite, and the catalyst was washed with hot methanol (10 ml). The combined filtrate and washing was evaporated and dried in vacuum (388 mg, 95%). 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): δ 1.64 (bs, 4H), 2.40 (bs, 2H), 2.58 (m, 2H), 2.66 (s, 3H), 3.06-3.59 (m, 4H), 4.95 (s, 2H), 5.01 (s, 2H), 5.77 (dd, J=4.9, 11.4 Hz, 1H), 6.39-6.48 (m, 4H), 6.63 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 6.89-7.04 (m, 3H).
  • To a solution of the diamine (388 mg, 1.11 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (10 ml) cooled in an ice bath was added pyridine (540 ml, 6.67 mmol), followed by MsCl (190 ml, 2.45 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (5 ml). The mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 0.5 h and then at room temperature for 18 hours. The solution was washed with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (2×50 ml), brine, dried (Na2SO4). The solvent was removed by rotary evaporation and the residue was purified by silica column chromatography to give gummy foam after drying (383 mg, 68%) which was then converted to the HCl salt form. mp: 160° C. (d). 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): δ 1.96 (bs, 4H), 2.77 (s, 3H), 2.97 (s, 3H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.14 (m, 2H), 3.57 (m, 3H), 3.974.10 (m, 3H), 6.12 (d, J=10.8 Hz, 1H), 7.03-7.37 (m, 8H), 9.10 (s, 1H), 9.81 (s, 1H). Fab MS (MH+): 509. Anal. Calcd. for C23H33N4O5S2Cl: C, 48.47; H, 6.43; N, 9.50. Found: C, 48.57; H, 6.07; N, 9.25.
  • EXAMPLE 3qq 2-(2-Iso-butyramidophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-isobutyramido-phenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide Methanesulfonic acid salt
  • To a solution of the diamine (132 mg, 0.376 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (5 ml) cooled in an ice bath was added pyridine (182 ml, 2.26 mmol), followed by isobutyryl chloride (119 ml, 1.14 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (5 ml). The mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 0.5 h and then at room temperature for 18 hours. The solution was washed with aqueous saturated NaHCO3 (2×25 ml), brine, dried (Na2SO4). TLC indicated that the compound was contaminated by bis-acylated side product. Thus, the solvent was removed by rotary evaporation and the residue was dissolved in MeOH (2 ml), treated with a drop of NaOH (13 N), and stirred at room temperature for 5 minutes. After neutralization with HCl (6N), the solvent was evaporated, the residue was purified by silica column chromatography to give a gummy foam after drying which was then converted to methanesulfonic acid salt (178 mg, 76%). Mp: 143-145° C.; 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): δ 1.08 (m, 12H), 1.88 (m, 2H), 2.00 (m, 2H), 2.31 (s, 3H), 2.56 (m, 2H), 2.65 (s, 3H), 3.18 (m, 2H), 3.36-3.63 (m, 6H), 3.80 (d, J=16.2 Hz, 1H), 4.10 (m, 1H), 6.09 (d, J=10.8 Hz, 1H), 6.90 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 7.10-7.63 (m, 7H), 9.20 (bs, 1H), 9.41 (s, 1H), 9.92 (s, 1H). Fab MS (MH+): 493. Anal. Calcd. for C30H44N4O6S: C, 58.86; H, 7.67; N, 9.15. Found: C, 58.77; H, 7.51; N, 8.98.
  • EXAMPLE 3rr 4-[4-N-Methylsulfonamido-phenyl]-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • 4-(N,N-Dimethylsulfonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (for preparation see U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955) 1.3 g; 2.63 mmol was dissolved in 60 mL of 2:1 MeOH:THF and 2.0 mL of 10 M NaOH was added. After 20 minutes, TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol with 2% ammonia) indicated the reaction was complete. The reaction was neutralized with 10% HCl and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in methylene chloride and washed with 10% sodium bicarbonate, brine and dried (anh. Na2SO4). The organic layer was concentrated in vacuo and the crude product was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 8% MeOH:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to give 300 mg (28%) of desired product, which was treated with 1.0 M HCl in diethyl ether to afford 3rr as a tan solid. mp>260° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (HCl salt, DMSO-d6) δ 2.0 (br s, 4H, —CH2CH2—), 2.8 (s, 3H, NCH3), 3.0 (s, 3H, SO2CH3), 3.8-4.0 (m, 2H), 6.1-6.3 (dd, 1H), 7.1-7.5 (complex, 9H, aromatic), 9.7 (s, 1H). MS (FAB) m/z 415. Anal. (C, H, N) Calcd. for C22H29N3O3S.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 58.46; H, 6.69; N, 9.30. Found: C, 57.89; H, 6.64; N, 9.19.
  • EXAMPLE 3ss 2-(3,4-Dichlorocinnamyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-Pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared from 3,4-dichlorocinnamic acid in 70% yield; mp 220-222° C.; Anal. Calcd. for C22H24Cl2N2O.HCl: C, 60.08; H, 5.73; N, 6.37. Found: C, 60.25; H, 5.81; N, 6.28.
  • EXAMPLE 3tt 2-(2-Nitrocinnamyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl) ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared from 2-nitrocinnamic acid in 46% yield; mp 195-197° C.; Anal. Calcd. for C22H25N3O3.HCl: C, 63.53; H, 6.30; N, 10.10. Found: C, 63.25; H, 6.38; N, 10.08.
  • EXAMPLE 3uu (R,S)-1-[2-(Methanesulfonylamino)phenyl-N-methylacetamido]-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane, methanesulfonic acid salt (R,S)-3-Methoxy-phenylglycine (5, Scheme M)
  • NaCN (12.2 g, 0.249 mol) was dissolved in 50 ml of water, and to this solution was added ammonium chloride (13.3 g, 0.249 mol). When all had dissolved, a solution of m-anisaldehyde (33.8 g, 0.249 mol) in 50 ml of EtOH was added slowly. The mixture was stirred at ambient temperature for 2-3 hours. TLC indicated no starting material left. The mixture was taken up in water/toluene (50 ml/50 ml). The organic layer was washed with water (50 ml), extracted with 6N HCl (2×30 ml). To hydrolyze the amino cyanide, the hydrochloric extract was refluxed for 4-5 hours. The solution was cooled to room temperature and filtered from some tarry material. The filtrate was cooled in ice bath and the aminoacid salt was collected via filtration, washed with cold water (20 ml), ether, dried at 60 degrees overnight to give 5 (14.5 g, 27%); NMR (DMSO-d6), δ 3.7 (3H, s), 4.29 (1H, s), 6.87 (1H, m), 6.96 (1H, d, J=7.6 Hz), 6.98 (1H, s), 7.26 (1H, t, J=8.0 Hz).
  • (R,S)-N-Methoxycarbonyl-2-(3-methoxyphenyl)glycine (6)
  • (R,S)-3-Methoxy-phenylglycine (5, 14.5 g, 66.7 mmol) was dissolved in NaOH (1N, 233 ml, 233 mmol) and the solution was cooled in ice bath for 15 minutes. To this solution was added methyl chloroformate (7.73 ml, 100 mmol) dropwise. After the addition was complete, the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 2 hours. The pH was adjusted to 10 with 2N NaOH and the stirring was continued for 1 hour. The solution was washed with ether (2×100 ml), acidified with 6N HCl after addition of EtOAc (100 ml). The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (100 ml), and the combined organic extracts were washed with brine (100 ml), dried over (Na2SO4), concentrated to yellow syrup 6, (14.4 g, 90%). NMR (CDCl3), δ 3.70 (3H, s), 3.82 (3H, s), 5.35 (1H, d), 5.77 (1H, d), 6.87-7.01 (3H, m), 7.31 (1H, t).
  • (R,S)-N-Methoxycarbonyl-2-(3-methoxyphenyl) glycine, pyrrolidine (7)
  • (R,S)-N-Methoxycarbonyl-2-(3-methoxyphenyl) glycine (6, 14.4 g, 60.4 mmol) and HOBt (8.97 g, 66.4 mmol) were dissolved in THF (150 ml) and cooled in ice bath. To this solution was added a solution of DCC (12.4 g, 60.4 mmol) in THF (50 ml). After stirring at room temperature for 2 hours, the mixture was cooled in ice bath, and the resulting DCU was filtered, washed with cold THF. The filtrate was treated with a solution of pyrrolidine (5.0 ml, 60.4 mmol) in dichloromethane (50 ml). The solution was stirred at room temperature for 18 hours and concentrated. The residue was taken up in EtOAc (250 ml), and the mixture was washed with NaHCO3 (saturated, 200 ml), water, brine, dried over Na2SO4, concentrated to a pale solution (50 ml) which was stored in refrigerator overnight. The more precipitated DCU was filtered off, and the filtrate was dried to give a pale yellow oil 7, (12.8 g, 77%). NMR (CDCl3), δ 1.8 (4H, m), 3.4-3.6 (4H, m), 3.65 (3H, s), 3.8 (3H, s), 5.35 (1H, d), 6.8-7.0 (3H, m), 7.3 (1H, m).
  • (R,S)-1-(3-Methoxyphenyl)-1-methylamino-2-(1-pyrrolidino) ethane (8)
  • LiAlH4 (5.3 g, 140 mmol) was stirred in anhydrous THF (200 mL) under N2 and a solution of (R,S)-N-Methoxycarbonyl-2-(3-methoxyphenyl) glycine, pyrrolidine (12.8 g, 46.6 mmol) in THF (100 ml) was added over 30 minutes at 10-15 degree. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 0.5 hour then at 55 degree for 2 hours. After cooling in ice bath the mixture was carefully quenched with excess saturated NaHCO3, filtered. The filtrate was washed with brine, dried over Na2SO4, and evaporated to 10.0 grams of colorless oil (8) that was used in further reaction without purification.
  • (R,S)-1-(2-Nitrophenyl-N-methylacetamido)-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane (9)
  • A solution of 2-Nitrophenylacetic acid (1.99 g, 11.0 mmol), HOBt (1.49 g, 11.0 mmol) in THF (50 ml) was cooled in ice bath and treated with a solution of DCC (2.27 g, 11.0 mmol) in THF (5 ml). The mixture was warmed up to room temperature and stirred for 2 hours. After cooling in ice bath the precipitated DCU was filtered, and the filtrate was treated with a solution of (R,S)-1-(3-Methoxyphenyl)-1-methylamino-2-(1-pyrrolidino) ethane (8) in CH2Cl2 (10 ml). The solution was stirred in N2 at room temperature for 18 hours and concentrated. The residue was dissolved in EtOAc (100 ml), washed with saturated NaHCO3, brine, dried (Na2SO4). Removal of the solvent, followed by silica column chromatography yielded 3.0 grams of the product (9). NMR (CDCl3), δ 1.74 (4H, bs), 2.52 (2H, bs), 2.67 (2H, bs), 2.77 (1H, m), 2.84 (3H, s), 3.10 (1H, m), 3.83 (3H, s), 4.024.31 (2H, m), 6.03 (1H, dd, J=6.0, 9.8 Hz), 6.80-6.94 (3H, m), 7.26 (1H, m), 7.39-7.46 (2H, m), 7.54-7.59 (1H, m), 8.10 (1H, dd, J=1.2, 8.0 Hz).
  • (R,S)-1-(2-Aminophenyl-N-methylacetamido)-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane
  • A suspension of (R,S)-1-(2-nitrophenyl-N-methylacetamido)-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane (8) (1.3 g, 3.27 mmol) and Raney Ni (1 spatula) in EtOH (20 ml) was stirred at 50 degree and treated with a solution of hydrazine hydrate in EtOH (10 ml). After effervescent stopped, the mixture was stirred at 55 degree for 0.5 hour, then cooled to room temperature, filtered through a bed of celite, washed with hot MeOH (20 ml). The combined filtrate and washing was concentrated, dried to yellow residue (1.2 g) of amino compound that was used with further purification.
  • (R,S)-1-[2-(Methanesulfonylamino) phenyl-N-methylacetamido]-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane, methanesulfonic acid salt (3uu)
  • To a solution of (R,S)-1-(2-aminophenyl-N-methylacetamido)-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane (1.2 g, 3.24 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (20 ml) was added pyridine (0.79 ml, 9.72 mmol), followed by a solution of MsCl (0.376 ml. 4.86 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 18 hours. The mixture was washed with water (20 ml), brine, dried (Na2SO4). The solution was concentrated, and the residue was purified via silica column chromatography to give a yellowish oil (1.20 g, 83%). 251 mg of the free base was converted to methane sulfonic acid salt, 3uu. M p: 135° C. (decomposed). NMR (DMSO-d6), δ 1.92 (2H, bs), 2.02 (2H, bs), 2.32 (3H, s), 2.72 (3H, s), 2.97 (3H, s), 3.19 (2H, m), 3.56-3.97 (8H, m), 4.034.12 (2H, m), 6.08 (1H, d, J=12.0 Hz), 6.74 (1H, s), 6.81 (1H, dd, J=2.3, 8.0 Hz), 7.16-7.39 (5H, m), 9.07 (1H, s), 9.26 (1H, bs). MS (FAB) m/z 446. Anal. (C, H, N)C23H31N3O4S.CH3SO3H.0.2H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 3vv (R,S)-1-[2-(Methanesulfonylamino)phenyl-N-methylacetamido]-1-(3-hydroxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane, methanesulfonic acid salt
  • A solution of (R,S)-1-[2-(methanesulfonylamino)phenyl-N-methylacetamido]-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane (3uu, 196 mg, 0.440 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (15 ml) was cooled to −70 degree and treated with a solution of BBr3 (1.0 M in CH2Cl2, 1.45 ml, 1.45 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (2 ml). The mixture was stirred at −70 degree for 1 hour, then slowly warmed up to room temperature overnight. The mixture was carefully quenched at 0 degree with MeOH (5 ml) and the solution was evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was stirred in 10 ml of anhydrous MeOH/Et2O (1/1) for 6 hours and filtered. The white solid was taken up in CHCl3 (50 ml) and NaHCO3/Na2CO3 (pH˜10)(50 ml). The organic layer was washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4). After removal of the solvent, the residue was dissolved in MeOH (5 ml) and treated with CH3SO3H (0.026 ml, 0.404 mmol). The solvent was evaporated and the residue was sonicated in ether. The precipitate was filtered, dried to give 3vv, (0.164 g, 84%). mp: 232-234° C. NMR (DMSO-d6), δ 1.93 (2H, bs), 2.02 (2H, bs), 2.32 (3H, s), 2.70 (3H, s), 2.97 (3H, s), 3.16 (2H, bs), 3.40-3.80 (4H, m), 4.034.12 (2H, m), 6.04 (1H, d, J=9.6 Hz), 6.63-6.72 (3H, m), 7.14-7.39 (5H, m), 9.06 (1H, s), 9.21 (1H, bs), 9.56 (1H, s). MS (FAB) m/z 432. Anal. (C, H, N) C22H29N3O4S.CH3SO3H.0.2H2O.
  • EXAMPLE 3ww 2-(3-Indolyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[(3S)-1-pyrrolidin-3-ol]ethyl]-acetamide hydrochloride
  • Compound 3ww was prepared from indole-3-acetic acid (477 mg; 2.72 mmol), DCC (1.12 g; 5.44 mmol), pyridine (0.440 mL; 5.44 mmol) and S-(−)-3-pyrrolidinol (600 mg; 2.72 mmol, for preparation see EP 0398 720 A2) in 15 mL of dry methylene chloride. After stirring at room temperature for 24 h, TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol w/ 2% ammonia) indicated the reaction was complete. The reaction was quenched with sat. sodium bicarbonate and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered and conc. in vacuo to give 2.04 g of a viscous yellow oil which was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 3% methanol:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to yield 700 mg (69%) of desired compound which was converted to the hydrochloride salt with HCl/ether to give 720 mg of 3ww. m.p. 142° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 2.1 (br, m, 4H), 2.8 (s, 3H), 4.5 (m, 1H), 6.3 (br, m, 1H), 7.2 (br, m, 1H), 7.3 (complex, 4H, aromatic), 7.5-7.6 (d, 2H), 7.8 (d, 2H). Fab MS (MH+): 377. Anal. Calcd for C23H27O2N3 HCl: C, 63.29; H, 7.04; N, 9.63. Found C, 63.15; H, 7.03; N, 9.57.
  • EXAMPLE 3xx 2-(2-N-Benzyl-2-N-methylsulfamoyl-3,4-dimethoxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride
  • Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00071
  • Compound B was prepared from methyl 3,4-dimethoxyphenyl acetate following the literature procedure [J. Het. Chem. 29, 1667 (1992)] and condensed with the diamine in usual fashion to give 3xx in 60% yield; mp 188-190° C.; 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.88 (m, 4H), 2.64 (s, 3H), 2.85-3.25 (m, 4H), 2.91 (s, 3H), 3.90 (s, 3H), 3.944.28 (m, 2H), 3.95 (s, 3H), 4.30-4.60 (m, 4H), 6.48 (m, 1H), 7.15-7.40 (m, 1H), 7.55 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C31H39N3O5S HCl 0.5H2O: C, 60.92; H, 6.76; N, 6.88. Found: C, 60.73; H, 6.99; N, 6.82.
  • EXAMPLE 3yy 2-(N-Methylsulfonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1R)-1-phenyl-2-(1-Pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide methane sulfonate
  • Compound 3yy was prepared using the same synthetic scheme as described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955 using (R)-1-[2-methylamino-2 phenyl)ethyl]pyrolidine (for preparation see J. Med. Chem. 34, 1991 pp181. Costello, G. F. et. al m.p. 179-181) C: 1H NMR (Mesylate salt, CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 2.0-2.2 (br, m, 4H), 2.8 (s, 3H), 3.0 (s, 3H), 3.6 (d, 2H), 6.2-6.3 (d, 1H), 7.1 (m, 3H), 7.2 (m, 1H), 7.3 (m, 3H), 7.7 (d, 2H). Fab MS (MH+): 415. Anal. Calcd. for C23H33O6N3S2: C, 53.99; H, 6.50; N, 8.21. Found C, 53.98; H, 6.41; N, 8.10.
  • EXAMPLE 3zz (R,S)-1-(4-Trifluoromethylphenyl-N-methylacetamido)-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane, methanesulfonic acid salt
  • The procedure is the same as that of 3uu. Yield: 74%. Mp.: 166-168° C. .NMR (CDCl3), δ: 2.11 (2H, m), 2.16-2.32 (2H, m), 2.81 (3H, s), 2.85-2.98 (4H, m), 3.12-3.21 (1H, m), 3.75 (3H, s), 3.83 (1H, m), 4.054.33 (4H, m), 6.30 (1H, dd, J=2.6, 12.0 Hz), 6.67 (1H, d, J=1.8 Hz), 6.75 (1H, d, J=7.6 Hz), 6.87 (1H, dd, J=2.4, 8.3 Hz), 7.30 (1H, m), 7.45 (1H, d, J=8.1 Hz), 7.57 (1H, d, J=8.1 Hz). MS (FAB) m/z 421. Anal. (C, H, N)C23H27N2O2F3.CH3SO3H.
  • EXAMPLE 3aaa (R,S)-1-(4-Trifluoromethylphenyl-N-methylacetamido)-1-(3-hydroxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane, methanesulfonic acid salt
  • The procedure is the same as that of 3vv. Yield: 38.5%. Mp: 158-160° C. NMR (CDCl3), δ: 2.01-2.14 (4H, m), 2.73 (3H, s), 2.82 (3H, s), 2.94 (2H, m), 3.30 (1H, m), 3.76 (1H, m), 4.03-4.14 (4H, m), 6.20 (1H, dd, J=3.3, 11.0 Hz), 6.63 (1H, d, J=7.9 Hz), 6.86 (1H, dd, J=1.8, 8.0 Hz), 7.06 (1H, s), 7.18 (1H, t, J=8.0 Hz), 7.41 (2H, d, J=8.0 Hz), 7.56 (2H, d, J=8.0 Hz).). MS (FAB) m/z 407. Anal. (C, H, N)C22H25N2O2F3.1.1CH3SO3H.
  • EXAMPLE 3bbb 2-Fluorophenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]-acetamide hydrochloride
  • Compound 3bbb was prepared using the same general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure as described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955 with 2-fluorophenylacetic acid (415 mg; 2.69 mmol), HOBT (363 mg; 2.69 mmol), EDCI (514 mg; 2.69 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.63 mL; 3.66 mmol), and (1S) 1-[(2-methylamino-2-phenyl)ethyl]pyrrolidine (500 mg; 2.44 mmol) in 10 mL of dry methylene chloride at room temperature. After 24 h, TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol w/ 2% ammonia) indicated the reaction was complete. The reaction solution was quenched with sat. sodium bicarbonate and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried over anh. sodium sulfate, filtered and conc. in vacuo to give 900 mg of a dark brown oil which was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 4% methanol:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to yield 750 mg (90%) of desired product which was converted to the hydrochloride salt with HCl/ether to give 880 mg of 3bbb. m.p. 255° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (HCl salt, CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H), 2.1-2.2 (br, m, 2H), 2.9 (s, 3H), 3.8-4.0 (dd, 4H), 7.0-7.4 (complex, 9H, aromatic). Fab MS (MH+): 340. Anal. Calcd. for C21H25ON2F.HCl: C, 66.97; H, 6.95; N, 7.43. Found C, 66.76; H, 6.90; N, 7.43.
  • EXAMPLE 3ccc 4-Fluorophenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride (3ccc)
  • Compound 3ccc was prepared using the same general EDCI/DIPEA coupling procedure from U.S. Pat. No. 5,688,955 with 4-fluorophenylacetic acid (415 mg; 2.69 mmol), HOBT (363 mg; 2.69 mmol), EDCI (514 mg; 2.69 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.63 mL; 3.66 mmol) and (1S) 1-[(2-methylamino-2-phenyl)ethyl]pyrrolidine (500 mg; 2.44 mmol) in 10 mL of dry methylene chloride at room temperature. After 24 h, TLC (95:5 methylene chloride:methanol w/ 2% ammonia) indicated the reaction was complete. The reaction was quenched with sat. sodium bicarbonate and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried over anh. sodium sulfate, filtered and conc. in vacuo to give 900 mg of a dark brown oil which was purified by flash chromatography using a stepwise gradient of 2% to 3% methanol:methylene chloride with 2% ammonia to yield 800 mg (96%) of desired product which was converted to the hydrochloride salt with HCl in ether to give 3ccc. m.p. >260° C. (dec.); 1H NMR (HCl salt; CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 2.0 (br, m, 4H), 2.1-2.2 (br, m, 2H), 2.9 (s, 3H), 3.8-4.0 (dd, 4H), 7.0-7.4 (complex, 9H, aromatic). Fab MS (MH+): 340. Anal Calcd for C21H25ON2HCl: C, 66.82; H, 6.95; N, 7.43. Found C, 66.81; H, 6.94; N, 7.48
  • EXAMPLE 3ddd (E)-4-[2-(2-Amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl]acetamido]4-oxo-2-butenoic acid hydrochloride
  • To a solution of 3y (1.4 g, 2.63 mmol) in THF:CH3OH (1:1, 20 mL) at room temperature was added 1M LiOH aqueous solution (5.3 mL, 5.26 mmol) and the reaction mixture was stirred for 8 h. Progress of reaction was followed by TLC and reaction mixture was acidified to pH 4.0 from 1N HCl. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was triturated with CH2Cl2 (3×45 mL). The combined organic layer was washed with sat. salt solution which resulted in the precipitation of the compound. The solid was filtered off, washed with a small amount of water, anhydrous ether, and dried to give 3ddd 0, 0.85 g (59%); mp 205-207° C. (d); 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.93 (m, 4H), 2.84 (s, 3H), 3.00-3.75 (m, 6H), 3.98 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 4.05 (m, 1H), 4.35 (d, J=16.5 Hz, 1H), 6.12 (m, 1H), 6.65 (d, J=15.4 Hz, 1H), 7.25-7.38 (m, 5H), 7.55 (s, 1H), 7.79 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 8.31 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd. for C25H27Cl2N3O4HCl.NaCl.1.5H2O: C, 47.94; H, 4.99; N, 6.71. Found: C, 47.98; H, 4.92; N, 6.57.
  • Compounds of Formula IV
  • Intermediates
  • The following intermediates were prepared.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00072
  • (±)-trans-2-Pyrrolidinyl-N-methylcyclohexylamine (3)
  • The racemic diamine (3) was prepared by a number of procedure reported in the literature.10,11 Alternatively, the amine was also prepared from cyclohexene oxide (1) following the procedure described in Scheme I and the literature in 70% overall yield as brown oil. A sample was purified by the distillation (b.p. 75-82° C./1.0 mm, lit.2 b.p. 76-80° C./1.2 mm); 1H-NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.04-1.36 (m, 4H), 1.49-1.89 (m, 8H), 2.18 (d, J=5.0 Hz, 1H), 2.52 (s, 3H), 2.56-2.70 (m, 4H), 2.80-2.93 (m, 1H), 7.75 (bs, 1H). The corresponding chiral amine (3) could be prepared following the literature procedures.
  • Ref.
    • (10) Szmuszkovicz, J.; Von Voigtlander, P. F. J. Med. Chem. 1982, 25, 1125-1126.
    • (11) DeCosata, B.; George, C.; Rothman, R. B.; Jacobson, A. E.; Rice, K. E. FEBBS Lett. 1987, 223, 335-339.
    • (12) Freeman, J. P.; Michalson, E. T.; D'Andrea, S. V.; Baczynskyj, L.; Von Voigtlander, P. F.; Lahti, R. A.; Smith, M. W.; Lawson, C. F.; Scahill, T. A.; Mizsak, S. A.; Szmuszkovicz, J. J. Med. Chem. 1991, 34, 1891-1896.
  • Synthesis of Arylacetamides
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00073
  • General procedure for the preparation of aryl acetamides (±) 5 HCl
  • To a stirred solution of aryl acetic acid (4) (1.5 mmol) in 20 mL of dry CH2Cl2 was added pyridine (0.5 mmol) at 065° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere. N,N′-Dicyclohexyl-carbodiimide (2.0 mmol) was added in one portion and the reaction mixture was continued stirring for 30 min while warming to room temperature. A solution of the (±) 3 (1.0 mml) in 10 mL of dry CH2Cl2 was added and the progress of the reaction was monitored by TLC in solvent system corresponds to CHCl3:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (93:5:2). After disappearance of the diamine 3, the reaction mixture was quenched with saturated NaHCO3 and stirring was continued for addition 15 min. The precipitated N,N′-dicyclohexylurea (DCU) was removed by filtration and the filter cake was washed with additional amounts of CH2Cl2. The combined filtrate was evaporated to dryness and the residue was purified either on a silica gel column or using Chromatotran silica gel plattes form the from the solvent system mentioned for each compound to give (±) 5 as free base. The hydrochloride salts were prepared from dissolving (±) 5 in minimum amount of CH2Cl2 and addition of 2.0 equivalents of 1M etherial HCl. The solvents were removed under reduced pressure and the HCl salts were recystallized from the solvents indicated below. The yields given below are for overall steps.
  • EXAMPLE 103 (±)-trans-2-Nitro-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5a HCl]
  • Prepared from 2-nitrophenylacetic acid [solvent for purification—CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (98:2:2)]: yield 21% as a white solid (2-prppanol); mp 267-269° C. (d); 1H NMR ((200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.00-1.44 (m, 2H), 1.60-2.35 (m, 8H), 2.85 (m, 1H), 3.15 (s, 3H), 3.18-3.35 (m, 4H), 3.40 (m, 1H), 3.85 (m, 1H), 4.33 (dd, J=10.0 Hz, 2H), 4.64 (m, 1H), 7.35 (m, 1H), 7.56 (m, 2H), 8.05 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 11.02 (bs, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C19H27N3O3.HCl: C, 59.75; H, 7.39; Cl, 9.28; N, 11.00. Found: C, 59.98; H, 7.38; 8.96; N, 10.85.
  • EXAMPLE 104 (±)-trans-2-Amino-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5b HCl]
  • To a solution of (±) 5a HCl (0.5 g, 1.31 nmol) in 30 mL of CH3OH was added 10% Pd/C (100 mg) and hydrogenated at 50 PSI in a Parr Apparatus at ambient temperature for 3 h. The catalyst was removed by filtration through a celite pad and washed with hot CH3OH and the combined filtrate was evaporated to dryness. The residue was recrystallized from 2-propanol to give (±) 5b HCl as a white solid, 0.45 g (95%); mp 213-215° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.05-1.40 (m, 2H), 1.65-2.25 (m, 8H), 3.10 (s, 3H), 2.90-3.25 (m, 4H), 3.50 (d, J=12.0, 1H), 3.65 (m, 1H), 3.88 (m, 1H), 4.20 (d, J=12.5 Hz, 1H), 4.70 (m, 1H), 6.65 (m, 2H), 7.00 (m, 2H), 7.25 (bs, 2H). Anal. Calcd for C19H29N3O.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 63.23; H, 8.66; N, 11.64. Found: C, 63.59; H, 8.76; N, 11.61.
  • EXAMPLE 105 (±)-trans-2-Nitro-4,5-dichloro-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5c HCl]
  • The compound was prepared according to the literature method (DeCosata, B.; Linda, B.; Rothman, R. B.; Jacobson, A. E.; Bykov, V.; Pert, A.; Rice, K. E. FEBBS Lett. 1989, 249, 178-182); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.15-1.45 (m, 2H), 1.55-2.30 (m, 8H), 3.10 (s, 3H), 2.85-3.20 (m, 4H), 3.40 (m, 1H), 3.88 (m, 1H), 4.25 (d, J=14.5 Hz, 1H), 4.45 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 4.65 (m, 1H), 7.70 (s, 1H), 8.13 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C19H25Cl2N3O3.HCl: C, 50.62; H, 5.81; N, 9.32. Found: C, 50.61; H, 5.61; N, 9.20.
  • EXAMPLE 106 (±)-trans-2-Amino-4,5-dichloro-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5d HCl]
  • Obtained from (±) 5c HCl following the literature procedure (DeCosata, B.; Linda, B.; Rothman, R. B.; Jacobson, A. E.; Bykov, V.; Pert, A.; Rice, K. E. FEBBS Lett. 1989, 249, 178-182); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.10-1.40 (m, 4H), 1.48-2.20 (m, 8H), 3.00 (s, 3H), 3.10-3.30 (m, 4H), 3.55 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.85 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 6.75 (s, 1H), 7.08 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C19H27Cl2N3O.HCl.0.75H2O: C, 52.54; H, 6.84; N, 9.67. Found: C, 52.561; H, 6.63; N, 9.33.
  • EXAMPLE 107 (±)-trans-2-Methanesulfonamido-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5e HCl]
  • To a solution of free base of (±) 5b (1.0 g, 3.2 mmol) in 40 mL of dry CH2Cl2 at 0° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere was added Et3N (1.86 g, 18.4 mmol). A solution of methanesulfonyl chloride (1.14 g, 9.92 mmol) in 15 mL of dry CH2Cl2 was added dropwise within 15 min. After 2 h at room temperature TLC [solvent system: CHCl3:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (93:5:2)] showed still staring material was present. Additional amounts of Et3N (1.86 g) and methanesulfonyl chloride (1.14 g) were added and stirring was continued for another 2 h by this time no starting material was present in the reaction mixture. After the mixture was diluted with 40 mL CH2Cl2 of, it was washed with saturated NaHCO3, water, saturated salt solution, and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. Removal of solvent under reduced pressure gave the bis-sulfoamide as a brown foam which was used directly in the following hydrolysis.
  • To a solution of bis-sulfonamide (1.0 g, 2.12 mmol) in 60 mL of CH3OH:THF (2:1) was added 10 M aqueous NaOH (0.96 mL, 9.6 mmol).13 The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 30 min and then acidified with 1N HCl. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue was redissolved in CH2Cl2. The CH2Cl2 layer was then washed with 5% NaHCO3, saturated salt solution, and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. Removal of solvent under reduced pressure chromatography on a silica gel column [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NHOH (95:5:2)] gave the mono-sulfonamide (free base) as an oil; 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.05-1.95 (m, 12H), 2.45-2.80 (m, 5H), 2.95 (s, 3H), 3.10 (s, 3H), 3.50 (d, J=13.8 Hz, 1H), 3.65 (m, 1H), 3.85 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 4.45 (m, 1H), 7.05 (m, 1H), 7.15 (m, 2H), 7.45 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 1H). The hydrochloride salt was prepared by dissolving the free base in CH2Cl2 and adding 1.2 equivalents of 1M etherial HCl and recrystallizing from 2-propanol to give (±) 5e HCl as beige colored solid, 0.37 g (38%); mp 229-231° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.10-2.20 (m, 12H), 2.90-3.20 (m, 4H), 3.00 (s, 3H), 3.15 (s, 3H), 3.50 (m, 1H), 3.65 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 2H), 3.80 (m, 1H), 4.40 (m, 1H), 7.05-7.30 (m, 3H), 7.60 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 8.90 (bs, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C20H31N3O3S.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 55.28; H, 7.54; N, 9.67. Found: C, 55.40; H, 7.39; N, 9.49.
  • Ref.
    • (13) Li, C.-S.; Black, W. C.; Chan, C.-C.; Ford-Huctchinson, A. W.; Gauthier, J.-Y.; Gordon, R.; Guay, D; Kargman, S.; Lau, C. K.; Mancini, J.; Ouimet, N.; Roy, P.; Vickers, P.; Wong. E.; Young, R. N.; Zamboni, R.; Prasit, P. J. Med. Chem. 1995, 38, 4897-4905.
    EXAMPLE 108 N-[2-(±)-trans-N-Methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamido]glycine Hydrochloride [(±) 5f HCl]
  • To a stirred solution of (±) 5b (free base, 1.0 g, 3.2 mmol) in 15 mL of dry DMF at room temperature under a nitrogen atmosphere was added 95% NaH (0.083 g, 3.3 mmol). After stirring at room temperature for 30 min, the turbid solution was added to a stirred solution of tert-butyl bromoacetate (0.66 g, 3.4 mmol) in 10 mL of dry DMF. The reaction mixture was continued stirring for 72 h however TLC of the reaction mixture [solvent system: CHCl3:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (93:5:2)] showed still starting material was present. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was partioned between CH2Cl2/water. The product was purified on a silica gel column from CH2Cl2:CH3OH (9:1) and was recystallized from CH2Cl2:Et2O (1:1) to give the corresponding tert-butyl ester, 0.16 (12%); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.05-1.35 (m, 4H), 1.35 (s, 9H), 1.55-2.20 (m, 8H), 2.92 (b, 4H), 3.12 (s, 3H), 3.45 (m, 1H), 3.60 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 2H), 3.78 (bt, 2H), 3.95 (m, 1H), 5.75 (b, 1H), 6.38 (d, J=6.5 Hz, 1H), 6.60 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 1H), 7.00 (m, 2H). The staring material was also recovered in 50% yield.
  • The tert-butyl ester (0.16 g, 0.372 mmol) was suspended in 10 mL of 4N aqueous HCl and added one drop of anisole and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 24 h. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue was redissolved in CH3CN and filtered. The filtrate was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue was recrystallized from 2-propanol:ether (1:1) to give (±) 5f HCl as a white solid, 0.070 g (42%); mp 212-214° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.15-2.25 (m, 12H), 2.90 (m, 1H), 3.05 (s, 3H), 3.14-3.70 (m, 6H), 3.85 (bs, 2H), 4.55 (b, 1H), 6.37 (d, J=6.0 Hz, 1H), 6.55 (t, J=5.0 Hz, 1H), 6.95 (m, 2H), 9.80 (b, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C21H31N3O3.HCl.H2O: C, 58.93; H, 8.00; N, 9.81. Found: C, 58.79; H, 7.64; N, 9.43.
  • EXAMPLE 109 (±)-trans-4-Trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5g HCl]
  • To a solution of 4-trifluoromethylphenyl acetic acid (1.45 g, 7.08 mmol) in 10 mL of dry CH2Cl2 under a nitrogen atmosphere was added 1-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (HOBT) (0.95 g, 7.08 mmol) and stirred. The reaction mixture was cooled to 0→5° C. and added solid EDCI ([1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethyl-carbodiimide HCl])(1.35 g, 7.08 mmol) and stirrat this temperature for 30 min. A solution (±) 3 (1.0 g, 5.48 mmol) in 10 mL of dry CH2Cl2 was added followed by N,N-diisopropylethylamine (Hunig's Base) (0.915 g, 7.08 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred for 24 h while warming to the room temperature. The reaction mixture was then poured on to excess of ice-cold saturated aqueous NaHCO3 solution and stirred for 30 min. After dilution with CH2Cl2, the organic was separated, washed with saturated salt solution, and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. Removal of solvent gave a brown oil which was chromatogrphed on a silica gel column [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (99:1:2)] to give the desired product as free base. The hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl and recrystallized from CH2Cl2: Et2O (1:1) to give (±) 5g HCl as a cream colored solid, 0.68 g (30%); 213-215° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.02-1.47 (m, 4H), 1.52-2.22 (m, 8H), 2.75-2.90 (m, 2H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.07 (m, 1H), 3.37 (m, 1H), 3.62 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 3.77 (m, 1H), 4.17 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 4.57 (m, 1H), 7.30 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.38 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H). Anal. Calcd for C20H27F3N2O.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 58.68; H, 7.02; N, 6.84. Found: C, 58.68; H, 6.84; N, 6.69.
  • Nitration of 4-trifluorometylphenyl acetic acid:
  • General Procedure:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00074

    Preparation of 2-nitro-4-trifluoromethylphenyl acetic acid [4, R=2-NO2(4-CF3)—C6H4CH2]
  • To a solution of 4-trifluoromethylphenyl acetic acid (2.5 g, 12.25 mmol) in 8 mL of glacial acetic acid at 0° C. under an anhydrous atmosphere was added 5 mL of fuming H2SO4 (11% SO3) (caution!) followed by cautious addition of 90% HNO3 (3.5 mL, 73.14 mmol) within 10 min. The reaction mixture was then stirred at room temperature for 2 h and poured into ice-water. The resulting solid was filtered and washed with cold deionized water to give the desired product after drying as off-white solid, 2.5 g (82%); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 4.02 (s, 2H), 7.41 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.74 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 8.28 (s, 1H). The product was used directly into the following reactions.
  • EXAMPLE 110 (±)-trans-2-Nitro-4-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5h HCl]
  • Prepared from 2-nitro-4-trifluoromethylphenyl acetic acid following the procedure described in Example II to give (±) 5h HCl as cream colored solid in 56% yield; mp 259-261° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.10-1.42 (m, 4H), 1.51-2.25 (m, 8H), 2.95-3.25 (m, 3H), 3.14 (s, 3H), 3.40 (m, 1H), 3.90 (m, 1H), 4.35 (d, J=13.8 Hz, 1H), 4.55 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 4.60 (m, 1H), 7.80 (dd, J=7.8 Hz, 2H), 8.25 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C20H26F3N3O3.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 52.86; H, 6.10; N, 9.25. Found: C, 52.85; H, 6.02; N, 9.13.
  • EXAMPLE 111 (±)-trans-2-Amino-4-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5i HCl]
  • To a solution of free base 4h (0.4 g, 0.97 mmol) in 20 mL of absolute alcohol was added 2 ml of hydrazine hydrate and the reaction mixture was stirred at 50° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere. Raney®nickel (50% slurry in water) was added slowly and the progress of the reaction was monitored on TLC plate [solvent system: CHCl3:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (99:1:2)]. If needed more of the Raney®nickel was added to the reaction mixture. When reaction was completed, excess of Raney®nickel was introduced to decompose the hydrazine hydrate. The reaction mixture was filtered through a celite pad and the pad was washed with hot CH3OH. The filtrate was evaporated to dryness. The residue was purified on a silica gel column [solvent system: CHCl3:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (99:1:2)] and the hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl. Recrystallization from CH2Cl2:Et2O (2:1) gave (±) 5i HCl as a white solid, 0.2 g (48%); mp 248-250° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.15-2.18 (m, 12H), 3.00 (s, 3H), 3.154.10 (m, 7H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 6.80 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 6.92 (s, 1H), 7.10 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 10.0 (bs, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C20H28F3N3O.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 56.01; H, 7.05; N, 9.80. Found: C, 55.70; H, 7.03; N, 9.65.
  • EXAMPLE 112 (±)-trans-2-Bismethanesulfonamido-4-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5j HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from free base (±) 5i (0.5 g, 1.30 mmol) following the procedure described in the first part of the preparation of (±) 5e. The bismethaneslfonamide was purified on a silica gel column [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (96:2:2)] to give the desired product as a foam. The hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etheial HCl and recrystallized from 2-propanol:Et2O (1:1) to give (±) 5j HCl as a beige colored solid, 0.23 g (30%); mp 224-226° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.12-1.51 (m, 4H), 1.53-2.24 (m, 8H), 1.82-3.17 (m, 2H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.32-3.56 (m, 2H), 3.28 (s, 3H), 3.33 (s, 3H), 3.77 (m, 1H), 3.97 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 4.27 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 4.62 (m, 1H), 7.39 (s, 1H), 7.55 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.85 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 111). Anal. Calcd for C22H32F3N3O5S2.HCl: C, 45.87; H, 5.77; N, 7.29. Found: C, 45.53; H, 5.81; N, 7.00.
  • EXAMPLE 113 (±)-trans-2-Methanesulfonamido-4-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5k HCl]
  • To a solution of (±) 5j HCl (0.16 g, 0.23 mmol) in 9 mL of CH3OH:THF (2:1) at room temperature was added 0.12 mL of 10M aqueous NaOH and the mixture was stirred for 30 min. The reaction mixture was neutralized with 1N HCl and evaporated to dryness. The residue was redissolved in CH2Cl2 and basified with saturated aqueous solution of NaHCO3. The organic layer was separated, washed with water, saturated salt solution, and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. Removal of solvent under reduced pressure gave the product as a free base. The hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl and recrystallized from CH2Cl2: Et2O (1:1) to give (±) 5k HCl as a beige colored solid, 0.085 g (61%); 209-211° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.15-1.24 (m, 4H), 1.50-2.10 (m, 8H), 2.20 (m, 2H), 2.90-3.10 (m, 2H), 3.05 (s, 6H), 3.55 (m, 2H), 3.80 (m, 1H), 4.64 (m, 1H), 7.20 (dd, J=7.8 Hz, 2H), 7.88 (s, 1H), 9.00 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C21H30F3N3O3S.HCl.0.125H2O: C, 50.42; H, 6.30; N, 8.40. Found: C, 50.62; H, 6.49; N, 8.00.
  • EXAMPLE 114 N-[2-(±)-trans-4-Trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamido]glycine Hydrochloride [(±) 5l HCl]
  • To a solution of free base (±) 5i (0.767, 2.0 mmol) in 10 mL of anhydrous THF under a nitrogen atmosphere at 0° C. was added N,N-diisopropylethylamine (Hunig's Base) (1.55 g, 12.0 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 15 min then added bromoacetic acid t-butyl ester (1.95 g, 10.0 mmol) and the reaction mixture was continued to stir while warming to room temperature 72 h. The solvent was evaporated at reduced pressure and the residue was partitioned between CH2Cl2 and water. The organic layer was then washed with, saturated NaHCO3, saturated salt solution, and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. Removal of solvent gave the crude product which was purified on a silica gel column [solvent system: CHCl3:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (96:2:2)] to give the intermediate t-butyl ester 0.477 g (40%); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.05-1.25 (m, 4H), 1.38-1.90 (m, 8H), 1.40 (s, 9H), 2.15-2.75 (m, 5H), 2.85 (s, 3H), 3.60 (m, 2H), 3.75 (d, J=4.0 Hz, 2H), 4.45 (m, 1H), 5.85 (m, 1H), 6.55 (s, 1H), 6.80 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 7.10 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H).
  • The above t-butyl ester (0.47 g, 0.77 mmol) was suspended in 10 mL of aqueous 4N HCl and added 2-3 drops of anisole. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 72 h and filtered. The filtrate was evaporated to dryness, redissolved in CH3CN, filtered again, and concentrated. Addition of the ether gave the product which was filtered, washed with ether, and dried to give (±) 5l HCl as a beige colored solid, 0.17 g (41%); mp 178-180° C. (d); MS (FAB) 442 (M+1); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.05-2.20 (m, 12H), 2.75 (s, 3H), 2.90-3.25 (m, 5H), 3.30-3.55 (m, 2H), 3.70-4.35 (m, 4H), 4.65 (m, 1H), 6.72 (s, 1H), 6.80 (m, 1H), 6.95 (d, J=7.7 Hz, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C22H30F3N3O3.HCl.0.125Et2O: C, 55.47; H, 6.67; N, 8.62. Found: C, 55.64; H, 7.06; N, 9.00.
  • EXAMPLE 115 (±)-trans-3-Trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5m HCl]
  • Following the Example II, (±) 5m HCl was prepared from 3-trifluoromethylphenyl acetic acid in 67% yield as a cream colored solid; mp 245-247° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.15-1.55 (m, 4H), 1.60-2.30 (m, 8H), 2.80-3.05 (m, 2H), 3.00 (s, 3H), 3.18 (m, 1H), 3.45 (m, 1H), 3.75 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 3.85 (m, 1H), 4.25 (d, J=14.8 Hz, 1H), 4.65 (m, 1H), 7.40 (m, 4H). Anal. Calcd for C20H27F3N2O.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 58.68; H, 7.02; N, 6.84. Found: C, 58.46; H, 7.17; N, 6.69.
  • Nitration of 3-trifluorometylphenyl acetic acid:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00075
  • Preparation of 2-nitro-3-trifluoromethylphenyl acetic acid [4, R=2-NO2(3-CF3)—C6H4CO2H] and Preparation of 5-nitro-3-trifluoromethylphenyl acetic acid [4, R=5-NO2(3-CF3)—C6H4CO2H]
  • The nitration of 3-trifluorophenylacetic acid as shown earlier resulted into a 1:1 non-separable mixture of 2- and 5-nitro compounds in 66% yield. The structural assignment of the compounds were made on the basis of 1H NMR spectrum. The mixture was used in the condensation reaction.
  • EXAMPLE 116 (±)-trans-5-Nitro-3-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5n HCl] and (±)-trans-2-Nitro-3-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5o HCl]
  • The compounds were prepared as shown in Example 109 and the mixture of 2- and 5-nitrophenylacetic acids to give the mixture of products. Initially the compounds were separated on a silica gel column [solvent system: CHCl3:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (96:2:2)] which resulted in the free base of the compounds as pure mixture. The products were again purified on Chromatotran using a 4 mm silica gel plate [solvent system: CHCl3 containing 2% NH4OH]. The first product was isolated and converted to the hydrochloride salt and the salt was recrystallized from 2-propanol:ether (1:1) to give (±) 5n HCl as a cream colored solid in 10% yield; mp 236-238° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.15-1.55 (m, 4H), 1.65-2.30 (m, 8H), 2.85-3.20 (m, 3H), 3.10 (s, 3H), 3.40 (m, 1H), 3.70 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.85 (m, 1H), 4.60 (brd, 2H), 7.90 (s, 1H), 8.25 (s, 1H), 8.32 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C20H26F3N3O3.HCl: C, 53.39; H, 6.05; N, 9.34. Found: C, 53.28; H, 6.06; N, 9.36.
  • The second product, (±) 5o HCl, was also isolated in 10% yield after the recrystallization of the hydrochloride salt from 2-propanol:ether (1:1) as a white solid; mp 243-245° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.10-1.50 (m, 4H), 1.55-2.20 (m, 8H), 2.90-3.20 (m, 3H), 3.10 (s, 3H), 3.44 (m, 1H), 3.65 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 3.90 (m, 1H), 4.65 (brd, 2H), 7.70 (s, 1H), 7.82 (s, 2H). Anal. Calcd for C20H26F3N3O3.HCl.H2O: C, 51.34; H, 6.25; N, 8.98. Found: C, 51.69; H, 6.24; N, 8.89.
  • EXAMPLE 117 (±)-trans-2-Trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5p HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 2-trfluoromethylphenylacetic acid following the Example II. The hydrochloride salt was made from 1M etherial HCl and recrystallized from 2-propanol:ether (1:1) to give (±) 5p HCl in 20% yield as a white solid; mp 282-284° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.20-1.50 (m, 4H), 1.55-2.30 (m, 8H), 3.85-3.04 (m, 2H), 3.08 (s, 3H), 3.10-3.27 (m, 1H), 3.40-3.60 (m, 1H), 3.90 (m, d, J=14.5 Hz, 2H), 4.26 (d, J=14.7 Hz, 1H), 4.63 (m, 1H), 7.26 (t, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.45 (t, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.60 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 2H). Anal. Calcd for C20H27F3N2O.HCl: C, 59.33; H, 6.97; N, 6.92. Found: C, 59.28; H, 6.73; N, 6.84.
  • Nitration of 2-trifluorometylphenyl acetic acid:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00076
  • Preparation of 4-nitro-2-trifluoromethylphenyl acetic acid [4, R=4-NO2(2-CF3)—C6H4CO2H]
  • The nitration of 2-trifluorophenylacetic acid as depicted in Scheme III gave mostly the corresponding 4-nitro derivative and only a trace amount of 6-nitro compound was detected in the proton NMR; 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 3.90 (s, 2H), 7.55 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 8.35 (dd, J=2.4, 8.0 Hz, 1H), 8.50 (d, J=2.4 Hz, 1H). The compound was used directly into the following coupling reaction.
  • EXAMPLE 118 (±)-trans-4-Nitro-2-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5q HCl]
  • The compound was prepared following the coupling method described in Example 109 from 4-nitro-2-trifluorophenylacetic acid. The hydrochloride salt was prepared by known method and recrystallized from 2-propanol:ether (1:1) to give (±) 5q HCl as a beige colored solid in 37% yield; mp 265-267° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.15-1.45 (m, 4H), 1.50-2.30 (m, 8H), 2.85-3.20 (m, 3H), 3.05 (s, 3H), 3.45 (m, 1H), 3.90 (m, d, J=14.0 Hz, 2H), 4.60 (brd, 2H), 8.00 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 8.25 (dd, J=2.4, 8.0 Hz, 1H), 8.40 (d, J=2.4 Hz, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C20H26F3N3O3.HCl: C, 53.39; H, 6.05; N, 9.34. Found: C, 53.29; H, 5.93; N, 9.17.
  • EXAMPLE 119 (±)-trans-4-Amino-2-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5r 2HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from free base (±) 5q following the reduction procedure described for the preparation of (±) 5h. The free base was converted to di-hydrochloride from 1M etherial HCl and recrystallized from CH2Cl2:CH3OH:Et2O (6:3:1) to give (±) 5r 2HCl as a White solid in 68% yield; mp 288-290° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.10-2.20 (m, 12H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.00-3.30 (m, 4H), 3.50 (m, 1H), 3.80 (d, J=14.5 Hz, 1H), 4.20 (d, J=14.8 Hz, 1H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 7.50 (m, 3H). Anal. Calcd for C20H28F3N30.2HCl: C, 52.64; H, 6.63; N, 9.21. Found: C, 52.67; H, 6.52; N, 9.06.
  • EXAMPLE 120 (±)-trans-N-Methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]2,2-dphenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5s HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from diphenylacetic acid following the general procedure for the preparation of aryl acetamides. The hydrochloride salt was recrystallized from 2-propanol to give (±) 5s HCl as a white solid in 20% yield; mp 295-297° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.20-2.40 (m, 12H), 2.85-3.15 (m, 2H), 3.00 (s, 3H), 3.25-3.60 (m, 2H), 3.95 (m, 1H), 4.75 (m, 1H), 5.70 (s, 1H), 7.35 (m, 10H). Anal. Calcd for C25H32N2O.HCl.0.25H2O: C, 71.92; H, 8.09; N, 6.71. Found: C, 72.25; H, 8.40; N, 6.52.
  • EXAMPLE 121 (±)-trans-4-Methylsulfonyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]phenylacetamide Hydrochloride [(±) 5t HCl]
  • The compound was prepared from 4-methylsulfonylphenylacetic acid to the method of Example 109 and the hydrochloride salt was recrystallized from CH2Cl2:ET2O (1:1) to give (±) 5t HCl as a cream colored solid in 50% yield; mp 152-154° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.10-2.30 (m, 12H), 2.95 (s, 6H), 3.00-3.25 (m, 2H), 3.40 (m, 1H), 3.65 (d, J=14.5 Hz, 1H), 3.85 (m, 1H), 4.35 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 4.67 (m, 1H), 7.45 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.80 (d, J=8.0
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00077

    Hz, 2H). Anal. Calcd for C20H30N2O3S.HCl.1.5H2O: C, 54.35; H, 7.75; N, 6.34. Found: C, 54.20; H, 7.38; N, 6.15.
  • Preparation of compounds 4a through 41 of formula IVA is according to Scheme 0.
  • The chiral compounds were prepared from the enantiomeric pure diamine B.
  • EXAMPLE 4a (Z)-4-[2-((±)-trans-2-Amino-4,5-dichloro-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-cyclohexyl]phenylaetamido)]4-oxo-2-butenoic acid
  • To a solution of (±)-trans-2-amino-4,5-dichloroN-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide3 (0.12 g, 0.312 mmol) in anhydrous THF (2.5 mL) under a nitrogen atmosphere was added maleic anhydride (0.03 g, 0.312 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 3 days. The precipitated solid was filtered off, washed with anhydrous THF, and dried to give 4a (0.088 g, 58%); mp 246-248° C. (d); MS (FAB) 482 (M+). Anal. Calcd. for C23H29Cl2N3O4.H2O: C, 55.20; H, 6.24; N, 8.40. Found: C, 55.32; H, 6.01; N, 8.09.
  • Ref.
    • 3. de Costa, B. R. et. al. FEBS Lett. 249, 178-182 (1989).
    EXAMPLE 4b (Z)-4-[2-((±)-trans-2-Amino-4-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-cyclohexyl]-phenylaetamido)]4-oxo-2-butenoic acid
  • The compound 4b was prepared from (±)-trans-2-amino-4-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-cyclohexyl]phenylacetamide1 following the above procedure in 60% yield; mp 256-258° C.; 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d) δ 1.15-2.18 (m, 12H), 3.01 (s, 3H), 3.15-4.10 (m, 7H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 5.95 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 6.35 (d, J=14.5 Hz, 1H), 7.37 (m, 2H), 8.16 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C24H30F3N3O4: C, 59.87; H, 6.28; N, 8.37. Found: C, 59.64; H, 6.14; N, 8.57.
  • EXAMPLE 4c (±)-trans-2-N-Methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-pyridylacetamide dihydrochloride
  • The compound 4c was prepared from 2-pyridyl acetic acid hydrochloride and (±)-trans-2-pyrrolidinyl-N-methylcyclohexylamine3 following the general procedure in 37% yield; mp 264-266° C. (d); 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.10-2.00 (m, 12H), 3.04 (s, 3H), 3.15-4.70 (m, 5H), 4.30 (d, J=16 Hz, 1), 4.55 (m, 1H), 4.67 (d, J=16.0 Hz, 1H), 7.82 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 8.10 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 8.55 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 8.88 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C18H27N30.2HCl.0.25H2O: C, 57.07; H, 7.85; N, 11.09. Found: C, 57.04; H, 7.48; N, 10.69.
  • EXAMPLE 4d (±)-trans-3-N-Methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-5-bromo-pyridylacetamide hydrochloride
  • The compound 4d was prepared 5-bromo-3-pyridyl acetic acid in 77% yield; mp 130-132° C.; 1H NMR (free base 200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.00-2.00 (m, 12H), 2.88 (s, 3H), 2.35-2.77 (m, 5H), 3.75 (m, 2H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 7.65 (bs, 1H), 8.30 (bs, 1H), 8.67(s, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C18H26BrN3O.HCl: C, 51.87; H, 6.53; N, 10.08. Found: C, 51.48; H, 6.11; N, 9.70.
  • EXAMPLE 4e (±)-trans-3,5-Di-Trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-Pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]phenylacetamide hydrochloride
  • Prepared from 3,5-di-trifluoromethyl-phenyl acetic acid in 27% yield; mp 211-213° C.; 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.20-2.25 (m, 12H), 3.04 (s, 3H), 3.00-3.35 (m, 3H), 3.50 (m, 1H), 3.80 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 4.00 (m, 1H), 4.60 (m, 2H), 7.75 (s, 1H), 7.84 (s, 2H). Anal. Calcd for C21H26F6N2O.HCl: C, 53.34; H, 5.75; N, 5.92. Found: C, 53.14; H, 5.74; N, 5.76.
  • EXAMPLE 4f (±)-trans-3-N-Methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-(trans-3-furyl)acetamide hydrochloride
  • The compound 4f was prepared from trans-3-furan acrylic acid in 56% yield; mp 164-166° C. (d); 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.20-2.25 (m, 12H), 3.15(s, 3H), 2.75-3.95 (m, 4H), 4.70 (m, 2H), 6.57 (bs, 1H), 6.65 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 7.34 (s, 1H), 7.46 (d, J=15.2 Hz, 1H), 7.55 (s, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C18H26N2O3.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 62.15; H, 8.11; N, 8.05. Found: C, 61.94; H, 8.01; N, 7.91.
  • EXAMPLE 4g (±)-trans-2-Methoxy-3-methylsulfamoyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-Pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]phenylacetamide hydrochloride
  • The compound 4g was prepared from 2-methoxy-3-methylsulfamoyl-phenyl acetic acid (prepared from methyl 2-methoxy phenyl acetic acid by the procedure reported earlier) in 45% yield; mp 168-170° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.15-2.20 (m, 12H), 2.52 (d, J=2.5 Hz, 3H), 2.76 (s, 3H), 2.40-2.70 (m, 4H), 3.58 (d, J=5.0 Hz, 1H), 3.79 (s, 3H), 3.84 (d, J=4.8 Hz, 1H), 4.75 (m, 2H), 6.84 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 1H), 7.65 (m, 2H). Anal. Calcd for C21H33N3O4S.HCl.0.5H2O: C, 53.78; H, 7.52; N, 8.96. Found: C, 53.80; H, 7.50; N, 8.90.
  • EXAMPLE 4h (±)-trans-3-N-Methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]indoleacetamide hydrochloride
  • Prepared from indole 3-acetic acid in 61% yield; 262-264° C.; 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.20-2.15 (m, 12H), 2.95 (s, 3H), 2.97-3.55 (m, 4H), 3.83 (s, 2H), 4.55 (m, 2H), 6.96 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 7.02 (t, J=7.0 Hz, 1H), 7.17 (s, 1H), 7.31 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.57 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C21H29N3O.0.9HCl: C, 67.75; H, 8.10; N, 11.29. Found: C, 67.78; H, 8.12; N, 11.22.
  • EXAMPLE 4i (±)-trans-4-Fluoro-3-methylsulfamoyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]phenylacetamide hydrochloride
  • The compound 4i was prepared from 4-fluroro-3-methylsulfamoyl phenyl acetic acid in 48% yield; mp 265-267° C.; 1H NMR (200 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.30-2.20 (m, 12H), 2.60 (s, 3H), 3.06 (s, 3H), 3.15-3.80 (m, 4H), 3.91 (d, J=15.0 Hz, 1H), 4.20 (d, J=15.5 Hz, 1H), 4.65 (m, 1H), 7.50 (t, J=8.0 Hz, 1H, 7.75 (m, 2H). Anal. Calcd for C20H30FN3O3S.HCl.H2O: C, 51.55; H, 7.14; N, 9.02. Found: C, 51.93; H, 6.81; N, 8.70.
  • EXAMPLE 4j N-[1S. 2S-trans-4-Trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamido]glycine Hydrochloride
  • 1S, 2S-trans-2-Nitro-4-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide hydrochloride
  • To a solution of (1S, 2S)-(±)-trans-2-pyrrolidinyl-N-methylcyclohexylamine3 (1.9 g, 10.42 mmol) in anhydrous CH2Cl (25 mL) under a nitrogen atmosphere was added 2-nitro-4-trifluorophenyl acetic acid1 (3.9 g, 15.63 mmol) and pyridine (0.42 mL, 5.21 mmol). The reaction mixture was cooled to 0° C. and added DCC (4.3 g, 20.84 mmol) in one portion and stirred the mixture for 3.5 h. The TLC [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (95:5:2)] showed no starting material was present. The DCU was removed by filtration and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was partitioned between 10% citric acid (100 mL) and ether (100 mL). The ether layer was discarded and the aqueous layer was washed with ether twice. The aqueous layer was then made alkaline from 28% ammonia hydroxide and the product was extracted with CH2Cl2. The organic layer was separated, dried over anhydrous Na2SO4, and evaporated to dryness to give the crude product. The hydrochloride salt was prepared from 1M etherial HCl and recrystallized from 2-prppanol:ether (1:1) to give the desired product, 4.2 g (97%); [α]18.8 589 −20.42° (c 1.01, CH3OH); 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.20-2.35 (m, 12H), 298-3.28 (m, 4H), 3.20 (s, 3H), 3.45 (m, 1H), 3.98 (m, 1H), 4.45 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 4.70 (d, J=14.5 Hz, 1H), 7.80 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 1H), 7.92 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 8.34 (s, 1H). The compound was used directly into the following reaction.
  • 1S,2S-trans-2-Amino-4-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]phenyl-acetamide hydrochloride
  • The above 2-nitro compound as hydrochloride salt (4.1 g, 9.09 mmol) was dissolved in methanol (30 mL), added PtO2 (0.4 g), and hydrogenated at room temperature at atmospheric pressure for 1 h. The catalyst was filtered off, washed with hot methanol and the combined filtrate was evaporated to dryness. The residue was re-crystallized from ethyl acetate to give the 2-amino compound as hydrochloride salt, 3.2 g (84%); [α]18.6 589 −6.48° (free base, c 0.51, CH3OH); 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.25-2.35 (m, 12H), 3.00-3.30 (m, 4H), 3.15 (s, 3H), 3.45 (m, 1H), 3.97 (m, 1H), 4.35 (m, 1H), 4.80 (m, 1H), 6.90 (s, d, 2H), 7.05 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 1H). The free base of the 2-amino compound was used to prepare the target compound.
  • The 2-amino compound (free base, 2.8 g, 7.30 mmol) was dissolved in anhydrous THF (20 mL) under a nitrogen atmosphere. N,N-Diisopropylethylamine (1.88 g, 14.60 mmol) was added at room temperature followed by t-butyl bromoacetate (2.14 g, 11.0 mmol) and the reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 3 days. The TLC [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NOH (95:5:2)] showed still starting material was pesent, the reaction mixture was heated to 60-70° C. (oil-bath temperature) for 48 h after the addition of N,N-diisopropylethylamine (1.88 g, 14.60 mmol) and by t-butyl bromoacetate (2.14 g, 11.0 mmol). The reaction mixture was cooled to room temperature and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was then re-dissolved in CH2Cl2, washed with water, 10% aqueous NaHCO3, saturated salt solution, and dried over anhydrous Na2SO4. Removal of solvent at reduced pressure resulted the crude product which was purified on a silica gel column [solvent system: CH2Cl2:CH3OH:28% NH4OH (98:2:2)] to the desired t-butyl ester, 2.3 g (63%), as a foam; %); [α]19.5 589 −9.50 (c 1.0, CH2Cl2); the chiral purity (>90%) of the compound was checked on ChiralPak® AD column; MS (FAB) 498 (M+1); 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.10-2.00 (m, s, 21H), 2.45-2.75 (m, 4H), 2.90 (s, 3H), 3.70 (m, 2H), 3.88 (m, 2H), 4.50 (m, 1H), 6.65 (s, 1H), 6.90 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 1H), 7.20 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 1H).
  • The t-butyl ester (2.1 g, 4.22 mmol) was dissolved in acetic acid (20 mL) and added 4N aqueous HCl (25 mL). After addition of 4 drops of p-anisole, the raction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 4 days. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was re-dissolved in minimum amount of acetonitrile and added excess of ether. The resulting solid was filtered, washed with ether, and dried. Re-crystallization from acetonitrile:ethylacetate (1:1) gave compound 4j (1.0 g, 50%); mp 176-178° C; [α]20.5 589 +6.50 (c 0.5, CH2Cl2); 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.10-2.05 (m, s, 12H), 2.70 (s, 3H), 2.98-3.30 (m, 4H), 3.404.15 (m, 6H), 6.65 (s, 1H), 6.82 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 7.10 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 1H). Anal. Calcd for C22H30FN3O3.HCl: C, 55.29; H, 6.54; N, 8.79. Found: C, 55.61; H, 6.76; N, 8.97.
  • EXAMPLE 4k N-[1R,2R-trans-4-Trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamido]glycine Hydrochloride
  • The compound was prepared from (1R, 2R)-(−)-trans-2-pyrrolidinyl-N-methylcyclohexyl-amine3 (1.9 g, 10.42 mmol) following the above procedures in 36% yield; [α]20.5 589 −7.40 (c 0.52, CH2Cl2). Anal. Calcd for C22H30FN3O3.HCl.0.25 CH3CN: C, 55.35; H, 6.55; N, 9.32. Found: C, 55.78; H, 6.81; N, 9.24.
  • Compounds of Formula IIIB
  • The following is a description of compounds of formula (IIIB) in accordance with an embodiment of the present invention. In this regard, as noted above, in one aspect of the invention, there are provided compounds of formula (IIIB) which have the following structure:
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00078

    wherein:
      • n is an integer from 1 to 3;
      • R1 and R2 are together alkylene of about 4 to about 8 carbons, optionally substituted with a group R′, where R′ is selected from —OH, halogen, —NRaRb, in which Ra and Rb are independently selected from hydrogen, —C(═O)Rc, —SO2Rd and —C(═O)(CH2)mCO2Re, in which Rc and Rd are independently selected from alkyl, aryl and heteroaryl, Re is hydrogen or alkyl and m is an integer from 1 to 3;
      • Ar is unsubstituted phenyl or mono-, di-, tri-, or tetra-substituted phenyl, wherein said substituents are independently selected from halogen; alkyl; alkoxy; aryloxy; aralkyloxy; alkylene dioxide; —OH; —SO2Rf in which Rf is alkyl or aryl; —CN; haloalkyl; —NRgRh, in which Rg and Rh are independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, —C(═O)Rf, —C(═O)—N(Re)2, —S(O)2Rf, and —(CH2)y—CO2Re in which y is an integer from 1 to 3; —S(O)2N(Ri)(Rj), in which Ri and Rj are each independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl optionally substituted with —CO2Re, aryl and aralkyl; or Ri and Rj together form —(CH2)2X(CH2)2—, where X is a direct bond, —CH2—, —NRe—, S or O;
      • R is hydrogen, halogen, —OH, alkoxy, or —NRkRl, where Rk and Rl are independently selected from hydrogen and alkyl.
  • In the compounds of formula (IIIB), R1 and R2 are together alkylene of about 4 to about 8 carbons, optionally substituted with a group R′, where R′ is selected from —OH, halogen, —NRaRb, in which Ra and Rb are independently selected from hydrogen, —C(═O)Rc, —SO2Rd and —C(═O)(CH2)mCO2Re, in which Rc and Rd are independently selected from alkyl, aryl and heteroaryl, Re is hydrogen or alkyl and m is an integer from 1 to 3. Preferably, substituent group R′ is in the S configuration, and m is 1. Also in preferred embodiments, R1 and R2 are together unsubstituted alkylene of about 4 to about 6 carbons or alkylene of about 4 to about 6 carbons substituted with —OH or alkoxy. In more preferred embodiments, R1 and R2 are together —(CH2)4— or —CH2CH(OH)(CH2)2—.
  • In the compounds of formula (IIIB), Ar is mono-, di-, tri-, or tetra-substituted phenyl, wherein said substituents are independently selected from halogen; alkyl; alkoxy; aryloxy; aralkyloxy; alkylene dioxide; —OH; —SO2Rf in which Rf is alkyl or aryl; —CN; haloalkyl; —NRgRh, in which Rg and Rh are independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, —C(═O)Rf, —C(═O)—N(Re)2, —S(O)2Rf, and —(CH2)y—CO2Re in which y is an integer from 1 to 3; —S(O)2N(Ri)(Rj), in which Ri and Rj are each independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl optionally substituted with —CO2Re, aryl and aralkyl; or Ri and Rj together form —(CH2)2X(CH2)2—, where X is a direct bond, —CH2—, —NRe—, S or O. In preferred embodiments, Ar is mono-, di-, tri-, or tetra-substituted phenyl, wherein said substituents are independently selected from alkyl; alkoxy; aralkyloxy; alkylene dioxide; —OH; haloalkyl; —NRgRh, in which Rg and Rh are independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, and —S(O)2Rf; —S(O)2N(Ri)(Rj), where Ri and Rj are each independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl optionally substituted with —CO2Re, and aralkyl; or Ri and Rj together form —(CH2)2X(CH2)2—, where X is a direct bond, —NRe—, S or O. In more preferred embodiments, Ar is mono-, di-, tri-, or tetra-substituted phenyl, wherein said substituents are independently selected from lower alkyl; —OCH3; —OCH2C6H5; —OCH2O; —OH; —CF3; —N(SO2CH3)2; —NHSO2CH3; —SO2N(CH3)2; —SO2N(CH3)(CH2CO2H); —SO2NHCH3; —SO2N(CH3)(CH2C6H5);
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00079
      • where X′ is —N(CH3)— or —O—.
  • In the compounds of formula (IIIB), n is an integer from 1 to 3. Preferably, n is 1.
  • In certain preferred embodiments, compounds of the present invention have the structure of formula (IIIB), except that when n is 1, R1 and R2 are unsubstituted alkylene of 4 carbons (i.e., —(CH2)4—), and R is H, then Ar is other than 2-aminophenyl, 3-aminophenyl, 4-aminophenyl, 2-amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl, 3,4-dichlorophenyl, 2-amino-4-trifluoromethyl, 2-N(SO2CH3)2-phenyl, 3-N(SO2CH3)2-phenyl, 4-N(SO2CH3)2-phenyl, 2-NHSO2CH3-phenyl, 3-NHSO2CH3-phenyl, 4-NHSO2CH3-phenyl, 2-N(SO2CH3)2-4,5-dichlorophenyl, 2-N(SO2CH3)2-4-trifluoromethylphenyl, 2-NHSO2CH3-4-trifluoromethylphenyl, 4-SO2CH3-phenyl, 2-methoxyphenyl, 2-hydroxyphenyl, 2-trifluoromethylphenyl, 3-trifluoromethylphenyl, 4-trifluoromethylphenyl, 3,4,5-trimethoxyphenyl, 2-NHSO2CH3-4,5-dichlorophenyl, 2-NHCH2CO2H-4-trifluoromethylphenyl, 2-NH(SO2C6H5)-phenyl, 3-SO2NHCH34-chlorophenyl, 3-SO2NH2-4-chlorophenyl, 3-SO2NHCH3-4-fluororophenyl, 4-SO2NHCH3-phenyl, 3-SO2NHCH3-phenyl, 2-SO2NHCH3-phenyl, 2-SO2NHCH34-bromophenyl, 2-methoxy-3-SO2NHCH3-phenyl, 4-methoxy-3-SO2NHCH3-phenol, 2-N(CH2CO2H)2-4-trifluoromethylphenyl, 3,4-dihydroxyphenyl, 3,4-dimethoxyphenyl, 2-SO2N(CH3)CH2C6H5-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, or 4-fluorophenyl, 2-SO2NCH3—CH2CO2H-3,4-olimethoxyphenol.
  • Also in certain preferred embodiments, compounds of the present invention have the structure of formula (IIIB), except that when n is 1, R1 and R2 are unsubstituted alkylene of 4 carbons, and R is NH2, then Ar is other than 3,4-dichlorophenyl, 2-aminophenyl or 4-N(SO2CH3)2-phenyl.
  • In still other preferred embodiments, compounds of the present invention have the structure of formula (IIIB), except that when n is 1, R1 and R2 are —CH2CH(OH)(CH2)2—, and R is hydrogen, then Ar is other than 2-amino-4-trifluoromethylphenyl, aminophenyl, 4-SO2CH3-phenyl, 3,4,5-trimethoxyphenyl, 2-SO2NHCH3-phenyl, trifluoromethylphenyl, methylphenyl, halophenyl, methoxyphenyl, unsubstituted phenyl, 3-chloro-4-hydroxyphenyl, 4-benzyloxyphenyl, hydroxyphenyl, aminochlorophenyl, aminobromophenyl, acetamidophenyl, methylsulfonylaminophenyl, formamidophenyl or 3-amino-4-methoxyphenyl.
  • Also in other preferred embodiments, compounds of the invention have the strucuture of formula (m), except that when n is 1, R1 and R2 are —CH2CH(OH)(CH2)2—, and R is hydroxy or amino, then Ar is other than trifluoromethylphenyl.
  • In yet other preferred embodiments, compounds of the present invention have the structure of formula (IIIB), except that when n is 1, R1 and R2 are unsubstituted alkylene of 4 carbons, and R is OH or OCH3, then Ar is other than 2-NHSO2CH3-phenyl, 4-trifluoromethylphenyl, or 3,4-dichlorophenyl.
  • In preferred form, the compounds of formula (IIIB) have the following formula (IIIB-i).
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00080

    wherein:
      • x is an integer from 0 to 4;
      • R″ is hydrogen, fluoro, —OH, —NHC(═O)Rc, —NHSO2Rd and —NHC(═O)(CH2)mCO2Re, in which Rc and Rd are independently selected from alkyl, aryl and heteroaryl, Re is hydrogen or alkyl and m is an integer from 1 to 3
      • R3 is independently selected from halogen; alkyl; alkoxy; aryloxy; aralkyloxy; alkylene dioxide; —OH; —SO2Rf in which Rf is alkyl or aryl; —CN; haloalkyl; —NRgRh, in which Rg and Rh are independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, —C(═O)Rf, —C(═O)—N(Re)2, —S(O)2Rf in which Rf is alkyl or aryl, and —(CH2)y—CO2R, in which y is an integer from 1 to 3; —S(O)2N(Ri)(Rj), in which Ri and Rj are each independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl optionally substituted with —CO2Re, aryl and aralkyl; or Ri and Rj together form —(CH2)2X(CH2)2—, where X is a direct bond, —CH2—, —NRe—, S or O;
      • R is hydrogen, halogen, —OH, alkoxy, or —NRkRl, where Rk and Rl are independently selected from hydrogen and alkyl.
  • In the above formula (IIIB-i), R3 is independently selected from halogen; alkyl; alkoxy; aryloxy; aralkyloxy; alkylene dioxide; —OH; —SO2Rf in which Rf is alkyl or aryl; —CN; haloalkyl; —NRgRh, in which Rg and Rh are independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, —C(═O)Rf, —C(═O)—N(Re)2, —S(O)2Rf in which Rf is alkyl or aryl, and —(CH2)y—CO2Re in which y is an integer from 1 to 3; —S(O)2N(Ri)(Rj), in which Ri and Rj are each independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl optionally substituted with —CO2Re, aryl and aralkyl; or Ri and Rj together form —(CH2)2X(CH2)2—, where X is a direct bond, —CH2—, —NRe—, S or O. In preferred embodiments, R3 is independently selected from alkyl; alkoxy; aralkyloxy; alkylene dioxide; —OH; haloalkyl; —NRgRh, in which Rg and Rh are independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, and —S(O)2Rf; —S(O)2N(Ri)(Rj), in which Ri and Rj are each independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl optionally substituted with —CO2Re, and aralkyl; or Ri and Rj together form —(CH2)2X(CH2)2—, where X is a direct bond, —NRe—, S or O. In more preferred embodiments, R3 is independently selected from lower alkyl; —OCH3; —OCH2C6H5; —OCH2O—; —OH; CF3; —N(SO2CH3)2; —NHSO2CH3; —SO2N(CH3)2; —SO2N(CH3)(CH2CO2H); —SO2NHCH3; —SO2N(CH3)(CH2C6H5);
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00081
      • where X′ is —N(CH3)— or —O—.
  • Also in the above formula (IIIB-i), R is hydrogen, halogen, —OH, alkoxy, or —NRkRl, where Rk and Rl are independently selected from hydrogen and alkyl. In preferred embodiments, R is hydrogen, halogen, —OH or alkoxy.
  • In the compounds of formula (IIIB-i), n is an integer from 1 to 3. Preferably, n is 1.
  • Also in the above formula (IIIB-i), R′ is preferably in the S configuration, and m is preferably 1.
  • In certain preferred embodiments, compounds of the present invention have the structure of formula (IIIB-i), except that when R and R″ are H, then the phenyl ring and (R3)x together are other than 2-aminophenyl, 3-aminophenyl, 4-aminophenyl, 2-N(SO2CH3)2-phenyl, 3-N(SO2CH3)2-phenyl 4-N(SO2CH3)2-phenyl, 2-NHSO2CH3-phenyl, 3-NHSO2CH3-phenyl, 4-NHSO2CH3-phenyl, 4-SO2CH3-phenyl, 2-methoxyphenyl, 2-hydroxyphenyl, 2-trifluoromethylphenyl, 3-trifluoromethylphenyl, 4-trifluoromethylphenyl, 3-SO2NHCH3-phenyl, 2-SO2NHCH3-phenyl, 4-SO2NHCH3-phenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, 4-fluorophenyl, 3,4-dichlorophenyl, 2-amino-4-trifluoromethyl, 2-N(SO2CH3)2-4-trifluoromethylphenyl, 2-NHSO2CH34-trifluoromethylphenyl, 2-NHCH2CO2HA-trifluoromethylphenyl, 3-SO2NHCH3-4-chlorophenyl, 3-SO2NH2-4-chlorophenyl, 3-SO2NHCH3-4-fluororophenyl, 2-SO2NHCH3-4-bromophenyl, 2-methoxy-3-SO2NHCH3-phenyl, 4-methoxy-3-SO2NHCH3-phenol, 2-N(CH2CO2H)2-4-trifluoromethylphenyl, 3,4-dihydroxyphenyl, 3,4-dimethoxyphenyl, 2-amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl, 2-N(SO2CH3)2-4,5-dichlorophenyl, 3,4,5-trimethoxyphenyl, 2-NHSO2CH3-4,5-dichlorophenyl, or 2-SO2N(CH3)CH2C6H5-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl, 2-SO2(CH3)—CH2CO2H-3,4-dimethoxyphenol.
  • In other certain preferred embodiments, compounds of the present invention have the structure of formula (IIIB-i), except that when R″ is H and R is NH2, then the phenyl ring and (R3)x together are other than 3,4-dichlorophenyl, 2-aminophenyl or 4-N(SO2CH3)2-phenyl.
  • In still other certain preferred embodiments, compounds of the present invention have the structure of formula (IIIB-i), except that when R″ is OH and R is hydrogen, then the phenyl ring and (R3)x together are other than unsubstitued phenyl, 2-amino-4-trifluoromethylphenyl, aminophenyl, 4-SO2CH3-phenyl, 3,4,5-trimethoxyphenyl, 2-SO2NHCH3-phenyl, trifluoromethylphenyl, methylphenyl, halophenyl, methoxyphenyl, 3-chloro-4-hydroxyphenyl, 4-benzyloxyphenyl, hydroxyphenyl, aminochlorophenyl, aminobromophenyl, acetamidophenyl, methylsulfonylaminophenyl, formamidophenyl or 3-amino-4-methoxyphenyl.
  • Also in other certain preferred embodiments, compounds of the present invention have the structure of formula (IIIB-i), except that when R″ is OH and R is hydroxy or amino, then the phenyl ring and (R3)x together are other than trifluoromethylphenyl.
  • In yet other certain preferred embodiments, compounds of the present invention have the structure of formula (IIIB-i), except that when when R″ is H and R is OH or OCH3, then the phenyl ring and (R3)x together are other than 2-NHSO2CH3-phenyl, 4-trifluoromethylphenyl or 3,4-dichlorophenyl.
  • Preparatory for the compounds of formula IIIB and IIIB-i, the following intermediates were prepared.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00082
  • 4-Methoxy-5-nitrophenyl acetic acid (iii):
  • To a solution of 4-hydroxy-5-nitrophenyl acetic acid (20.0 g, 0.101 mol) in anhydrous methanol (500 mL) was added Dowex 50Wx4-400 (H+) resin, pre-washed with methanol. The suspension was stirred with refluxing for 24 hr. The resin was filtered and the filtrate was evaporated to dryness to give as a light yellow oil; 21.3 g (99.3%). The ester was used directly in the following reaction.
  • The above ester (21.3 g, 0.1 mol) was redissolved in anhydrous acetone (250 mL) and anhydrous potassium carbonate (20.94 g, 0.14 mol) was added to the reaction mixture. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 15 minutes followed by slow addition of methyl iodide (20.1 g, 0.14 mol) and the stirring was continued for an additional 48 h at room temperature. The reaction mixture was filtered and the filtrate was evaporated to dryness. The residue was portioned between CH2Cl2 and water. The organic layer was separated and washed with water and saturated salt solution, and was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate. Evaporation to dryness afforded (ii) as a yellow solid; 23.0 g (100%); 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 3.62 (s, 2H), 3.72 (s, 3H), 3.96 (s, 3H), 7.05 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 1H), 7.48 (m, 1H), 7.80 (d, J=2.2 Hz, 1H). The compound was used in next step without any further purification.
  • A suspension of ester (ii) (23.0 g) in 4N HCl (300 mL) and acetic acid (20 mL) was heated to reflux with stirring for 18 h. The reaction mixture was cooled to room temperature and the resulting solid was filtered, washed with water, and dried to give the acid (iii) as a light yellow solid, 17.5 g (81%); 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz) δ 3.63 (s, 2H), 3.89 (s, 3H), 7.28 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 1H), 7.50 (m, 1H), 7.77 (d, J=2.0 Hz, 1). Acid (iii) was sufficiently pure to use in the coupling reaction, discussed infra.
  • 2-(4-Methoxy-5-nitrophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]-acetamide (va)
  • To a solution of acid (iii) (17.5 g, 85.78 mmol) in anhydrous CH2Cl2 (175 mL) was added 1-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (11.58 g, 85.78 mmol) and 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (EDCI, 18.02 g, 94.36 mmol). After stirring the reaction mixture at room temperature for 30 min, a solution of the diamine (iv-a) (16.00 g, 78.43 mmol) in anhydrous CH2Cl2 (60 mL) was added, followed by N,N-diisopropylethylamine (10.43 g, 80.0 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 72 h. The reaction mixture was quenched with saturated sodium bicarbonate solution and the organic layer was separated, washed with saturated salt solution and dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate. The removal of CH2Cl2 under reduced pressure gave crude compound (v-a) as dark brown oil. The product (v-a) was purified on a silica gel column to give a yellow syrup, 31 g (99%); 1HNMR(CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 1.74 (m, 4H), 2.75 (s, 3H), 3.95 (s, 3H), 6.10 (m, 1H), 7.05-7.75 (m, 8H).
  • EXAMPLE 122 2-(3-N-Methylsulfonamido-3-amino-4-methoxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide methane sulfonate (1)
  • Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00083
  • To a solution of compound (v) (31.0 g, 78.0 mmol) in ethanol (700 mL) at 50-60° C. was added hydrazine hydrate (15 mL) followed by Raney/Nickel slowly until all the starting material was reduced, as shown by TLC. The reaction mixture was cooled to room temperature and the catalyst was filtered off and washed thoroughly with warm ethanol. The filtrate was evaporated to dryness to give the amino compound, which was used directly in the following reaction.
  • To a stirred solution of the amino compound (26.6 g, 72.45 mmol) in anhydrous CH2Cl2 (250 mL) was added pyridine (12.1 g, 152.6 mmol) and the reaction mixture was cooled to 0-5° C. in an ice-bath. A solution of methanesulfonyl chloride (13.1 g, 114.4 mmol) in anhydrous CH2Cl2 (50 mL) was added dropwise in 15 min with continued stirring. After the completion of the addition, the ice-bath was removed and the reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 60 h. The reaction was quenched by the slow addition of saturated sodium bicarbonate, and the organic layer was separated, washed with water, saturated salt solution and dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate. The removal of solvent gave the crude free base of compound (1), which was purified on a silica gel column. The methane sulfonic acid salt was prepared and recrystallized twice from 2-propanol to give (1) as an off-white solid, 19.7 g (50%); mp 149-151° C.; 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz) δ 2.01 (m, 4H), 2.38 (s, 3H), 2.73 (s, 3H), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.17 (m, 2H), 3.81 (s, 3H), 6.15 (m, 1H), 7.00-7.34 (m, 8H), 8.90 (s, 1H); MS 446 (M+H)+.
  • Intermediates for the compounds prepared in following examples were prepared as depicted below.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00084
  • 2-(4-Hydroxy-5-nitrophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]-acetamide (vi)
  • The diamine (iv-a) was condensed with 4-hydroxy-5-nitrophenyl acetic acid following the method described for compound (v). The product (vi) was isolated as a hydrochloride salt in 60% yield; 1HNMR(CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 2.00-2.40 (m, 4H), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.65 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 1H), 4.05 (m, 4H), 4.38 (d, J=9.5 Hz, 1H), 6.40 (m, 1H), 7.05-7.50 (m, 6, H), 7.70 (d, J=5.5 Hz, 1H), 8.05 (d, J=2.0 Hz, 1H). Intermediate compound (vi) was then used in the preparation of intermediate (vii).
  • 2-(4-Benzyloxy-5-nitrophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]-acetamide (vii)
  • To a solution of compound (vi) (3.2 g, 7.62 mmol) in anhydrous acetone (50 mL) was added anhydrous potassium carbonate (4.22 g, 30.5 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 30 mins then added dropwise benzyl bromide (1.30 g, 7.62 mmol). The stirring was continued for an additional 48 h and the reaction mixture was filtered off. The cake was washed thoroughly with acetone and the combined filtrate was evaporated to dryness. The residue was redissolved in CH2Cl2 and the organic layer was washed with water, saturated salt solution and dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate. The removal of the solvent resulted in a yellow foam, and the product was purified on a silica gel column to give (vii) as a solid, 2.5 g (69%); MS 474 (M+H)+.
  • Intermediate compound (vii) was then used to prepare compounds 2 and 3 of the present invention, as depicted below.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00085
  • EXAMPLE 123 2-(3-N-Methylsulfonamido-3-amino-4-benzyloxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (2)
  • Compound (viii) and compound (2) were prepared according to the procedure described for (v). Compound (2) was isolated as a hydrochloride salt in 95% yield (HCl salt); mp 219-221° C.; MS 522 (M+H)+; 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz) δ 2.00 (m, 4H), 2.78 (s, 3H), 2.90 (s, 3H), 3.15 (m, 2H), 3.70 (m, 5H), 4.05 (m, 1H), 5.16 (s, 2H), 6.15 (m, 1H), 7.07-7.53 (m, 14H), 8.94 (s, 1H).
  • EXAMPLE 124 2-(3-N-Methylsulfonamido-3-amino-4-hydroxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide (3)
  • To a solution of compound (2) (2.4 g, 4.6 mmol) in ethanol (150 mL) was added 10% Pd/C (0.25 g), and the resulting suspension was hydrogenated at room temperature for 24 h. The catalyst was removed by filtration and washed with hot methanol. The combined filtrate was evaporated to dryness to give a solid, which was recystallized from acetonitrile to give compound (3) as a white solid, 1.6 g (72%) (HCl salt); mp 228-230° C.; MS 432 (M+H)+; 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz) δ 1.98 (m, 4H): 2.76 (s, 3H), 2.93 (s, 3H) 3.17 (m, 2H), 3.44-4.00 (m, 6H), 6.14 (m, 1H), 6.80-7.37 (m, 7H), 8.70 (s, 8H).
  • Employing similar chemistry, the following compounds of formula IIIB were prepared.
  • EXAMPLE 125 2-(2-N-Methylsulfonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Prepared from diamine (iv-b) in 31% yield (HCl salt); mp 168-171° C.; MS (FAB) 432 (MH)+.
  • EXAMPLE 126 2-(2-N-Methylsulfonamido-2-amino-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Prepared from diamine (iv-b) in 18% yield (HCl salt); mp 178-181° C.; MS (FAB) 500 (MH)+.
  • EXAMPLE 127 2-(3-N-Methylsulfonamido-3-amino-4-methoxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Prepared from diamine (iv-b) in 44% yield (HCl salt); mp 148-151° C.; MS (FAB) 462 (MH)+.
  • EXAMPLE 128 2-(2-N-Methylsulfonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-1-(4-methoxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • Prepared from the diamine (iv-a) (R=4-OCH3) in 40% yield (CH3SO3H salt); mp 170-172° C.; MS 446 (M+H)+; 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz) δ 1.90 (m, 4H), 2.34 (s, 3H), 2.70 (s, 3H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.20 (m, 2H), 3.60 (m, 4H), 3.75 (s, 3H), 4.07 (m, 2H), 6.10 (m, 1H), 6.93 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.29 (m, 4H), 9.06 (s, 1H).
  • EXAMPLE 129A (R,S)-2-(2-N-Methylsulfonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-1-(4-hydroxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • To a solution of the compound prepared in Example 128 (1.07 g, 2.04 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (20 mL) at −70° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere was added dropwise a solution of BBr3 1M in CH2Cl2 (7.95 mL, 7.93 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred for 1 additional hour and was slowly warmed to room temperature. After stirring for 24 h, the reaction mixture was then quenched with anhydrous methanol (10 mL). The solvent was removed under reduced pressure, and the resulting residue was stirred in methanol:ether (1:1) to give a solid. The solid was re-dissolved in CH2Cl2 and basified to give the free base of the title compound. The methane sulfonic acid salt was prepared to give the title compound in 83% yield (CH3SO3H salt); mp 197-199° C.; 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz, HBr Salt) δ 1.93 (m, 4H), 2.70 (m, 3H), 2.98 (m, 3H), 3.16 (m, 2H), 3.60 (m, 4H), 3.73 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 4.05 (d, J=14.5 Hz, 1H), 6.02 (m, 2H), 6.74 (d, 8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.04 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 7.27 (m, 4H), 9.07 (s, 1H).
  • The preparation of the compound of Example 129B follows according to the following Scheme P.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00086
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00087
  • Key: i. (tert)-Butyldimethylsilyl chloride, imidazole, DMF, 0° C.→25° C., 2 h. ii. DCC, HOBt, pyrrolidine, DCM, rt, 3 h. iii. LAH, THF, 0° C.→35° C., 8 h. iv. DCC, HOBt, 2-nitrophenylacetic acid, DMF, rt, 3 h. v. 10% Pd on C, EtOH, H2 gas, rt, 12 h. vi. CH3SO2Cl, DCM, DIEA, 0° C.→25° C., 2 h. vii. TBAF, THF, rt, 2 h.
  • EXAMPLE 129B (S)-2-(2-N-Methylsulfonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-1-(4-hydroxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00088
  • Starting nitro phenyl derivative 1 (2.28 g; 4.58 mmol) was dissolved in ethanol (100 mL). The reaction vessel was evacuated under reduced pressure and purged with nitrogen. 10% Pd on C was added to the reaction mixture. The mixture was evacuated under reduced pressure and put over hydrogen via a balloon. The reaction proceeded to completion after 4-6 h, following the disappearance of the starting material by TLC (Rf SM=0.5; Rf Prod=0.48; 2% MeOH in DCM). The reaction mixture was filtered through Celite, and concentrated to give the product amine. Purification of the product amine 2 by column chromatography afforded 1.14 g (2.4 mmol; 53%) yield.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00089
  • Starting amine 2 (1.0 g; 2.16 mmol) was dissolved in DCM. DIEA (1.16 mL; 6.49 mmol) was added to the reaction vessel and the mixture was cooled to 0° C. with an ice bath. Mesyl chloride (0.37 mL; 4.76 mmol) was added drop-wise to the mixture at 0° C., after which the reaction mixture was allowed to warm to ambient temperature. The reaction proceeded for 1 hour after which the starting material disappeared by TLC (Rf SM=0.6; Rf prod=0.8; 10% MeOH in DCM). The reaction was diluted with ethylacetate, washed with water, brine, then dried over MgSO4. The mixture was filtered and concentrated to yield product 3 (1.3 g; 2.08 mmol; 96%), which was used crude in the next step.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00090
  • Amine 3 from the above reaction (1.3 g; 2.08 mmol) was dissolved in THF (20 mL). A THF solution of TBAF (1M solution in THF; 4.16 mL; 4.16 mmol) was added to the reaction mixture, and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 2 h monitoring the disappearance of the starting material (Rf SM=0.8; Rf prod=0.4; 10% MeOH in DCM). Phenol 129B was obtained after standard work-up and purification by silica gel chromatography. LCMS: M+H=432. Elemental analysis (CHN): C22H29N3O4S.H2O (calc % C=58.78; % H=6.95; % N=9.35; % S=7.13; found % C=58.55; % H=6.83; % N=8.94; % S=7.27).
  • EXAMPLE 130 2-(3-N-Bis-methylsulfonamido-3-amino-4-hydroxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide
  • The title compound was prepared from 2-(2-amino-4-hydroxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide and methane sulfonyl chloride as described above in 83% yield. The title compound was isolated as the methane sulfonic acid salt; mp 197-199° C. (CH3SO3H salt); MS (FAB) 510 (M+H)+; 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz) δ 2.05 (m, 4H), 2.36 (s, 3H), 2.75 (s, 3H), 3.05 (s, 3H), 3.51 (s, 3H), 6.15 (m, 1H), 7.35 (m, 5H), 9.5 (bs, 1H).
  • The following general chemistry was employed in the preparation of sulfonyl chloride derivatives, as described in J. Heterocyclic Chem., 29, 1667-1669 (1992), similar to methods described hereinabove, in the preparation of compounds of formula IIIB and IIIB-i, as prepared in Examples 131 to 147.
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00091
  • To a solution of the ester derivatives (ix) (10.3 mmol) and acetic anhydride (30.7 mmol) in ethyl acetate (15.3 mL) was added, dropwise, a solution of concentrated sulfuric acid (11.2 mmol) in ethyl acetate (4.1 mL) at 0° C. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 3 h, after which a solution of potassium acetate (11.2 mmol) in 95% ethanol was added and the mixture was stirred for additional 30 min at room temperature. The potassium salt (x) (90%) was isolated by filtration and used in the next reaction.
  • A solution of thionyl chloride (8.74 mmol) and anhydrous DMF (0.01 mL) was added to potassium salt (x) (1.6 mmol) under a nitrogen atmosphere. The reaction mixture was stirred at 60° C. for 3.5 h and then poured into an ice water mixture and extracted with CH2Cl2 (3×20 mL). The combined organic extract was dried and evaporated to dryness to give (xi) (81%). The material was used in the following reaction.
  • To a solution of 70 mmol of an appropriate amine (N-benzylmethylamine in the presently exemplified chemistry) in anhydrous THF (30 mL) at 0° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere was added dropwise a solution of (xi) (31.7 mmol) in anhydrous THF (30 mL). After the addition was complete, the reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 20 h. The resulting solid was filtered off, the cake was washed with THF and the filtrate was evaporated to dryness. The residue was portioned between CH2Cl2 and water. The organic layer was separated, dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and evaporated to dryness to give (xii) in 88% yield. The compound was used directly into the hydrolysis reaction.
  • To a solution of (xii) (3 mmol) in tetrahydrofuran:methanol (1:1, 5 mL) at 0-5° C. was added 1M lithium hydroxide (6 mL) and the reaction mixture was stirred at this temperature for 1 h then at room temperature for 24 h. After neutralization of the solution with concentrated HCl, the solvent was removed under reduced pressure to give a white solid. The solid was filtered off, washed with water and dried to give (xiii), (95%); 1HNMR (R1=R2=OCH3; CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 2.61 (s, 3H), 3.87 (s, 3H), 3.90 (s, 3H), 4.08 (s, 2H), 4.27 (s, 2H), 6.85 (s, 1H), 7.31 (m, 5H), 7.49 (s, 1H).
  • The compounds of Examples 131 to 147 were prepared employing the general procedure described for compound (v). Crude compounds were purified on a silica gel column and isolated as salts either from hydrochloric acid or methane sulfonic acid.
  • EXAMPLE 131 2-[2-(N-Benzyl-N-methylsulfamoyl)-4,5-methylenedioxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Yield, 82% (CH3SO3H salt); mp 236-238° C.; 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz) δ 1.98 (m, 4H), 2.48 (s, 3H), 2.55 (s, 3H), 2.74 (s, 3H), 3.10-3.75 (m, 6H), 4.054.40 (m, 4H), 6.10 (m, 1H), 6.16 (bs, 2H), 7.05 (s, 1H), 7.35 (m, 11H), 9.30 (bs, 1H).
  • EXAMPLE 132 2-[2-(N-Dimethylsulfamoyl)-4,5-methylenedioxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Yield, 48% (HCl salt); mp 269-271° C.; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 1.96 (m, 4H), 2.25 (m, 2H), 2.69 (s, 6H), 2.92 (bs, 3H), 4.05 (m, 4H), 4.35 (q, J=10.0 Hz, 2H), 6.03 (d, J=9.5 Hz, 2H), 6.35 (m, 1H), 7.27 (m, 7H).
  • EXAMPLE 133 2-[2-(N-Dimethylsulfamoyl)-4,5-methylenedioxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Prepared from diamine (iv-b), yield, 41% (HCl salt); mp>240° C. (d); MS 491 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 134 2-[2-(N-Pyrrolidinesulfamoyl)-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Yield 67% (HCl salt); mp 240-242° C.; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 1.70 (m, 4H), 2.00-2.45 (m, 4H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.25 (m, 5H), 3.90 (s, 3H), 3.99 (m, 6H), 4.15 (m, 2H), 4.30 (d, J=10.5 Hz, 1H), 4.50 (d, J=10.6 Hz, 1H), 6.38 (m, 1H), 7.25 (m, 3H), 7.34 (m, 3H), 7.48 (s, 1H).
  • EXAMPLE 135 2-[2-(N-Pyrrolidinesulfamoyl)-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Prepared from diamine (iv-b) in 49% yield (CH3SO3H salt); mp>120° C. (d); MS 532 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 136 2-[2-(N-Dimethylsulfamoyl)-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Yield, 55% (HCl salt); mp 246-248° C.; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 2.00-2.40 (m, 4H), 2.69 (s, 3H), 2.94 (m, 4H), 3.25 (m, 1H), 3.90 (s, 3H), 4.00 (m, 6H), 4.34 (d, J=11.0 HZ, 1H), 4.41 (d, J=10.7 Hz, 1H), 6.35 (m, 1H), 7.20-7.40 (m, 6H), 7.45 (s, 1H).
  • EXAMPLE 137 2-[2-(N-Dimethylsulfamoyl)-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Prepared from diamine (iv-b) in 45% yield (HCl salt); mp 221-223° C.; MS 474 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 138 2-[2-[N-(4-Methylpiperazine)]sulfamoyl)-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Yield, 62% (di HCl salt); mp 255-257° C. (d); 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 2.00-2.38 (m, 4H), 2.77 (s, 3H), 2.95 (s, 3H), 3.05-3.28 (m, 4H), 3.30-3.48 (m, 2H), 3.55-3.80 (m, 4H), 3.95-4.15 (m, 10H), 4.20 (d, J=10.5 Hz, 1H), 4.30 (d, J=10.5 Hz, 1H), 6.40 (m, 1H), 7.27 (m, 2H), 7.35 (m, 2H), 7.46 (m, 3H).
  • EXAMPLE 139 2-[2-[N-(4-Methylpiperazine)]sulfamoyl)-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Prepared from diamine (iv-b) in 74% yield (di HCl salt); mp 168-171° C.; MS 561 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 140 2-[2-N-(Morpholinesulfamoyl)-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Yield 75% (HCl salt), mp 229-231° C.; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 2.05-2.40 (m, 4H), 2.94 (m 6H), 3.08 (m, 4H), 3.25 (m, 1H), 3.68 (m, 4H), 3.90 (s, 3H), 3.97 (s, 3H), 4.15 (m, 2H), 4.37 (m, 2H), 6.38 (m, 1H), 7.25-7.39 (m, 6H), 7.52 (s, 1H).
  • EXAMPLE 141 2-[2-N-(Morpholinesulfamoyl)-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Prepared from diamine (iv-b) in 77% yield (HCl salt); mp 158-161° C.; MS 548 (M+H)+.
  • EXAMPLE 142 N-Methyl-[[2-(N-sulfamoyl)-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamido]glycine
  • The desired sulfamoyl phenyl acetic acid was prepared from sulfonyl chloride (xi) (R1=R2=OCH3) and sarcosine t-butyl ester followed by the hydrolysis of the methyl ester. The acid was condensed with diamine (iv-a) and the cleavage of t-butyl ester gave (21) in 80% overall yield (HCl salt); mp 231-233° C. (d); MS (FAB) 534 (MH)+; 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz) δ 2.05 (m, 4H), 2.77 (s, 3H), 2.81 (s, 3H), 3.504.35 (m, 17H), 6.15 (m, 1H), 7.25-7.55 (m, 7H).
  • EXAMPLE 143 2-[2-(N-Pyrrolidinesulfamoyl)-3,4,5-trimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Yield, 62% (HCl salt); mp 225-227° C.; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 1.80 (m, 4H), 2.50-2.80 (m, 8H), 2.75 (s, 7H), 3.90 (s, 6H), 4.00 (s, 3H), 4.20 (m, 2H), 6.50 (m, 1H), 7.20-7.44 (m, 6H).
  • EXAMPLE 144 2-[2-(N-t-Butylsulfamoyl)-3,4,5-trimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Yield, 74% (HCl salt); mp 248-250° C.; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 1.34 (s, 9H), 2.05-2,30 (m, 4H), 2.69 (s, 6H), 2.90 (m, 6H), 4.05 (m, 2H), 4.30 (d, J=9.5 HZ, 1H), 4.40 (d, J=9.6 Hz, 1H), 6.30 (m, 1H), 7.27 (m, 4H), 7.60 (m, 3H), 7.83 (s, 1H).
  • EXAMPLE 145 2-[2-(N-Methylsulfamoyl)-4-methoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Yield, 25% (CH3SO3H salt); mp 232-234° C.; 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz) δ 1.80-2.01 (m, 4H), 2.37 (s, 3H), 2.39 (s, 3H), 2.75 (s, 3H), 3.18 (m, 2H), 3.50-3.57 (m, 3H), 3.85 (m, 2H), 3.88 (s, 3H), 6.15 (m, 1H), 6.99 (m, 1H), 7.20 (m, 2H), 7.35 (m, 2H), 7.48 (m 1H), 7.68 (m, 1H).
  • EXAMPLE 146 2-[4-N-(Methylsulfamoyl)-phenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-(3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • The sulfamoyl acid was prepared from methyl phenyl acetate as described above and condensed with diamine (iv-b) to give the title compound in 42% yield (CH3SO3H salt); mp 201-203° C.; 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz) δ 1.70-2.35 (m, 2H), 2.32 (s, 3H), 2.40 (d, J=5.0 Hz, 3H), 2.74 (s, 3H), 3.15-3.80 (m, 5H), 3.814.20 (m, 3H), 4.354.55 (m, 1H), 5.44 and 5.55 (m, 1H), 6.13 (m, 1H), 7.50-7.45 (m, 5H), 7.47 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 2H), 7.71 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 9.55 (bs, 1H), 9.87 (bs, 1H).
  • EXAMPLE 147 2-[2-(N-Methylsulfamoyl)-phenyl]-N-methyl-N-[1-(2-fluorophenyl-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Prepared from diamine (iv-a) (R=2-F) in 63% yield (CH3SO3H salt); mp 232-234° C.; 1H NMR (d6DMSO, 300 MHz) δ 1.80-2.50 (m, 4H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 2.41 (d, J=4.9 Hz), 2.76 (s, 3H), 3.22 (m, 2H), 3.50-3.80 (m, 3H), 3.88 (s, 2H), 4.23 (m, 2H), 6.28 (m, 2H), 7.20-7.35 (m 2H), 7.35-7.50 (4H), 7.71 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 2H), 9.33 (bs, 1H).
  • EXAMPLE 148 2-[2-(N-Benzyl-N-methylsulfamoyl)-4,5-dimethoxyphenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]]acetamide
  • Yield, 46% (HCl salt); mp 188-189° C.; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 2.15 (m, 4H), 2.56 (s, 3H), 2.92 (s, 3H), 3.25 (m, 1H), 3.90 (s, 3H), 4.04 (m, 10H), 4.50 (m, 2H), 6.38 (m, 1H), 7.26 (m, 11H), 7.50 (s, 1H).
  • In a composition aspect, the kappa agonist compounds of the present invention are formulated into parenteral, local and topical formulations.
  • The compositions are formulated as injectables, as oral and rectal formulations for systemic administration, and for local and topical administration as creams, aqueous or non-aqueous suspension, lotions, emulsions, suspensions or emulsions containing micronized particles, gels, foams aerosols, solids and other suitable vehicles for application to the skin, eyes, lips and mucosa, as suppositories or cream for vaginal administration, and as combinations with bandages, patches, bioadhesives and dressings. The compounds may be formulated in combination with other agents, such as local anesthetics and other therapeutic agents. The other agents may be mixed in the compositions are provided and administered prior to, simultaneously with or subsequent to administration of the compositions provided for the methods herein. Such agents include, but are not limited to: antibiotics, including cephalosporins, β-lactams, tetracyclines, vancomycins, sulfas and aminoglycosides; antivirals, including acylovir; and antifungals including clotrimazole.
  • In a method aspect the present invention provides method to treat hyperalgesia by applying an amount of a compound or composition to a mammal to ameliorate or eliminate pain. Thus, the method of the present invention comprises a method of treating pain internally or externally present in the mammalian body including: internal injuries, such as caused by accident or surgical procedures; abnormal functioning of body organs; irritation associated with inflammation following local infection, blisters, boils, or acute skin injuries, such as abrasions, burns, superficial cuts, surgical incisions, toothaches, contusions, irritations, inflammatory skin conditions, including but not limited to poison ivy, and allergic rashes and dermatitis and any condition that yields a hyperalgesic pain state and other such conditions.
  • Assessment of Anti-Hyperalgesic Activity
  • The pharmacological activity of the compounds of the present invention may be assessed by several art-recognized in vitro and in vivo models. Some of the typical models are described herein.
  • (a) In Vitro Binding Assay (Primary Screen)14
  • The initial test of these compounds is [3H]diprenorphine binding to the cloned human kappa receptor. The compounds that inhibit binding by at least 80% at 1 μM are titrated and Ki values are determined by Cheng-Prusoff transformations of IC50 values. The IC50 value is the concentration of inhibitor that inhibits binding of radiolabel by 50% and the Ki value is the affinity of the inhibitor for the receptor. Compounds are also tested against [3H]U69593 (agonist) binding to this receptor. No compound is known to inhibit only agonist binding or antagonist binding. However, such a compound may have a unique pharmacological profile as a result of its specificity for one region of the receptor.
  • Initial specificity is determined by testing compounds using [3H]diprenorphine binding to cloned human mu and delta receptors at 10 μM and titrating those compounds that inhibit binding by at least 80%. Compounds that do not have Ki values at least 100-fold higher against mu and delta receptors may be more likely to have additional side effects and are not pursued to enable further evaluation of specific compounds.
  • Ref.
    • (14) Raynor et al., Mol. Pharmacol. 45, 330-334 (1994)
  • (b) In Vivo Evaluation of Formalin-Induced Nociception
  • Administration of formalin into the paw results in a localized inflammation and a pain response that is moderate in intensity and continuous in duration. Unlike many other assays of nociception, the formalin assay measures tonic pain that is a result of tissue injury, and therefore is a model which is more relevant to clinical pain states in humans [see Tjolsen et al. (1992) Pain 51: 5-17]. In the rat the response to formalin-induced pain consists of spontaneous flinching behavior, characterized by paw lifting and paw shaking, and a rapid vibration of the paw after drawing it under the body. The flinching response can be reliably quantitated and exhibits two peaks of activity which are indicative of acute and tonic pain [Wheeler-Aceto and Cowan (1991) Psychopharmacology 104: 35-44]. The early or acute phase lasts from 0-5 min post-formalin and is followed by a quiescent period lasting approximately 15 min. The tonic phase occurs from 20-35 min following formalin injection and is the interval where the number of flinching responses is maximal. This model has been characterized in several species [Tjolsen et al. (1992) Pain 51: 5-17] and is sensitive to the analgesic effects of opiates administered by a variety of routes, including local administration directly into the paw. In addition, the test is particularly sensitive to the effects of κ agonists [Wheeler-Aceto and Cowan (1991) Psychopharmacology 104: 35-44].
  • Inflammation is induced by subcutaneous injection of 50 μL of a 5% formalin solution into the dorsal surface of the right hind paw of male Sprague-Dawley rats weighing 70-90 g. Injections of drug are given into the dorsal surface of the paw prior to formalin injection, and flinching behavior is quantitated by counting the number of responses that occur during the tonic phase of pain, lasting from 20-35 min after formalin injection. Results are expressed as the mean percent antagonism of formalin-induced flinching calculated for individual drug-treated, formalin-injected rats using the following formula:
    (mean formalin response−mean saline response)−individual response×100
      • mean formalin response−mean saline response
  • The mean formalin response is the mean behavioral score of vehicle-treated and formalin-injected rats. The mean saline response is the pooled behavioral score from rats injected with 50 μL of saline into the paw.
  • (d) Randall-Selitto Test
  • Numerous variations and exemplifications of this assay are known to those of skill in this art [see, Randall et al. (1957) Arch. Int. Pharmacodyn. 111: 409-419; see, also, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,434,292, U.S. Pat. No. 5,369,131, U.S. Pat. No. 5,345,943, U.S. Pat. No. 5,242,944 and U.S. Pat. No. 5,109,135.
  • The pain threshold is measured in this method as the amount of pressure in g required to induce a flight reaction (struggle) when applied to the foot of an experimental animal exhibiting hyperalgesia, typically an inflamed paw, compared to a control, such as the same or equivalent animal in the absence of the inflammation, and/or in the absence of a test compound. Incremental pressure is applied to the paw with a wedge-shaped blunt piston onto the dorsal surface of the hind paw by means of a paw pressure analgesia meter. The pressure required to elicit paw withdrawal, the paw pressure threshold (PPT), is determined.
  • Stein and coworkers [Stein et al. (1988) Pharmacol. Biochem. Behav. 31: 445-451; Stein et al. (1989) J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 248: 1269-1275] have developed a model of peripheral inflammation and hyperalgesia in rats, which supports the role of opiates in mediating peripheral analgesia. In this protocol, modified Freund's adjuvant is used as the inflammatory stimulus, and the paw pressure test is used to assess the response of the rat to a painful pressure stimulus. The model is sensitive to opiate agonists of the μ, δ and κ subtypes, which produce analgesia upon administration [Antonijevic et al. (1995) J. Neurosci. 15: 165-172; Stein et al. (1988) Neurosci. Lett. 84: 225-228; Stein et al. (1989) J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 248: 1269-1275]. Histological verification of opiate receptor localization and density have confirmed that peripheral opiate receptors are accessible on primary afferent nerve fibers and are upregulated following inflammation [Hassan et al. (1993) Neuroscience 55: 185-193; Przewlocki et al. (1992) Neuroscience 48: 491-500].
  • Experiments are conducted in rats weighing 150-250 g at the time of inoculation. Modified Freund's complete adjuvant (FCA) is used as the inflammatory stimulus. Rats are administered an i.pl. injection of the FCA suspension into the right hind foot. Hyperalgesia and antinociception are evaluated using the paw pressure test. The rat is gently restrained and incremental pressure is applied to the paw with a wedge-shaped blunt piston onto the dorsal surface of the hind paw by means of a paw pressure analgesia meter. The pressure required to elicit paw withdrawal, the paw pressure threshold (PPT), is determined. A cutoff pressure of 250 g is used to avoid undue stress and pain to the animal. Baseline responding is established by determining the average of three consecutive trials separated by 10 sec. The same procedure is conducted on the contralateral side and the sequence of sides is alternated between animals to control for order effects. Typically injections are not made in the contralateral (noninflamed) paw; however, in selected cases drugs may be administered to the contralateral paw to evaluate the potential for drug effects in the absence of inflammation.
  • Analgesic activity is determined by expressing the increase in PPT resulting from the effect of the drug as a percentage of basal preinjection thresholds.
  • Hyperalgesia can also be produced by inflammatory stimuli such as yeast or carrageenan, endogenous inflammatory mediators such as bradykinin or prostaglandins, or other types of chemical irritants [see Hargreaves and Joris (1993) APS Journal 2: 51-59].
  • (e) Acetic Acid-Induced Writhing
  • This test identifies novel agents which exhibit peripheral analgesic activity against visceral or chemical pain [see Barber and Gottschlich (1986) Med. Res. Rev. 12: 525-562; Ramabadran and Bansinath (1986) Pharm. Res. 3: 263-270]. Injection of acetic acid into the peritoneal cavity is used as the noxious stimulus, and the number of writhing responses that occur in response to acetic acid are counted in order to quantify the response to pain. Compounds which possess analgesic activity reduce the number of writhing responses that occur. Opiate agonists of the μ and κ subtype exhibit analgesic activity in this model [Barber and Gottschlich (1986) Med. Res. Rev. 12: 525-562; Millan (1990) Trends Pharmacol. Sci. 11: 70-76]. Novel compounds which demonstrate potency and efficacy in this assay are potential drugs for the treatment of various pathological conditions involving peripheral pain.
  • The writhing assay is adapted from the procedure originally described by Taber et al. [(1969) J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 169: 29-38], using male CF-1 mice weighing 20-25 g. Animals are treated with various doses of drugs prior to the administration of an i.p. injection of 0.6% acetic acid solution. Mice are then placed into observation chambers and the number of writhing responses, as defined by a full hindlimb extension and retraction, are recorded.
  • The mean number of writhing responses is calculated for vehicle-treated control mice, and the percent inhibition (% I) of writhing is calculated for each mouse that is treated with drug using the following formula:
    % I=100×(mean control writhing responses−individual test responses)
  • mean control writhing responses
    TABLE I
    Compounds of Formula I
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00092
    Late Phase
    Ki, nM Formalin
    Compounds R Ar 3H-Diprenorphin 3H-U-69,593 A50 (mg); i.paw
    GR 89696 CO2CH3 3,4-Cl2 0.095, 0.10 1.6, 1.5 0.35(0.20-0.62)
    (R)
    (R-1) Bn 3,4-Cl2 57, 38 9.3 53% @ 300
    (R-2) H 3,4-Cl2 14, 17 1.5, 1.3 57% @ 300
    (R-3a) SO2CH3 3,4-Cl2 0.2, 1.3 0.19, 0.5 14 (5.6-29)
    (R-3b) CH2CO2t-Bu 3,4-Cl2 30% @ 1 uM 75% @ 1 uM 75% I @ 1 μM
    (R-3c) CH2CO2H 3,4-Cl2 62% @ 1 uM 23, 21 26% @ 300
    (R-3d)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00093
    3,4-Cl2 36% @ 1 uM 379, 249 Not tested.
    (R-3e)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00094
    3,4-Cl2 39% @ 1 uM 37, 28 22% A @ 300
    (R-3f) COCH3 3,4-Cl2 4.2, 1.4 0.11, 0.14 95% @ 300
    (R-3g) PO(OEt)2 3,4-Cl2 99, 33 1.3, 1.4 54% @ 300
    (R-3h) COCF3 3,4-Cl2 6.9, 1.8 0.26, 0.16 94% @ 300
    (R-3i) CONH2 3,4-Cl2 56, 29 2.9 68% @ 300
    (R-3j) CHO 3,4-Cl2 96% @ 1 uM 0.40 65% @ 300
    (R-3l) SO2-Tol 3,4-Cl2 120 6.2 24% @ 300
    (R,S-8a) SO2CH3 3,4-Cl2 5.4, 4.0 0.37, 0.65 96% @ 300
    (R,S-8b) SO2CH3 p-SO2CH3 41% @ 1 uM 20, 31 Not tested
    (R,S-8c) SO2CH3 o-NO2 15% @ 1 uM 51% @ 1 uM Not tested
    (R,S-8d) SO2CH3 p-CF3 16, 17 1.3, 1.9 97% @ 300
    (R,S-8e) SO2CH3 3-indole 74% 5.3, 3.2 Not tested
    (R,S-9a) CO2CH3 p-SO2CH3 11 0.37, 0.42 46% @ 300
    (R,S-9b) CO2CH3 p-CF3 0.49 0.076, 0.13 98% @ 300
    (R,S-9c) CO2CH3 3-indole 3.0 0.27, 0.40 95% @ 300
    (R,S-9d) CO2CH3 o-NO2 37 0.74, 0.73 93% @ 300
    (R,S-9e) CO2CH3 o-OCH3 7.3 0.46, 1.3 98% @ 300
    (R,S-9f) CO2CH3 o-NH2 4.6, 3.2 0.67, 0.41 97% @ 300
    (R,S-10a) COCH3 p-SO2CH3 27% 2.3  6% @ 300
    (R,S-10b) COCH3 p-CF3 26, 24 2.y0 89% @ 300
    (R,S-10c) COCH3 o-CF3 45% @ 1 uM 16 Not tested
    (R,S-10d) COCH3 m-NO2 94% @ 1 uM 0.72 Not tested
    (R,S-10e) COCH3 o-NO2 541 24 Not tested
    (R,S-10f) COCH3 p-NO2 59% @ 1 uM 2.4 Not tested
    (R.S-11) Bn p-CF3 2.2, 2.4 0.39, 0.57 92% @ 300
  • TABLE IA
    Compounds of Formula IA
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00095
    Formalin
    (% A @ 300 nM)
    Ki(nM) i. paw or
    R Ar R′ R″ n X (3H)-Diprenorphin A50 mg/kg s.c.
    1a CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00096
    H H 1 CH2 248 Not tested
    1b CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00097
    H H 1 CH2 7 Not tested
    1c CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00098
    H H 1 CH2 65% @ 1 mM 69% @ 300
    1d CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00099
    H H 1 CH2 7.6 77% @ 300
    1e CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00100
    H H 1 CH2 14 55% @ 300
    1f CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00101
    H H 1 CH2 53.5 Not tested
    1g COCF3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00102
    H H 1 CH2  5% @ 1 mM Not tested
    1h COCF3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00103
    H H 1 CH2 50 100% @ 300 
    1i CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00104
    H CO2CH3 2 N 12% @ 1 mM Not tested
    1j CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00105
    H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00106
    1 CH 13 Not tested
    1k CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00107
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00108
    H 1 CH 51.5 95% @ 300
    1l (R, S) CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00109
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00110
    H 1 CH 3.5 1.7
    1m CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00111
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00112
    H 1 CH 49.5 1.7
    1n CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00113
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00114
    H 1 CH 12% @ 1 mM Not tested
    1o CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00115
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00116
    H 1 CH 133 41% @ 300
    1p CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00117
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00118
    H 1 CH 11 Not tested
    1q CO2CH3 H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00119
    1 CH 5.2 98% @ 300
    1r COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00120
    H H 1 CH 43% @ 1 mM Not tested
    1s COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00121
    H H 1 CH 53% @ 1 mM Not tested
    1t COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00122
    H H 1 CH  1% @ 1 mM Not tested
    1u COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00123
    H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00124
    1 CH 1780 Not tested
    1v COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00125
    H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00126
    1 CH 4.3 70% @ 300
    1w COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00127
    H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00128
    1 CH 1156 60% @ 300
    1x COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00129
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00130
    H 1 CH 36% @ 1 mM Not tested
    1y COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00131
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00132
    H 1 CH 45% @ 1 mM Not tested
    1z COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00133
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00134
    H 1 CH 102 71% @ 300
    1aa COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00135
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00136
    H 1 CH  % @ 1 mM Not tested
    1bb COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00137
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00138
    H 1 CH 11% @ 1 mM 46% @ 300
    1cc COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00139
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00140
    H 1 CH 22% @ 1 mM 10% @ 300
    1dd CHO
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00141
    H H 1 CH 13% @ 1 mM Not tested
    1ee
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00142
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00143
    H H 1 CH 58.9 1.0
    1ff allyl
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00144
    H H 1 CH 0.58 98% @ 300
    1gg COCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00145
    H H 1 CH 27% @ 1 mM Not tested
    1hh CHO
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00146
    H H 1 CH  0% @ 1 mM Not tested
    1ii (S, S) CO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00147
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00148
    H 1 CH 21.5 60% @ 300
    1jj SO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00149
    H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00150
    1 CH 11.5 49% @ 300
    1kk SO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00151
    H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00152
    1 CH 5.1 52% @ 300
    1ll SO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00153
    H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00154
    1 CH 2.86 52% @ 300
    1mm SO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00155
    H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00156
    1 CH 287 Not tested
    1nn SO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00157
    H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00158
    1 CH 2.33 7.1
  • TABLE II
    Compounds of Formula II
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00159
    Ki (nM) Ki (nM)
    k k Late Phase
    [3H] (mg) Formalin
    Compounds R, n R′ Diprenorphin [3H]U69,593 A50 (mg)
    II-1  7-OCH3, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00160
    4.7 0.8 44% A @ 300
    II-2  7-OCH3, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00161
    142 20 124
    II-3  7-OH, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00162
    0.6 0.18  7
    II-4  7-OH, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00163
    549 432 Not tested
    II-5  7-OCH2CO2H, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00164
    40 7 39% @ 300
    II-6  7-NO2, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00165
    2.8 0.8  65
    II-7  7-NO2, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00166
    57% @ 1 mM 12.8 40% A @ 300
    II-8  7-NO2, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00167
    9.6 0.7 891
    II-9  7-NH2, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00168
    2.2 0.35  19
    II-10 7-N(CH2CO2Et)2, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00169
    4.6 0.68 37% A @ 300
    II-11 7-N(CH2CO2tBu)2, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00170
    7.4 2.8 nM 155
    II-12 7-N(CH2CO2H)2, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00171
    3.8 0.68 232
    II-13 7-NH(CH2)2PO3Et2, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00172
    6.2 2.2 Not tested
    II-14 7-NHPO3Et2, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00173
    2.4 0.6  34
    II-15 7-SO2NCH3Bn, n = 1 6-OMe
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00174
    48 8.0 Not tested
    II-16 7-SO2NCH3Bn, n = 1
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00175
    200 40 Not tested
    II-17 —H, n = 2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00176
    8.4 2.8 21% A @ 300
    II-18 R═H, n = 0
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00177
    12 2.0 80% @ 300
    II-19 R═H, n = 0
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00178
    46% @ 1 mM 29 Not tested
    II-20 R═H, n = 0
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00179
    29% @ 1 mM 146 Not tested
    II-21 R═H, n = 0
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00180
    5.7 0.74 Not tested
    II-22 R═H, n = 0
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00181
    75% @ 1 mM 9 Not tested
    II-23 (±)- Niravoline R═H, n = 0
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00182
    13 1.8 92% @ 300
  • TABLE IIA
    Compound of Formula IIA
    Ki (nM)
    [3H] Late Phase
    Compound Structure Diprenorphin κ Formalin
    II-24 (2a)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00183
    28.0 69% @ 300 μg
  • TABLE III
    Compounds of Formula III
    Ki (nM) Ki (nM) Late Phase
    k k Formalin
    Compounds X R R′ [3H]Diprenorphin [3H]U69.593 A50 (mg)
    III-1  —H —NO2(3-5% p-NO2)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00184
    0.65 0.25 16
    III-2  —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00185
    2.9, 9.0 0.7, 1.0 29
    III-3  —OH R═H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00186
    0.61 0.085 15
    III-4  —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00187
    0.2 0.1 5.3
    III-5  —OH R═H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00188
    0.09 0.07 2.7 mg/ms (i-paw) 0.18 mg/kg (sc)
    III-6  —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00189
    0.20 0.26 27
    III-7  —OH R═H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00190
    0.16 0.11 97% @ 300
    III-8  —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00191
    0.28 0.08 95% @ 300
    III-9  —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00192
    24% @ 1 mM 1.35 Not tested
    III-10 —H —NO2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00193
    35 3.2 Not tested
    III-11 —H —NO2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00194
    0.3 0.07 Not tested
    III-12 —H —NO2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00195
    31 1.5 Not tested
    III-13 —H —NO2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00196
    76% @ 1 mM 6.4 Not tested
    III-14 —H —NO2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00197
    25% @ 1 mM 79% @ 1 mM Not tested
    III-15 —H —NO2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00198
    19% @ 1 mM 168 Not tested
    III-16 —H 2,3-Br24-NH2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00199
    9.4 4.25 306
    III-17 —H —NH2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00200
    0.14 0.04 0.4
    III-18 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00201
    8.15 1.45 65
    III-19 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00202
    13 0.85 58% @ 300
    III-20 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00203
    22 1.8 52% @ 300
    III-21 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00204
    0.10 0.055 7
    III-22 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00205
    0.09 0.10 0.02 mg/Kg(s.c)
    III-23 —OH R═H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00206
    0.18 0.12 0.02 mg/kg sc
    III-24 —H —NH2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00207
    20 2.6 81% @ 300
    III-25 (EMD 60400) —OH R═H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00208
    0.8 0.175 33
    III-26 —H —NH2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00209
    61% @ 1 mM 43 Not tested
    III-27 —H —NH-a-D-Asp
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00210
    3.65 1.05 72
    III-28 —H —NH-a-L-Asp
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00211
    1.9 0.5 9.1
    III-29 —H —NH-a-L-(Asp)2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00212
    2.0 0.67 14
    III-30 —H —NH-b-L-Asp
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00213
    2.3 0.7 47
    III-31 —H —NH-g-D-Glu
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00214
    62
    III-32 —H —N(SO2Me)2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00215
    6.45 1.2 58
    III-33 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00216
    57% @ 1 mM 6.4, 8.9 17
    III-34 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00217
    54, 40 6.8, 3.5 mg/Kg (s.c.)
    III-35 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00218
    0.38, 0.45 0.01, 0.09 28
    III-36 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00219
    0.83, 0.49 0.29, 0.43 Not tested
    III-37 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00220
    2.2, 3.8 0.64, 0.38 Not tested
    III-38 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00221
    63% at 1 mM 10.8 91% @ 300
    III-39 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00222
    198 32 Not tested
    III-40 —H —N(SO2Me)2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00223
    7% @ 1 mM 58% @ 1 mM Not tested
    III-41 —NHPO3Et2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00224
    33 48 Not tested
    III-42 —H —NHPO3Et2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00225
    56% @ 1 mM 76 Not tested
    III-43 (EMD 61753) —OH R═H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00226
    0.52 0.34 59 mg/ms (i-paw) 28 mg/kg (sc)
    III-44 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00227
    25, 18 4.8, 3.0 67
    III-45 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00228
    55, 42, 60 7.7, 15 174
    III-46 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00229
    0.2, 0.17 0.21, 1.7 27
    III-47 —OH R═H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00230
    0.23 0.16 Not tested
    III-48 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00231
    5.4, 3.7 0.36, 0.39 39
    III-49 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00232
    0.43, 0.88 0.33, 0.38 29
    III-50 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00233
    0.94, 0.28 0.5, 0.07, 0.06 13
    III-51 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00234
    0.12, 0.013 0.050, 0.060 0.009 mg/Kg(s.c.)
    III-52 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00235
    0.30 0.12 97% @ 300
    III-53 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00236
    1.3 0.18 98% @ 300
    III-54 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00237
    22, 13 3.3, 1.3 90% A @ 300
    III-55 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00238
    65% @ 1 mM 98% @ 1 mM 43% @ 300
    III-56 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00239
    52 4.8 51% @ 300
    III-57 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00240
    5.4, 4.9 2.2. 1.2 Not tested
    III-58 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00241
    75% at 1 mM 9.0 32% @ 300
    III-59 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00242
    19 2.2 40% @ 300
    III-60 —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00243
    100% @ 1 mM 91% @ 1 mM 94% @ 300
    III-61 —OH R═H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00244
    1.06 0.36 Not tested
  • TABLE IIIA
    Compounds of Formula IIIA
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00245
    Ki (nM)
    [3H]- Late Phase
    Diprenorphin Formalin
    Compound X R R′ κ A50 (mg/kg)
    3a —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00246
    1.0 1.8
    3b —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00247
    464.0 Not tested
    3c —H —NHSO2NH2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00248
    0.12 0.27
    3d —H —NHSO2Me
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00249
    0.28 16.0
    3e —H —NHSO2Me
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00250
    3.2 71% @ 300
    3f —H —NHSO2Me
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00251
    0.18 8.9
    3g —H —NHPO3Et2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00252
    0.12 4.4
    3h —H —NH-maleic acid
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00253
    1.80 59% @ 10
    3i —H —NH—C10H16O4N2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00254
    0.14 23% @ 300
    3j —H —NH—C6H8O3N 2.3 38% @ 300
    3k —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00255
    18.0 Not tested
    3l —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00256
    3.8 73% @ 300
    3m —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00257
    5.1 65% @ 300
    3n —H —NHSO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00258
    7.3 73% @ 300
    3o —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00259
    30.5 59% @ 300
    3p —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00260
    9.7 84% @ 300
    3q —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00261
    3.2 Not tested
    3r —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00262
    7.3 10.0
    3s —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00263
    86% @ 300
    3t —OH —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00264
    4.2 65% @ 300
    3u —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00265
    1.0 48% @ 300
    3v —OH —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00266
    46.0 36% @ 300
    3w —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00267
    2.5 90% @ 300
    3y —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00268
    0.35 Not tested
    3z —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00269
    1.7 98% @ 300
    3aa —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00270
    5279.0 Not tested
    3bb —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00271
    438.0 Not tested
    3cc —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00272
    3.1 52% @ 30
    3dd —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00273
    3.8 65% @ 300
    3ee —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00274
    26.0 34% @ 300
    3ff —OH —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00275
    0.17 97% @ 300
    3gg —OH —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00276
    5.2 1.4
    3hh —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00277
    0.56 0.11
    3ii —OH —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00278
    0.44 88% @ 300
    3jj —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00279
    50% @ 1 μM Not tested
    3kk —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00280
    53% @ 1 μM 23% @ 300
    3ll —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00281
    68% @ 1 μM 77% @ 300
    3mm —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00282
    16.4 53% @ 300
    3nn —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00283
    8.8 Not tested
    3oo —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00284
    2.8 Not tested
    3pp —H —NHSO2CH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00285
    4.6 Not tested
    3qq —H —NHCOCH(CH3)2
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00286
    21.0 Not tested
    3rr —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00287
    0.44 2.9
    3ss —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00288
    361.5 Not tested
    3tt —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00289
    164.0 Not tested
    3uu —H —OCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00290
    17.5 Not tested
    3vv —H —OH
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00291
    19.5 Not tested
    3ww —OH —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00292
    1.28 Not tested
    3xx —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00293
    0.83 Not tested
    3yy —H —H (R-isomer)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00294
    0% @ 1 μM Not tested
    3zz —H —OCH3
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00295
    0.64 Not tested
    3aaa —H —OH
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00296
    0.59 Not tested
    3bbb —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00297
    4.45 Not tested
    3ccc —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00298
    1.1 Not tested
    3ddd —H —H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00299
    Not tested
  • TABLE IIIB
    Compounds of Formula IIIB and IIIB-i
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00300
    Ki(nM) Late Phase
    [3H]- Formalin
    Example Diprenorphin (i. paw)
    No. R R″ Ar κ A50(μg/kg)
    130 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00301
    1.3 46% @ 300
    131 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00302
    0.22
    132 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00303
    0.25 100% @ 300
    133 H OH
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00304
    0.64 98% @ 300
    134 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00305
    0.26 99% @ 300
    135 H OH
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00306
    0.66
    136 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00307
    0.44 97% @ 300
    137 H OH
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00308
    0.83
    138 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00309
    1.3 80% @ 300
    139 H OH
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00310
    4.2
    140 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00311
    0.56
    141 H OH
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00312
    1.3 98% @ 300
    142 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00313
    13
    143 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00314
    2.1 98% @ 300
    144 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00315
    0.17
    122 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00316
    0.80 85% @ 300
    145 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00317
    20.5 83% @ 300
    123 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00318
    23.6 87% @ 300
    124 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00319
    5.6 77% @ 300
    125 H OH
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00320
    5.3 81% @ 300
    126 H OH
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00321
    0.61 93% @ 300
    127 H OH
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00322
    0.82 94% @ 300
    128 (racemic) 4-OCH3 H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00323
    110 56% @ 300
    129A (racemic) 4-OH H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00324
    59 46% @ 300
    129B (S-isomer) 4-OH H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00325
    75 >46% @ 300
    146 H OH
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00326
    1 52% @ 300
    147 (racemic) 2-F H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00327
    10 56% @ 300
    148 H H
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00328
    0.83
  • TABLE IV
    Compounds of Formula IV
    5a-t
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00329
    Late Phase
    Ki(nM) Ki(nM) Formalin
    Compounds R diprenorphine U-69593 A50(mg)
    U-50488
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00330
    4.3 0.6 Not tested
    (5a)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00331
    596 100 Not tested
    (5b)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00332
    1031 433 Not tested
    (5c)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00333
    6.7 1.4 3.5
    (5d)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00334
    10.6 1.7 72.0 
    (5e)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00335
    3185 675 Not tested
    (5f)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00336
    14% @ 1 μM 866 Not tested
    (5g)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00337
    77% @ 1 μM 3.75 59% @ 300 μg
    (5h)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00338
    59% @ 1 μM 13.4 58% @ 300 μg
    (5i)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00339
    43% @ 1 μM 5.4 73% @ 300 μg
    (5j)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00340
    13% @ 1 μM 48% @1 μM Not tested
    (5k)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00341
    16% @ 1 μM 216.0 Not tested
    (5l)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00342
    43.5 2.35 4.7
    (5m)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00343
    192.5 11.25 6.2
    (5n)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00344
    61% @ 1 μM 10.85 70% @ 300 μg
    (5o)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00345
    5.65 1.4 86% @ 300 μg
    (5p)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00346
    53% @ 1 μM 25.0 Not tested
    (5r)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00347
    50% @ 1 μM 21.0 Not tested
    (5s)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00348
    1171 330 Not tested
    (5t)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00349
    40% @ 1 mM 96 Not tested
  • TABLE IVA
    Compounds of Formula IVA
    5
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00350
    Formalin
    (% A
    @ 300 μg i-paw
    Ki(nM) or
    Compounds R [3H]-Diprenorphin A50(mg/kg s.c.)
    4a
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00351
    77.0 26% @ 300
    4b
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00352
    22% @ 1 μM Not tested
    4c
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00353
    7% @ 1 μM NT
    4d
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00354
    340.5 Not tested
    4f
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00355
    0% @ 1 μM Not tested
    4g
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00356
    294.0 Not tested
    4h
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00357
    164.0 56% @ 300
    4i
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00358
    31% @ 1 μM Not tested
    4j (1S,2S)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00359
    10.30 91% @ 300
    4k (1R, 2R)
    Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00360
    28% @ 1 μM 80% @ 300
  • FORMULATIONS OF THE PRESENT INVENTION
  • Effective concentrations of one or more of the compounds of the present invention or pharmaceutically acceptable derivatives thereof are mixed with a suitable pharmaceutical carrier or vehicle for systemic, topical or local administration. Compounds are included in an amount effective for reducing the hyperalgesic state or other symptoms for which treatment is contemplated. The concentration of active compound in the composition will depend on absorption, inactivation, excretion rates of the active compound, the dosage schedule, and amount administered as well as other factors known to those of skill in the art. For topical and local administration, the dosages are higher, typically at least about 5 to 10 fold, than the amount delivered when administered systemically orally.
  • The compounds of the present invention possess analgesic activity and can be used for the relief of pain without loss of consciousness. For example, compounds can be used to treat muscle spasm, arthritis and other musculoskeletal conditions, e.g., bursitis, relieve mild to moderate postoperative and postpartum pain, dysmenorrhea and pain of traumatic origin.
  • Additionally, the compounds of the present invention can be administered for the treatment of severe pain, e.g., pain associated with adenocarcinoma, amputation of a limb, and third degree burns over a major portion of the body in animals and humans.
  • Selected compounds of the present invention have activity as narcotic antagonists. They can be used to counteract or prevent excessive central nervous system depression and respiratory depression resulting from the administration of morphine or other morphine-like drugs, e.g., hydromorphone, oxymorphone, methadone and meperidine. The compounds are also capable of inducing an abstinence syndrome in narcotic addicted subjects, i.e., induce withdrawal effects for diagnostic purposes.
  • The dosage of the compound of Formulas I, IA, II, IIA, III, IIIA, IIIB, IIIB-i, IV, and IVA for analgesic purposes is from about 0.001 to about 20 mg/kg body weight of the patient. The compounds of Formulas I, IA, II, IIA, III, IIIA, IIIB, IIIB-i, IV, and IVA are conveniently prepared in 5, 10, 25, 50, 75, 100 and 200 mg dosage units for administration for 1 to 4 times a day. Preferred unit dosages are from 0.05 to 10 mg/kg body weight of the patient.
  • The compounds are administered orally, parenterally, rectally and topically.
  • Pharmaceutical carriers or vehicles suitable for administration of the compounds and for the methods provided herein include any such carriers known to those skilled in the art to be suitable for the particular mode of administration. In addition, the compounds may be formulated as the sole pharmaceutically active ingredient in the composition or may be combined with other active ingredients.
  • a) Systemic Formulations
  • The formulations of the present invention are provided for administration to humans and animals in unit dosage forms, such as tablets, capsules, pills, powders, granules, sterile parenteral solutions or suspensions, and oral solutions or suspensions, and oil-water emulsions containing suitable quantities of a compound of Formulas I, IA, II, IIA, III, IIIA, IIIB, IIIB-i, IV, and IVA or pharmacologically acceptable salts thereof.
  • Pharmaceutical dosage unit forms are prepared to provide from about 0.05 mg to about 500 mg and preferably from about 1.0 to about 200 mg of the essential active ingredient or a combination of essential ingredients per dosage unit form.
  • Oral pharmaceutical dosage forms are either solid or liquid. The solid dosage forms are tablets, capsules, granules, and bulk powders. Types of oral tablets include compressed, chewable lozenges and tablets which may be enteric-coated, sugar-coated or film-coated. Capsules may be hard or soft gelatin capsules, while granules and powders may be provided in non-effervescent or effervescent form with the combination of other ingredients known to those skilled in the art.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers utilized in tablets are binders, lubricants, diluents, disintegrating agents, coloring agents, flavoring agents, and wetting agents. Enteric-coated tablets, due to their enteric-coating, resist the action of stomach acid and dissolve or disintegrate in the neutral or alkaline intestines. Sugar-coated tablets are compressed tablets to which different layers of pharmaceutically acceptable substances have been applied. Film-coated tablets are compressed tablets which have been coated with a water soluble polymers. Multiple compressed tablets are compressed tablets made by more than one compression cycle utilizing the pharmaceutically acceptable substances previously mentioned. Coloring agents may also be used in the above dosage forms. Flavoring and sweetening agents are used in compressed tablets, sugar-coated, multiple compressed and chewable tablets. Flavoring and sweetening agents are especially useful in the formation of chewable tablets and lozenges.
  • Examples of binders include glucose solution, acacia mucilage, gelatin solution, sucrose and starch paste. Lubricants include talc, starch, magnesium or calcium stearate, lycopodium and stearic acid. Diluents include, for example, lactose, sucrose, starch, kaolin, salt, mannitol and dicalcium phosphate. Disintegrating agents include corn starch, potato starch, bentonite, methylcellulose, agar and carboxymethylcellulose. Coloring agents include, for example, any of the approved certified water soluble FD and C dyes, mixtures thereof, and water insoluble FD and C dyes suspended on alumia hydrate. Sweetening agents include sucrose, lactose, mannitol and artificial sweetening agents such as sodium cyclamate and saccharin, and any number of spray dried flavors. Flavoring agents include natural flavors extracted from plants such as fruits and synthetic blends of compounds which produce a pleasant sensation. Wetting agents include propylene glycol monostearate, sorbitan monooleate, diethylene glycol monolaurate and polyoxyethylene laural ether. Enteric-coatings include fatty acids, fats, waxes, shellac, ammoniated shellac and cellulose acetate phthalates. Film coatings include hydroxyethylcellulose, sodium carboxymethylcellulose, polyethylene glycol 4000 and cellulose acetate phthalate.
  • Liquid oral dosage forms include aqueous solutions, emulsions, suspensions, solutions and/or suspensions reconstituted from non-effervescent granules and effervescent preparations reconstituted from effervescent granules. Aqueous solutions include, for example, elixirs and syrups. Emulsions are either oil-in water or water-in-oil.
  • Elixirs are clear, sweetened, hydroalcoholic preparations. Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers used in elixirs include solvents. Syrups are concentrated aqueous solutions of a sugar, for example, sucrose, and may contain a preservative. An emulsion is a two-phase system in which one liquid is dispersed in the form of small globules throughout another liquid. Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers used in emulsions are non-aqueous liquids, emulsifying agents and preservatives. Suspensions use pharmaceutically acceptable suspending agents and preservatives. Pharmaceutically acceptable substances used in non-effervescent granules, to be reconstituted into a liquid oral dosage form, include diluents, sweeteners and wetting agents. Pharmaceutically acceptable substance used in effervescent granules, to be reconstituted into a liquid oral dosage form, include organic acids and a source of carbon dioxide. Coloring and flavoring agents are used in all of the above dosage forms.
  • Solvents include glycerin, sorbitol, ethyl alcohol and syrup. Examples of preservatives include glycerin, methyl and propylparaben, benzoic acid, sodium benzoate and alcohol. Examples of non-aqueous liquids utilized in emulsions include mineral oil and cottonseed oil. Examples of emulsifying agents include gelatin, acacia, tragacanth, bentonite, and surfactants such as polyoxyethylene sorbitan monooleate. Suspending agents include sodium carboxymethylcellulose, pectin, tragacanth, Veegum and acacia. Diluents include lactose and sucrose. Sweetening agents include sucrose, syrups, glycerin and artificial sweetening agents such as sodium cyclamate and saccharin. Wetting agents include propylene glycol monostearate, sorbitan monooleate, diethylene glycol monolaurate and polyoxyethylene lauryl ether. Organic acids include citric and tartaric acid. Sources of carbon dioxide include sodium bicarbonate and sodium carbonate. Coloring agents include any of the approved certified water soluble FD and C dyes, and mixtures thereof. Flavoring agents include natural flavors extracted from plants such fruits, and synthetic blends of compounds which produce a pleasant taste sensation.
  • Parenteral administration of the formulations of the present invention includes intravenous, subcutaneous and intramuscular administrations.
  • Preparations for parenteral administration include sterile solutions ready for injection, sterile dry soluble products ready to be combined with a solvent just prior to use, including hypodermic tablets, sterile suspensions ready for injection, sterile dry insoluble products ready to be combined with a vehicle just prior to use and sterile emulsions. The solutions may be either aqueous or nonaqueous.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers used in parenteral preparations include aqueous vehicles, nonaqueous vehicles, antimicrobial agents, isotonic agents, buffers, antioxidants, local anesthetics, suspending and dispersing agents, emulsifying agents, sequestering or chelating agents and other pharmaceutically acceptable substances.
  • Examples of aqueous vehicles include Sodium Chloride Injection, Ringers Injection, Isotonic Dextrose Injection, Sterile Water Injection, Dextrose and Lactated Ringers Injection. Nonaqueous parenteral vehicles include fixed oils of vegetable origin, cottonseed oil, corn oil, sesame oil and peanut oil. Antimicrobial agents in bacteriostatic or fungistatic concentrations must be added to parenteral preparations packaged in multiple-dose containers which include phenols or cresols, mercurials, benzyl alcohol, chlorobutanol, methyl and propyl p-hydroxybenzoic acid esters, thimerosal, benzalkonium chloride and benzethonium chloride. Isotonic agents include sodium chloride and dextrose. Buffers include phosphate and citrate. Antioxidants include sodium bisulfate. Local anesthetics include procaine hydrochloride. Suspending and dispersing agents include sodium carboxymethylcelluose, hydroxypropyl methylcellulose and polyvinylpyrrolidone. Emulsifying agents include Polysorbate 80 (Tween 80). A sequestering or chelating agent of metal ions include EDTA. Pharmaceutical carriers also include ethyl alcohol, polyethylene glycol and propylene glycol for water miscible vehicles and sodium hydroxide, hydrochloric acid, citric acid or lactic acid for pH adjustment.
  • The concentration of the pharmaceutically active compound is adjusted so that an injection provides an effective amount to produce the desired pharmacological effect. The exact dose depends on the age, weight and condition of the patient or animal as is known in the art.
  • The unit-dose parenteral preparations are packaged in an ampoule or a syringe with a needle.
  • All preparations for parenteral administration must be sterile, as is known and practiced in the art.
  • Illustratively, intravenous or intraarterial infusion of a sterile aqueous solution containing an active compound is an effective mode of administration. Another embodiment is a sterile aqueous or oily solution or suspension containing an active material injected as necessary to produce the desired pharmacological effect.
  • Pharmaceutical dosage forms for rectal administration are rectal suppositories, capsules and tablets for systemic effect.
  • Rectal suppositories are used herein mean solid bodies for insertion into the rectum which melt or soften at body temperature releasing one or more pharmacologically or therapeutically active ingredients.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable substances utilized in rectal suppositories are bases or vehicles and agents to raise the melting point.
  • Examples of bases include cocoa butter (theobroma oil), glycerin-gelatin, carbowax, (polyoxyethylene glycol) and appropriate mixtures of mono-, di- and triglycerides of fatty acids. Combinations of the various bases may be used. Agents to raise the melting point of suppositories include spermaceti and wax. Rectal suppositories may be prepared either by the compressed method or by molding. The typical weight of a rectal suppository is about 2 to 3 gm.
  • Tablets and capsules for rectal administration are manufactured using the same pharmaceutically acceptable substance and by the same methods as for formulations for oral administration.
  • The pharmaceutically therapeutically active compounds of Formulas I, II, III and IV are administered orally, parenterally or rectally in unit-dosage forms or multiple-dosage forms. Unit-dose forms as used herein refers to physically discrete units suitable for human and animal subjects and packaged individually as is known in the art. Each unit-dose contains a predetermined quantity of the therapeutically active compound sufficient to produce the desired therapeutic effect, in association with the required pharmaceutical carrier, vehicle or diluent. Examples of unit-dose forms include ampoules and syringes individually packaged tablet or capsule. Unit-dose forms may be administered in fractions or multiples thereof. A multiple-dose form is a plurality of identical unit-dosage forms packaged in a single container to be administered in segregated unit-dose form. Examples of multiple-dose forms include vials, bottles of tablets or capsules or bottles of pint or gallons. Hence, multiple dose form is a multiple of unit-doses which are not segregated in packaging.
  • Compounds of the present invention in formulations may be included with other active compounds to obtain desired combinations of properties. Other active compounds with known pharmacological properties include analgesics such as aspirin, phenacetin acetaminophen, propoxyphene, pentazocine, codeine, meperidine, oxycodone, mefenamic acid, and ibuprofen; muscle relaxants such as methocarbamol, orphenadrine, carisoprodol, meprobamate, chlorphenesin carbamate, diazepam, chlordiazepoxide and chlorzoxazone; analeptics such as caffeine, methylphenidate and pentylenetetrazol; corticosteroids such as methylprednisolone, prednisone, prednisolone and dexamethasone; antihistamines such as chlorpheniramine, cyproheptadine, promethazine and pyrilamine.
  • b) Local and Topical Formulations
  • Typically a therapeutically effective dosage is formulated to contain a concentration of at least about 0.1% w/w up to about 50% w/w or more, preferably more than 1% w/w of the active compound to the treated tissue. The active ingredient may be administered at once, or may be divided into a number of smaller doses to be administered at intervals of time. It is understood that the precise dosage and duration of treatment is a function of the tissue being treated and may be determined empirically using known testing protocols or by extrapolation from in vivo or in vitro test data. It is to be noted that concentrations and dosage values may also vary with the age of the individual treated. It is to be further understood that for any particular subject, specific dosage regimens should be adjusted over time according to the individual need and the professional judgment of the person administering or supervising the administration of the formulations, and that the concentration ranges set forth herein are exemplary only and are not intended to limit the scope or practice of the claimed formulations.
  • The compound may be suspended in micronized or other suitable form or may be derivatized to produce a more soluble active product or to produce a prodrug. The form of the resulting mixture depends upon a number of factors, including the intended mode of administration and the solubility of the compound in the selected carrier or vehicle. The effective concentration is sufficient for ameliorating the hyperalgesic or other condition and may be empirically determined.
  • Compounds are typically included at concentrations 0.001% w/w or greater than 1% w/w up to 50% w/w or higher. The concentration is generally greater than the concentration for systemic administration of the compound. Preferable concentrations are in the range of 0.01% w/w to about 25% w/w, more preferably 1% w/w to 25% w/w, yet more preferably greater than about 1% w/w to about 10% w/w, and most preferably greater than 1% w/w up to about 5% w/w. Aqueous suspensions and formulations contain 1% w/w or more.
  • The resulting mixture may be a solution, suspension, emulsions or the like and are formulated as creams, gels, ointments, emulsions, solutions, elixirs, lotions, suspensions, tinctures, pastes, foams, aerosols, irrigations, sprays, suppositories, bandages, or any other formulations suitable for topical or local administration.
  • The route of administration herein is topical or local administration, and compositions are formulated in a manner suitable for each route of administration. Preferred modes of administration include topical application to the skin, eyes or mucosa, and local application to the joints, such as by intra-articular injection. Thus, typical vehicles are those suitable for pharmaceutical or cosmetic application to body surfaces or for local injection.
  • Pharmaceutical and cosmetic carriers or vehicles suitable for administration of the compounds provided herein include any such carriers known to those skilled in the art to be suitable for the particular mode of administration. In addition, the compounds may be formulated as the sole pharmaceutically active ingredient in the composition or may be combined with other active ingredients. The active compound is included in the carrier in an amount sufficient to exert a therapeutically useful effect in the absence of serious toxic effects on the treated individual. The effective concentration may be determined empirically by testing the compounds using in vitro and in vivo systems, including the animal models described herein.
  • For topical administration, the compounds may be formulated in compositions in the form of gels, creams, lotions, solids, solutions or suspensions, or aerosols. Compositions for treating human skin are formulated for topical application with an anti-hyperalgesic effective amount of one or more of the compounds selected as described herein, in an effective concentration range [by weight], between about 0.1% and 80%, preferably 0.1 to 50%, more preferably greater than about 1% up to about 50% or more in a cream, ointment, lotion, gel, solution or solid base or vehicle known in the art to be non-toxic and dermatologically acceptable or suitable for application to the mucosa. Aqueous suspensions are preferably formulated at concentrations greater than about 1% w/w, more preferably 2% w/w.
  • To formulate a composition, the weight fraction of compound is dissolved, suspended, dispersed or otherwise mixed in a selected vehicle at an effective concentration such that the hyperalgesic condition is relieved or ameliorated. Generally, emollient or lubricating vehicles that help hydrate the skin are more preferred than volatile vehicles, such as ethanol, that dry the skin. Examples of suitable bases or vehicles for preparing compositions for use with human skin are petrolatum, petrolatum plus volatile silicones, lanolin, cold cream [USP], and hydrophilic ointment [USP].
  • The choice of an acceptable vehicle is largely determined by the mode of application and tissue to be treated. Suitable pharmaceutically and dermatologically acceptable vehicles for topical application include those suited for use include lotions, creams, solutions, gels, tapes and the like. Generally, the vehicle is either organic in nature or an aqueous emulsion and capable of having the selected compound or compounds, which may be micronized, dispersed, suspended or dissolved therein. The vehicle may include pharmaceutically-acceptable emollients, skin penetration enhancers, coloring agents, fragrances, emulsifiers, thickening agents, and solvents.
  • For local internal administration, such as intra-articular administration, the compounds are preferably formulated as a suspension in an aqueous-based medium, such as isotonically buffered saline or are combined with a biocompatible support or bioadhesive intended for internal administration.
  • Lotions
  • The lotions contain an effective concentration of one or more of the compounds. The effective concatenation is preferably effective to deliver an anti-hyperalgesic amount, typically at a concentration of between about 0.1-50% w/w or more of one or more of the compounds provided herein. The lotions also contain from 1% to 50% w/w, preferably from 3% to 15% w/w of an emollient and the balance water, a suitable buffer, a C2 or C3 alcohol, or a mixture of water of the buffer and the alcohol. Any emollients known to those of skill in the art as suitable for application to human skin may be used. These include, but are not limited to, the following:
      • (a) Hydrocarbon oils and waxed, including mineral oil, petrolatum, paraffin, ceresin, ozokerite, microcrystalline wax, polyethylene, and perhydrosqualene.
      • (b) Silicone oils, including dimethylpolysiloxanes, methylphenylpolysiloxanes, water-soluble and alcohol-soluble silicone-glycol copolymers.
      • (c) Triglyceride fats and oils, including those derived from vegetable, animal and marine sources. Examples include, but are not limited to, castor oil, safflower oil, cotton seed oil, corn oil, olive oil, cod liver oil, almond oil, avocado oil, palm oil, sesame oil and soybean oil.
      • (d) Acetoglyceride esters, such as acetylated monoglycerides.
      • (e) Ethoxylated glycerides, such as ethoxylated glyceryl monostearate.
      • (f) Alkyl esters of fatty acids having 10 to 20 carbon atoms. Methyl, isopropyl and butyl esters of fatty acids are useful herein. Examples include, but are not limited to, hexyl laurate, isohexyl laurate, isohexyl palmitate, isopropyl palmitate, isopropyl myristate, decyl oleate, isodecyl oleate, hexadecyl stearate, decyl stearate, isopropyl isostearate diisopropyl adipate, diisohexyl adipate, dihexyldecyl adipate, diisopropyl sebacate, lauryl lactate, myristyl lactate, and cetyl lactate.
      • (g) Alkenyl esters of fatty acids having 10 to 20 carbon atoms. Examples thereof include, but are not limited to, oleyl myristate, oleyl stearate, and oleyl oleate.
      • (h) Fatty acids having 9 to 22 carbon atoms. Suitable examples include, but are not limited to pelargonic, lauric, myristic, palmitic, stearic, isostearic, hydroxystearic, oleic, linoleic, ricinoleic, arachidonic, behenic, and erucic acids.
      • (i) Fatty alcohols having 10 to 20 carbon atoms, such as but not limited to, lauryl, myristyl, cetyl, hexadecyl, stearyl, isostearyl, hydroxystearyl, oleyl, ricinoleyl, behenyl, erucyl, and 2-octyl dodecyl alcohols.
      • (j) Fatty alcohol ethers, including, but not limited to, ethoxylated fatty alcohols of 10 to 20 carbon atoms, such as, but are not limited to, the lauryl cetyl, stearyl, isostearyl, oleyl, and cholesterol alcohols having attached thereto from 1 to 50 ethylene oxide groups or 1 to 50 propylene oxide groups or mixtures thereof.
      • (k) Ether-esters, such as fatty acid esters of ethoxylated fatty alcohols.
      • (l) Lanolin and derivatives, including but not limited to, lanolin, lanolin oil, lanolin wax, lanolin alcohols, lanolin fatty acids, isopropyl lanolate, ethoxylated lanolin, ethoxylated lanolin alcohols, ethoxylated cholesterol, propoxylated lanolin alcohols, acetylated lanolin, acetylated lanolin alcohols, lanolin alcohols linoleate, lanolin alcohols ricinoleate, acetate of lanolin alcohols ricinoleate, acetate of ethoxylated alcohols-esters, hydrogenolysis of lanolin, ethoxylated hydrogenated lanolin, ethoxylated sorbitol lanolin, and liquid and semisolid lanolin absorption bases.
      • (m) Polyhydric alcohols and polyether derivatives, including, but not limited to, propylene glycol, dipropylene glycol, polypropylene glycol [M.W. 2000-4000], polyoxyethylene polyoxypropylene glycols, polyoxypropylene polyoxyethylene glycols, glycerol, ethoxylated glycerol, propoxylated glycerol, sorbitol, ethoxylated sorbitol, hydroxypropyl sorbitol, polyethylene glycol [M.W. 200-6000], methoxy polyethylene glycols 350, 550, 750, 2000, 5000, poly)ethylene oxide) homopolymers [M.W. 100,000-5,000,000], polyalkylene glycols and derivatives, hexylene glycol (2-methyl-2,4-pentanediol), 1,3-butylene glycol, 1,2,6-hexanetriol, ethohexadiol USP (2-ethyl-11,3-hexanediol), C15-C18 vicinal glycol and polyoxypropylene derivatives of trimethylolpropane.
      • (n) Polyhydric alcohol esters, including, but not limited to, ethylene glycol mono- and di-fatty acid esters, diethylene glycol mono- and di-fatty acid esters, polyethylene glycol [M.W. 200-6000], mono- and di-fatty esters, propylene glycol mono- and di-fatty acid esters, polypropylene glycol 2000 monooleate, polypropylene glycol 2000 monostearate, ethoxylated propylene glycol monostearate, glyceryl mono- and di-fatty acid esters, polyglycerol poly-fatty acid esters, ethoxylated glyceryl monostearate, 1,3-butylene glycol monostearate, 1,3-butylene glycol distearate, polyoxyethylene polyol fatty acid ester, sorbitan fatty acid esters, and polyoxyethylene sorbitan fatty acid esters.
      • (o) Wax esters, including, but not limited to, beeswax, spermaceti, myristyl myristate, and stearyl stearate and beeswax derivatives, including, but not limited to, polyoxyethylene sorbitol beeswax, which are reaction products of beeswax with ethoxylated sorbitol of varying ethylene oxide content that form a mixture of ether-esters.
      • (p) Vegetable waxes, including, but not limited to, carnauba and candelilla waxes.
      • (q) Phospholipids, such as lecithin and derivatives.
      • (r) Sterols, including, but not limited to, cholesterol and cholesterol fatty acid esters.
      • (s) Amides, such as fatty acid amides, ethoxylated fatty acid amides, and solid fatty acid alkanolamides.
  • The lotions further preferably contain from 1% w/w to 10% w/w, more preferably from 2% w/w to 5% w/w, of an emulsifier. The emulsifiers can be nonionic, anionic or cationic. Examples of satisfactory nonionic emulsifiers include, but are not limited to, fatty alcohols having 10 to 20 carbon atoms, fatty alcohols having 10 to 20 carbon atoms condensed with 2 to 20 moles of ethylene oxide or propylene oxide, alkyl phenols with 6 to 12 carbon atoms in the alkyl chain condensed with 2 to 20 moles of ethylene oxide, mono- and di-fatty acid esters of ethylene oxides mono- and di-fatty acid esters of ethylene glycol wherein the fatty acid moiety contains from 10 to 20 carbon atoms, diethylene glycol, polyethylene glycols of molecular weight 200 to 6000, propylene glycols of molecular weight 200 to 3000, glycerol, sorbitol, sorbitan, polyoxyethylene sorbitol, polyoxyethylene sorbitan and hydrophilic wax esters. Suitable anionic emulsifiers include, but are not limited to, the fatty acid soaps, e.g. sodium, potassium and triethanolamine soaps, wherein the fatty acid moiety contains from 10 to 20 carbon atoms. Other suitable anionic emulsifiers include, but are not limited to, the alkali metal, ammonium or substituted ammonium alkyl sulfates, alkyl arylsulfonates, and alkyl ethoxy ether sulfonates having 10 to 30 carbon atoms in the alkyl moiety. The alkyl ethoxy ether sulfonates contain from 1 to 50 ethylene oxide units. Among satisfactory cationic emulsifiers are quaternary ammonium, morpholinium and pyridinium compounds. Certain of the emollients described in preceding paragraphs also have emulsifying properties. When a lotion is formulated containing such an emollient, an additional emulsifier is not needed, though it can be included in the composition.
  • The balance of the lotion is water or a C2 or C3 alcohol, or a mixture of water and the alcohol. The lotions are formulated by simply admixing all of the components together. Preferably, the compound, is dissolved, suspended or otherwise uniformly dispersed in the mixture.
  • Other conventional components of such lotions may be included. One such additive is a thickening agent at a level from 1% to 10% w/w of the composition. Examples of suitable thickening agents include, but are not limited to: cross-linked carboxypolymethylene polymers, ethyl cellulose, polyethylene glycols, gum, tragacanth, gum kharaya, xanthan gums and bentonite, hydroxyethyl cellulose, and hydroxypropyl cellulose.
  • Creams
  • The creams are formulated to contain concentration effective to deliver an anti-hyperalgesic effective amount of the compound to the treated tissue, typically at between about 0.1%, preferably at greater than 1% up to and greater than 50%, preferably between about 3% and 50%, more preferably between about 5% and 15% of one or more of the compounds provided herein. The creams also contain from 5% to 50%, preferably from 10% to 25%, of an emollient and the remainder is water or other suitable non-toxic carrier, such as an isotonic buffer. The emollients, as described above for the lotions, can also be used in the cream compositions. The cream may also contain a suitable emulsifier, as described above. The emulsifier is included in the composition at a level from 3% to 50%, preferably from 5% to 20%.
  • Solutions and Suspensions for Topical and Local Administration
  • The solutions are formulated to contain an amount of one or more compounds effective to deliver an anti-hyperalgesic amount, typically at a concentration of between about 0.1-50% w/w, preferably at least more than 1% w/w, more preferably more than 2% w/w of one or more of the compounds provided herein. The balance is water, a suitable organic solvent or other suitable solvent or buffer. Suitable organic materials useful as the solvent or a part of a solvent system are as follows: propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol [M.W. 200-600], polypropylene glycol [M.W. 425-2025], glycerine, sorbitol esters, 1,2,6-hexanetriol, ethanol, isopropanol, diethyl tartrate, butanediol and mixtures thereof. Such solvent systems can also contain water.
  • Solutions or suspensions used for local application can include any of the following components: a sterile diluent, such as water for injection, saline solution, fixed oil, polyethylene glycol, glycerine, propylene glycol or other synthetic solvent; antimicrobial agents, such as benzyl alcohol and methyl parabens; antioxidants, such as ascorbic acid and sodium bisulfite; chelating agnets, such as ethylenediaminetetraacetic acid [EDTA]; buffers, such as acetates, citrates and phosphates; and agents for the adjustment of tonicity such as sodium chloride or dextrose. Liquid preparations can be enclosed in ampoules, disposable syringes or multiple dose vials made of glass, plastic or other suitable material. Suitable carriers may include physiological saline or phosphate buffered saline [PBS], and the suspensions and solutions may contain thickening and solubilizing agents, such as glucose, polyethylene glycol, and polypropylene glycol and mixtures thereof. Liposomal suspensions, may also be suitable as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. These may be prepared according to methods known to those skilled in the art.
  • These compositions that are formulated as solutions or suspensions may be applied to the skin, or may be formulated as an aerosol or foam and applied to the skin as a spray-on. The aerosol compositions typically contain from 25% to 80% w/w, preferably from 30% to 50% w/w, of a suitable propellant. Examples of such propellants are the chlorinated, fluorinated and chlorofluorinated lower molecular weight hydrocarbons. Nitrous oxide, carbon dioxide, butane, and propane are also used as propellant gases. These propellants are used as understood in the art in a quantity and under a pressure suitable to expel the contents of the container.
  • Suitably prepared solutions and suspension may also be topically applied to the eyes and mucosa. Solutions, particularly those intended for opthalmic use, may be formulated as 0.01%-10% w/w isotonic solutions, pH about 5-7, with appropriate salts, and preferably containing one or more of the compounds herein at a concentration of about 0.1% w/w preferably greater than 1% w/w, up to 50% w/w or more. Suitable opthalmic solutions are known [see, e.g. U.S. Pat. No. 5,116,868, which describes typical compositions of opthalmic irrigation solutions and solutions for topical application]. Such solutions, which have a pH adjusted to about 7.4, contain, for example, 90-100 mM sodium chloride, 4-6 mM dibasic potassium phosphate, 4-6 mM dibasic sodium phosphate, 8-12 mM sodium citrate, 0.5-1.5 mM magnesium chloride, 1.5-2.5 mM calcium chloride, 15-25 mM sodium acetate, 10-20 mM D.L.-sodium β-hydroxybutyrate and 5-5.5 mM glucose.
  • The active compounds of the present invention can also be mixed with other active materials, that do not impair the desired action, or with materials that supplement the desired action, including viscoelastic materials, such as hyaluronic acid, which is sold under the trademark HEALON [solution of a high molecular weight (MW of about 3 million) fraction of sodium hyaluronate; manufactured by Pharmacia, Inc. see, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,292,362, 5,282,851, 5,273,056, 5,229,127, 4,517,295 and 4,328,803], VISCOAT [fluorine-containing (meth) acrylates, such as, 1H, 2H, 2H-heptadecafluorodecylmethacrylate; see, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,278,126, 5,273,751 and 5,214,080; commercially available from Alcon Surgical, Inc.], ORCOLON [see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,273,056; commercially available from Optical Radiation Corporation], methylcellulose, methyl hyaluronate, polyacrylamide and polymethacrylamide [see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,273,751]. The viscoelastic materials are present generally in amounts ranging from about 0.5 to 5.0% w/w, preferably 1 to 3% w/w of the conjugate material and serve to coat and protect the treated tissues. The compositions may also include a dye, such as methylene blue or other inert dye, so that the composition can be seen when injected into the eye or contacted with the surgical site during surgery.
  • Gels
  • Gel compositions can be formulated by simply admixing a suitable thickening agent to the previously described solution or suspension composition. Examples of suitable thickening agents have been previously described with respect to the lotions.
  • The gelled compositions contain an effective amount of one or more of an antihyperalgesic amount, typically at a concentration of between about 0.1-50% w/w or more of one or more of the compounds provided therein; from 5% to 75% w/w, preferably from 10% to 50% w/w, of an organic solvent as previously described; from 0.5% to 20% w/w, preferably from 1% to 10% w/w of the thickening agent; the balance being water or other aqueous carrier.
  • Solids
  • Compositions of solid forms may be formulated as stick-type compositions intended for application to the lips or other parts of the body. Such compositions contain an effective amount of one or more of the compounds provided therein. The amount is typically an amount effective to deliver an anti-hyperyperalgesic amount, typically at a concentration of between about 0.1-50% w/w or more of one or more of the compounds provided herein. The solids also contain from about 40% to 98% w/w, preferably from about 50% to 905 w/w, of the previously described emollients. This composition can further contain from 1% to 20% w/w, preferably from 5% to 15% w/w, of a suitable thickening agent, and, if desired or needed, emulsifiers and water or buffers. Thickening agents previously described with respect to lotions are suitably employed in the composition in solid form.
  • Other ingredients such as preservatives, including methyl-paraben or ethyl-paraben, perfumes, dyes or the like, that are known in the art to provide desirable stability, fragrance or color, or other desirable properties, such as shielding from actinic rays from the sun, to compositions for application to the skin may also be employed in a composition for such topical application.
  • Additional Ingredients
  • Other active ingredients include, but are not limited to, antibiotics, antivirals, antifungals, anti-inflammatories, including steroidal and non-steroidal anti-inflammatories, anesthetics and mixtures thereof. Such additional ingredients include any of the following:
  • a. Antibacterial Agents
  • Aminoglycosides, such as Amikacin, Apramycin, Arbekacin, Bambermycins, Butirosin, Dibekacin, Dihydrostreptomycin, Fortimicin(s), Fradiomycin, Gentamicin, Ispamicin, Kanamycin, Micronomicin, Neomycin, Neomycin Undecylenate, Netilmicin, Paromomycin, Ribostamycin, Sisomicin, Spectinomycin, Streptomycin, Streptonicozid and Tobramycin;
  • Amphenicols, such as Azidamfenicol, Chloramphenicol, Chloramphenicol Palmirate, Chloramphenicol Pantothenate, Florfenicol, Thiamphenicol;
  • Ansamycins, such as Rifamide, Rifampin, Rifamycin and Rifaximin;
  • β-Lactams;
  • Carbapenems, such as Imipenem;
  • Cephalosporins, such as 1-Carba (dethia) Cephalosporin, Cefactor, Cefadroxil, Cefamandole, Cefatrizine, Cefazedone, Cefazolin, Cefixime, Cefinenoxime, Cefodizime, Cefonicid, Cefoperazone, Ceforanide, Cefotaxime, Cefotiam, Cefpimizole, Cefpirimide, Cefpodoxime Proxetil, Cefroxadine, Cefsulodin, Ceftazidime, Cefteram, Ceftezole, Ceftibuten, Ceftizoxime, Ceftriaxone, Cefuroxime, Cefuzonam, Cephacetrile Sodium, Cephalexin, Cephaloglycin, Cephaloridine, Cephalosporin, Cephalothin, Cephapirin Sodium, Cephradine and Pivcefalexin;
  • Cephamycins such as Cefbuperazone, Cefinetazole, Cefminox, Cefetan and Cefoxitin;
  • Monobactams such as Aztreonam, Carumonam and Tigemonan;
  • Oxacephems such as Flomoxef and Moxolactam;
  • Penicillins such as Amidinocillin, Amdinocillin, Pivoxil, Amoxicillin, Ampicillan, Apalcillin, Aspoxicillin, Azidocillan, Azlocillan, Bacampicillin, Benzylpenicillinic Acid, Benzylpenicillin, Carbenicillin, Carfecillin, Carindacillin, Clometocillin, Cloxacillin, Cyclacillin, Dicloxacillin, Diphenicillin, Epicillin, Fenbenicillin, Floxicillin, Hetacillin, Lenampicillin, Metampicillin, Methicillin, Mezlocillin, Nafcillin, Oxacillin, Penamecillin, Penethamate Hydriodide, Penicillin G Benethamine, Penicillin G Benzathine, Penicillin G Benzhydrylamine, Penicillin G Calcium, Penicillin G Hydragamine, Penicillin G Potassium, Penicillin G. Procaine, Penicillin N, Penicillin O, Penicillin V, Penicillin V Benzathine, Penicillin V Hydrabamine, Penimepicycline, Phenethicillin, Piperacillin, Pivapicillin, Propicillin, Quinacillin, Sulbenicillin, Talampicillin, Temocillin and Ticarcillin;
  • Lincosamides such as Clindamycin and Lincomycin;
  • Macrolides such as Azithromycin, Carbomycin, Clarithromycin, Erythromycin(s) and Derivatives, Josamycin, Leucomycins, Midecamycins, Miokamycin, Oleandomycin, Primycin, Rokitamycin, Rosaramicin, Roxithromycin, Spiramycin and Troleandomycin;
  • Polypeptides such as Amphomycin, Bacitracin, Capreomycin, Colistin, Enduracidin, Enviomycin, Fusafungine, Gramicidin(s), Gramicidin S, Mikamycin, Polymyxin, Polymyxin B-Methanesulfonic Acid, Pristinamycin, Ristocetin, Teicoplanin, Thiostrepton, Tuberactinomycin, Tyrocidine, Tyrothricin, Vancomycin, Viomycin(s), Virginiamycin and Zinc Bacitracin;
  • Tetracyclines such as Spicycline, Chlortetracycline, Clomocycline, Demeclocycline, Doxycycline, Guamecycline, Lymecycline, Meclocycline, Methacycline, Minocycline, Oxytetracycline, Penimepicycline, Pipacycline, Rolitetracycline, Sancycline, Senociclin and Tetracycline; and
  • others such as Cycloserine, Mupirocin, Tuberin.
  • b. Synthetic Antibacterials
  • 2,4-Diaminopyrimidines such as Brodimoprim, Tetroxoprim and Trimethoprim;
  • Nitrofurans such as Furaltadone, Furazolium, Nifuradene, Nifuratel, Nifurfoline, Nifurpirinol, Nifurprazine, Nifurtoinol and Nitrofurantoin;
  • Quinolones and analogs thereof, such as Amifloxacin, Cinoxacin, Ciprofloxacin, Difloxacin, Enoxacin, Fleroxacin, Flumequine, Lomefloxacin, Miloxacin, Nalidixic Acid, Norfloxacin, Ofloxacin, Oxolinic Acid, Perfloxacin, Pipemidic Acid, Piromidic Acid, Rosoxacin, Temafloxacin and Tosufloxacin;
  • Sulfonamides such as Acetyl Sulfamethoxypyrazine, Acetyl Sulfisoxazole, Azosulfamide, Benzylsulfamide, Chloramine-β, Chloramine-T, Dichloramine-T, Formosulfathiazole, N2-Formyl-sulfisomidine, N4-β-D-Glucosylsulfanilamide, Mafenide, 4′-(Methyl-sulfamoyl)sulfanilanilide, p-Nitrosulfathiazole, Noprylsulfamide, Phthalylsulfacetamide, Phthalylsulfathiazole, Salazosulfadimidine, Succinylsulfathiazole, Sulfabenzamide, Sulfacetamide, Sulfachlorpyridazine, Sulfachrysoidine, Sulfacytine, Sulfadiazine, Sulfadicramide, Sulfadimethoxine, Sulfadoxine, Sulfaethidole, Sulfaguanidine, Sulfaguanol, Sulfalene, Sulfaloxic Acid, Sulfamerazine, Sulfameter, Sulfamethazine, Sulfamethizole, Sulfamethomidine, Sulfamethoxazole, Sulfamethoxypyridazine, Sulfametrole, sulfamidochrysoidine, Sulfamoxole, Sulfanilamide, Sulfanilamidomethanesulfonic Acid Triethanolamine Salt, 4-Sulfanilamidosalicyclic Acid, N4-Sulfanilylsulfanilamide, Sulfanilylurea, N-Sulfanilyl-3,4-xylamide, Sulfanitran, Sulfaperine, Sulfaphenazole, Sulfaproxyline, Sulfapyrazine, Sulfapyridine, Sulfasomizole, Sulfasymazine, Sulfathiazole, Sulfathiourea, Sulfatolamide, Sulfisornidine and Sulfisoxazole;
  • Sulfones, such as Acedapsone, Acediasulfone, Acetosulfone, Dapsone, Diathymosulfone, Glucosulfone, Solasulfone, Succisulfone, Sulfanilic Acid, p-Sulfanilylbenzylamine, p,p′-sulfonyldianiline-N,N′digalactoside, Sulfoxone and Thiazolsulfone;
  • Others such as Clofoctol, Hexedine, Magainins, Methenamine, Methenamine Anhydromethylene-citrate, Methenamine Hippurate, Methenamine Mandelate, Methenamine Sulfosalicylate, Nitroxoline, Squalamine and Xibornol.
  • c. Antifungal (Antibiotics)
  • Polyenes such as Amphotericin-B, Candicidin, Dermostatin, Filipin, Fungichromin, Hachimycin, Hamycin, Lucensomycin, Mepartricin, Natamycin, Nystatin, Pecilocin, Perimycin; and others, such as Azaserine, Griseofulvin, Oligomycins, PyrroInitrin, Siccanin, Tubercidin and Viridin.
  • d. Antifungal (Synthetic)
  • Allylamines such as Naftifine and terbinafine;
  • Imidazoles such as Bifonazole, Butoconazole, Chlordantoin, Chlormidazole, Cloconazole, Clotrimazole, Econazole, Enilconazole, Finticonazole, Isoconazole, Ketoconazole, Miconazole, Omoconazole, Oxiconazole Nitrate, Sulconazole and Tioconazole;
  • Triazoles such as Fluconazole, Itraconazole, Terconazole;
  • Others such as Acrisorcin, Amorolfine, Biphenamine, Bromosalicylchloranilide, Buclosamide, Chlophenesin, Ciclopirox, Cloxyquin, Coparaffinate, Diamthazole, Dihydrochloride, Exalamide, Flucytosine, Halethazole, Hexetidine, Loflucarban, Nifuratel, Potassium Iodide, Propionic Acid, Pyrithione, Salicylanilide, Sulbentine, Tenonitrozole, Tolciclate, Tolindate, Tolnaftate, Tricetin, Ujothion, and Undecylenic Acid.
  • e. Antiglaucoma Agents
  • Antiglaucoma agents, such as Dapiprazoke, Dichlorphenamide, Dipivefrin and Pilocarpine.
  • f. Anti-Inflammatory Agents
  • Corticosteroids, aminoarylcarboxylic Acid Derivatives such as Etofenamate, Meclofenamic Acid, Mefanamic Acid, Niflumic Acid;
  • Arylacetic Acid Derivatives such as Acemetacin, Amfenac Cinmetacin, Clopirac, Diclofenac, Fenclofenac, Fenclorac, Fenclozic Acid, Fentiazac, Glucametacin, Isozepac, Lonazolac, Metiazinic Acid, Oxametacine, Proglumetacin, Sulindac, Tiaramide and Tolmetin;
  • Arylbutyric Acid Derivatives such as Butibufen and Fenbufen;
  • Arylcarboxylic Acids such as Clidanac, Ketorolac and Tinoridine;
  • Arylpropionic Acid Derivatives such as Bucloxic Acid, Carprofen, Fenoprofen, Flunoxaprofen, Ibuprofen, Ibuproxam, Oxaprozin, Piketoprofen, Pirprofen, Pranoprofen, Protizinic Acid and Tiaprofenic Acid;
  • Pyrazoles such as Mepirizole;
  • Pyrazolones such as Clofezone, Feprazone, Mofebutazone, Oxyphenbutazone, Phenylbutazone, Phenyl Pyrazolidininones, Suxibuzone and Thiazolinobutazone;
  • Salicylic Acid Derivatives such as Bromosaligenin, Fendosal, Glycol Salicylate, Mesalamine, 1-Naphthyl Salicylate, Olsalazine and Sulfasalazine;
  • Thiazinecarboxamides such as Droxicam, Isoxicam and Piroxicam;
  • Others such as e-Acetamidocaproic Acid, S-Adenosylmethionine, 3-Amino-4-hydroxybutyric Acid, Amixetrine, Bendazac, Bucolome, Carbazones, Difenpiramide, Ditazol, Guaiazulene, Heterocyclic Aminoalkyl Esters of Mycophenolic Acid and Derivatives, Nabumetone, Nimesulide, Orgotein, Oxaceprol, Oxazole Derivatives, Paranyline, Pifoxime, 2-substituted-4,6-di-tertiary-butyl-s-hydroxy-1,3-pyrimidines, Proquazone and Tenidap.
  • g. Antiseptics
  • Guanidines such as Alexidine, Ambazone, Chlorhexidine and Picloxydine;
  • Halogens/Halogen Compounds such as Bomyl Chloride, Calcium Iodate, Iodine, Iodine Monochloride, Iodine Trichloride, Iodoform, Povidone-Iodine, Sodium Hypochlorite, Sodium Iodate, Symclosene, Thymol Iodide, Triclocarban, Triclosan and Troclosene Potassium;
  • Nitrofurans such as Furazolidone, 2-(Methoxymethyl)-5-Nitrofuran, Nidroxyzone, Nifuroxime, Nifurzide and Nitrofurazone;
  • Phenols such as Acetomeroctol, Chloroxylenol, Hexachlorophene, 1-Naphthyl Salicylate, 2,4,6-Tribromo-m-cresol and 3′,4′,5-Trichlorosalicylanilide;
  • Quinolines such as Aminoquinuride, Chloroxine, Chlorquinaldol, Cloxyquin, Ethylhydrocupreine, Halquinol, Hydrastine, 8-Hydroxyquinoline and Sulfate; and
  • others, such as Boric Acid, Chloroazodin, m-Cresyl Acetate, Cupric sulfate and Ichthammol.
  • h. Antivirals
  • Purines/Pyrimidinones, such as 2-Acetyl-Pyridine 5-((2-pyridylamino)thiocarbonyl) Thiocarbonohydrazone, Acyclovir, Dideoxyadenosine, dideoxycytidine, Dideoxyinosine, Edoxudine, Floxuridine, Ganciclovir, Idoxuridine, MADU, Pyridinone, Trifluridine, Vidrarbine and Zidovudline;
  • Others such as Acetylleucine Monoethanolamine, Acridinamine, Alkylisooxazoles, Amantadine, Amidinomycin, Cuminaldehyde Thiosemicarbzone, Foscarnet Sodium, Kethoxal, Lysozyme, Methisazone, Moroxydine, Podophyllotoxin, Ribavirin, Rimantadine, Stallimycin, Statolon, Thymosins, Tromantadine and Xenazoic Acid.
  • Combinations and Kits
  • The compounds and compositions containing the compounds may also be coated on bandages, mixed with bioadhesives or included in dressings. Thus, combinations of bandages, bioadhesives, dressings and other such materials and the compositions formulated as described herein are provided. Kits containing these combinations, which may also include compositions containing the above listed agents, are also provided.
  • Articles of Manufacture
  • The compounds and compositions provided herein may be packaged as articles of manufacture containing packaging material, one or more of the compounds provided herein, which is effective for ameliorating peripheral hyperalgesia, within the packaging material, and a label that indicates that the compound, N-oxide, acid, salt or other derivative thereof is used for treating hyperalgesic conditions.
  • Methods of Treatment
  • Compositions for use with human skin preferably may be applied at least once per day, or if necessary, to achieve the desired result, more often, to the areas of the skin for which treatment is sought. It is understood that the precise treatment regimen depends upon the individual treated and may be ascertained empirically depending upon the formulation, and particularly, the age of the treated individual. Any regimen is acceptable as long as the desired anti-hyperalgesic effects are achieved without substantial deleterious or sustained undesirable side effects.
  • The methods for treating human skin are practiced by applying to the skin, preferably at least daily, a composition suitable for human skin treatment or treatment of mucosal membranes and other body surface tissues, including the vagina, rectum, mouth, eyes and other such tissues. The compositions may be injected into joints or other inflamed areas.
  • Compositions may be combined with bandages, bioadhesives and other dressings and applied to the body in combination therewith.
  • The following examples are included for illustrative purposes only and are not intended to limit the scope of the invention.
  • EXAMPLE A Capsules
  • Active Compound  2.5 gm
    Corn starch  23.0 gm
    Lactose 145.0 gm
    Talc  15.0 gm
    Magnesium stearate  3.0 gm
  • The ingredients were mixed and were encapsulated using techniques practiced in the art.
  • EXAMPLE B Tablet
  • Active Compound  150 gm
    Lactose  125 gm
    Corn starch   50 gm
    Magnesium stearate  2.0 gm
    Liquid Petrolatum  2.0 gm
  • The ingredients were mixed, then put through U.S. Standard Screens to produce fine granules. The granules were compressed into tablets, each tablet containing about 150 mg of an active compound of the present invention.
  • EXAMPLE C Syrup
  • Active Compound  25 gm
    Lemon Oil   2 ml
    Sucrose  650 gm
    Citric Acid   4 gm
    Benzoic Acid   3 gm
    Tragacanth  16 gm
    Deionized water q.s. 1000 ml
  • The ingredients, without the active compound, are dispersed in water to make about 800 to 900 ml of solution. The active compound is then added and the solution is stirred into a syrup. Water is then added to make 1000 ml of the syrup.
  • EXAMPLE D Parenteral Solution
  • Active Compound  30 gm
    Methylparaben   3 gm
    Propylparaben   1 gm
    Lidocaine   5 gm
    Deionized water q.s. 1000 ml
  • The ingredients are dissolved in water to provide a solution followed by sterilization by filtration.
  • EXAMPLE E Rectal Suppository
  • Active Compound  80 gm
    Propylene glycol  95 gm
    Polyethylene glycol 4000 1800 gm
  • The active compound is added to the propylene glycol and milled until a finely divided uniform mixture is formed. The polyethylene glycol 4000 is melted and the propylene glycol dispersion is added with stirring to obtain a suspension. The suspension is poured into molds, allowed to solidify and removed from the molds for packaging.
  • EXAMPLE F Water-Washable Ointment
  • Active Compound  1.4% w/w
    Lanolin alcohol  0.15 w/w
    Emulsifying wax NF  7.5% w/w
    PEG-20 glycerides  5.0% w/w
    Petrolatum 86.0% w/w
  • The ingredients are melted together and mixed well until the resulting ointment congeals.
  • EXAMPLE G Oil-in-Water Cream
  • Active Compound 10.0% w/w
    Benzyl alcohol  4.0% w/w
    Propylene glycol 10.0% w/w
    Polyethylene glycol 400 10.0% w/w
    Petrolatum 20.0% w/w
    Stearyl alcohol 10.0% w/w
    Poloxamer 10.0% w/w
    Water q.s.  100
    Buffer to pH  7.0% w/w
  • In preparing the oil-in-water cream, water, propylene glycol and polyethylene glycol 400 are heated to about 70 to 80° C., followed by adding a mixture of petrolatum, stearyl alcohol and poloxamer and the mixture is stirred until homogeneous. The active compound in benzyl alcohol is added and the mixture is homogenized. The pH is then adjusted with a buffer to about 7.0.
  • EXAMPLE H Aqueous Gel
  • Active Compound 10.0% w/w
    Benzyl alcohol  4.0% w/w
    Hydroxyethyl cellulose  3.0% w/w
    Water q.s.  100
    Buffer to pH  7.0% w/w
  • The aqueous gel is prepared by mixing the active compound, benzyl alcohol and adding the mixture to buffered water. Hydroxyethyl cellulose is then added with stirring until the mixture gels.
  • The disclosures of each patent, patent application and publication cited or described in this document are hereby incorporated herein by reference, in their entirety.
  • Various modifications of the invention, in addition to those described herein, will be apparent to those skilled in the art from the foregoing description. Such modifications are also intended to fall within the scope of the appended claims.

Claims (21)

1-19. (canceled)
20. A compound of the formula IIIA or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof:
Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00361
wherein:
n is 1 to 3;
R1 and R2 are independently CH3 or together form —(CH2)m—, —CH2CH(OR)(CH2)2—, —CH2CH(F)(CH2)2—, —(CH2)2O(CH2)2— or —(CH2)2CH═CHCH2—;
R is H, alkyl, acyl or aroyl;
Ar is mono- or di-substituted phenyl, wherein said substituents are selected from the group consisting of halogen, OCH3, OH, SO2CH3, CF3, NH2, alkyl, CN, unsubstituted and substitued sulfamoyl groups;
Ar may also be substituted with NH(CH2)uCO2R′, NH(CH2)u(CH═CH)u(CH2)CO2R′, NHCO(CH2)u(CH═CH)u(CH2)uCO2R′, NHP(O)(OBn)2, NHP(O)(OR′)2, (CH2)uNHSO2CH3, (CH2)uNHC(S)NHCH(CO2R′)(CH2)uCO2R′, CONHOH, or (CH2)uCONHOH;
or Ar is substituted with
Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00362
R6 is H or Ac;
R7 is NH(CH2)vCO2H, NH(CH2)vCH(NH2)(CO2H), NHCH(CO2H)(CH2)vNH2. NH(CH2)vSO3H, NH(CH2)vPO3H, NH(CH2)vNHC(NH)NH2, or NHCH(CO2H)(CH2)vCO2H;
R′ is H or lower alkyl;
X7 is H, halogen, OH, OCH3, CF3, NO2, NH2, amino substituted with acyl, carbamate, alkyl or aryl sulfonates, or COR″;
R″ is OH, amide, alkoxy, aryloxy or heteroaryloxy;
X8 is CO2H, NHSO2CH3, NHP(O)(OBn)2, NHP(O)(OH)2, OP(O)(OBn)2, or OP(O)(OH)2;
m is 4 to 8;
u is 0 to 5; and
v is 1 to 20.
21. A compound which is selected from the group consisting of
N-[(4-Trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-{[1S-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl)]ethyl}-acetamido]glycine hydrochloride;
2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1R,S)-1-(3-sulfamidophenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(4-Trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1 S]-1-[3-[(methylsulfonyl)amino]-phenyl]-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(4-Methanesulfonylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-[3-[(methylsulfonyl)amino]-phenyl]-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide methanesulfonate;
2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-[3-[(methylsulfonyl)amino]phenyl]-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-[3-(diethyl phosphoryl)amino]phenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-[3-[(4-oxo-butenoate)]amino]phenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide;
2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{(1S)-1-[3-(3-(((iso-butoxycarbonyl)-methyl)aminocarbonyl)propionamido)phenyl]-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(3,4-Dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{(1R,S)-1-[3-(3-(((hydroxycarbonyl)-methyl)aminocarbonyl)propionamido)phenyl]-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
2-[(2-N-Phenylsulfonamido)phenyl)]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide methane sulfonate;
2-[3-(N-Methylsulfamoyl)-4-chlorophenyl]-N-methyl-N-{[1 S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(3-Sulfamoyl-4-chlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]-ethyl}acetamide methanesulfonate;
2-(3-Sulfamoyl-4-chlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-[3-[(methylsulfonyl)amino]-phenyl]-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide methanesulfonate;
2-[3-(N-Methylsulfamoyl)-4-fluorophenyl]-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
2-[2&4-(N-Methylsulfamoyl)phenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride;
3-(N-Methylsulfamoyl)phenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]-acetamide hydrochloride;
2-[N-Methylsulfamoyl)-4-bromophenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl acetamide hydochloride;
2-[2&4-(N-Methylsulfamoyl)phenyl]-N-methyl-N-{[1 S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
2-[2-Methoxy-3-(N-methylsulfamoyl)phenyl]-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
(Z)-4-[2-(2-Aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-(3S)-3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl]ethyl]acetamido]-4-oxo-2-butenoic acid;
(Z)-4-[2-(2-Amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl]acetamido]-4-oxo-butanoic acid;
(Z)-4-[2-(2-Amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl]acetamido]-4-oxo-2-butenoic acid;
(E) Ethyl 4-[2-(2-amino-4,5-dichorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl]acetamido]-4-oxo-2-butenoate hydrochloride;
(Z)-4-[2-(2-Amino-4-trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl]acetamido]-4-oxo-2-butenoic acid;
(Z)-4-[2-(2-Aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]-ethyl]acetamido]-4-oxo-2-butenoic acid hemimaleate;
2-(N,N-Bisacetic acid-2-amino-α,α,α,-trifluoro-4-tolyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride;
3-[2-N-Methylsulfonamido)phenyl]-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(O-Butylacetate)phenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl acetamide hydrochloride;
2-[Phenoxy-acetyl]methylamino(1-pyrrolidinyl) ethyl]acetamide]hydrochloride;
2-[4-Trifluoromethylphenyl]-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-3-hydroxy-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(2-Pyridyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1 S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-3-hydroxypyrrolidinyl]ethyl}-acetamide dihydrochloride;
2-(5-Bromo-3-pyridyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-pyrrolidinyl ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(5-Bromo-3-pyridyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-[1-(3S)-3-hydroxy-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(9-Anthracenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(2-Carboxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1 S]-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyldethyl}acetamide hydrochloride;
[2-(2-Phenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}acetamido]-2-oxo-glycine hydrochloride;
Methyl N-[2-(2-phenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1S]-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}-acetamido]-2-oxo-glycinate hydrochloride;
2-(3,4-Dihydroxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1 S]-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}-acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(3,4-Dimethoxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-{[1 S]-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl}-acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(2-Methanesulfonamidophenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-methanesulfonamidophenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(2-Iso-butyramidophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-(3-isobutyramido-phenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide methanesulfonic acid salt;
4-[4-N-Methylsulfonamido-phenyl]-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(3,4-Dichlorocinnamyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(2-Nitrocinnamyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl) ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride;
(R,S)-1-[2-(Methanesulfonylamino)-phenyl-N-methylacetamido]-1-(3-methoxy-phenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane, methanesulfonic acid salt;
(R,S)-1-[2-(Methanesulfonylamino)-phenyl-N-methylacetamido]-1-(3-hydroxy-phenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)ethane, methanesulfonic acid salt;
2-(3-Indolyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-[(3S)-1-pyrrolidin-3-ol]ethyl]-acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(2-N-Benzyl-2-N-methylsulfamoyl-3,4-dimethoxyphenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride;
2-(N-Methylsulfonamido-2-aminophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1R)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide methane sulfonate;
(R,S)-1-(4-Trifluoromethylphenyl-N-methylacetamido)-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane, methanesulfonic acid salt;
(R,S)-1-(4-Trifluoromethylphenyl-N-methylacetamido)-1-(3-hydroxyphenyl)-2-(1-pyrrolidino)-ethane, methanesulfonic acid salt;
2-Fluorophenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]-acetamide hydrochloride;
4-Fluorophenyl-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl]acetamide hydrochloride; and
(E)-4-[2-(2-Amino-4,5-dichlorophenyl)-N-methyl-N-[(1S)-1-phenyl)-2-[1-pyrrolidinyl]ethyl]acetamido]-4-oxo-2-butenoic acid hydrochloride.
22. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of claim 20 in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
23. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of claim 21 in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
24. A method of treating hyperalgesia in a patient comprising administereing to said patient an effective amount of a compound of claim 20.
25. A method of treating hyperalgesia in a patient comprising administereing to said patient an effective amount of a compound of claim 21.
26. A method of treating hyperalgesia in a patient comprising administereing to said patient an effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition of claim 22.
27. A method of treating hyperalgesia in a patient comprising administereing to said patient an effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition of claim 23.
28. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of claim 20 and an antibiotic, antiviral, antifungal, anti-inflammatory agent, or a mixture thereof in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
29. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of claim 21 and an antibiotic, antiviral, antifungal, anti-inflammatory agent, or a mixture thereof in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
30. A compound of the formula IVA or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof:
Figure US20050020576A1-20050127-C00363
wherein:
n is 1 to 3;
R1 and R2 are independently CH3 or together form —(CH2)m—, —CH2CH(OR)(CH2)2—, —CH2CH(F)(CH2)2—, —(CH2)2O(CH2)2— or —(CH2)2CH═CHCH2—;
R is H, alkyl, acyl or aroyl;
R3 and R4 are independently H, OCH3, alkyl or —O(CH2)2—;
each X9 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, CF3, OH, OCH3, SO2NH(CH2)qCH3, NH(CH2)qCO2R′, NH(CH2)q(CH═CH)q(CH2)qCO2R′, NH(CH2)q(CH≡CH)q(CH2)qCO2R′, NHCO(CH2)q(CH═CH)q(CH2)qCO2R′, and NHCO(CH2)q(CH≡CH)q(CH2)qCO2R′;
R′ is OH, lower alkyl, aryl ester or aryl amide;
q is 0 to 20; and
y is 1 to 4.
31. A compound which is selected from the group consisting of
(Z)-4-[2-((±)-trans-2-Amino-4,5-dichloro-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-cyclohexyl]phenylaetamido)]-4-oxo-2-butenoic acid;
(Z)-4-[2-((±)-trans-2-Amino-4-trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)-cyclohexyl]-phenylaetamido)]-4-oxo-2-butenoic acid;
(±)-trans-2-N-Methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-pyridylacetamide dihydrochloride;
(±)-trans-3-N-Methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-5-bromo-pyridylacetamide hydrochloride;
(±)-trans-3,5-Di-Trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide hydrochloride;
(±)-trans-3-N-Methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-(trans-3-furyl)acetamide hydrochloride;
(±)-trans-2-Methoxy-3-methylsulfamoyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide hydrochloride;
(±)-trans-3-N-Methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]indoleacetamide hydrochloride;
(±)-trans-4-Fluoro-3-methylsulfamoyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamide hydrochloride;
N-[1 S,2S-trans-4-Trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamido]glycine hydrochloride; and
N-[1 R,2R-trans-4-Trifluoromethyl-N-methyl-N-[2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)cyclohexyl]-phenylacetamido]glycine hydrochloride.
32. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of claim 30 in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
33. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of claim 31 in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
34. A method of treating hyperalgesia in a patient comprising administering to said patient an effective amount of a compound of claim 30.
35. A method of treating hyperalgesia in a patient comprising administering to said patient an effective amount of a compound of claim 31.
36. A method of treating hyperalgesia in a patient comprising administering to said patient an effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition of claim 32.
37. A method of treating hyperalgesia in a patient comprising administering to said patient an effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition of claim 33.
38. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of claim 30 and an antibiotic, antiviral, antifungal, anti-inflammatory agent, or a mixture thereof in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
39. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of claim 31 and an antibiotic, antiviral, antifungal, anti-inflammatory agent, or a mixture thereof in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
US10/807,113 1996-03-08 2004-03-23 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof Abandoned US20050020576A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US10/807,113 US20050020576A1 (en) 1996-03-08 2004-03-23 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof

Applications Claiming Priority (8)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US08/612,680 US5646151A (en) 1996-03-08 1996-03-08 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US08/796,078 US5688955A (en) 1996-03-08 1997-02-05 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US08/899,086 US5744458A (en) 1996-03-08 1997-07-23 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US09/034,661 US5945443A (en) 1996-03-08 1998-03-03 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US09/150,369 US6303611B1 (en) 1996-03-08 1998-09-09 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US09/478,482 US6391910B1 (en) 1996-03-08 2000-01-06 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US10/146,693 US6750216B2 (en) 1996-03-08 2002-05-15 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US10/807,113 US20050020576A1 (en) 1996-03-08 2004-03-23 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US10/146,693 Continuation US6750216B2 (en) 1996-03-08 2002-05-15 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20050020576A1 true US20050020576A1 (en) 2005-01-27

Family

ID=27617951

Family Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US10/146,693 Expired - Fee Related US6750216B2 (en) 1996-03-08 2002-05-15 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US10/807,113 Abandoned US20050020576A1 (en) 1996-03-08 2004-03-23 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof

Family Applications Before (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US10/146,693 Expired - Fee Related US6750216B2 (en) 1996-03-08 2002-05-15 Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof

Country Status (1)

Country Link
US (2) US6750216B2 (en)

Cited By (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20030138455A1 (en) * 1997-09-04 2003-07-24 Hertelendy, Pharm.D.,Ph.D Zsolt Istvan Urogential or anorectal transmucosal vaccine delivery system
US20090163682A1 (en) * 2007-10-19 2009-06-25 Braskem S/A Process of Preparation of Catalytic Support and Supported Metallocene Catalysts for Production of Homopolymers and Copolymers of Ethylene with Alfa-Olefins, of High and Ultra High Molecular Weight and with Broad Molecular Weight Distribution in Slurry, Bulk and Gas Phase Processes and Products Thereof
US20100046495A1 (en) * 2006-09-28 2010-02-25 Guy Wolf Method and apparatus of system scheduler
US20110212926A1 (en) * 2008-05-20 2011-09-01 Neurogesx, Inc. Water-soluble acetaminophen analogs
US8735376B2 (en) 2008-05-20 2014-05-27 Acorda Therapeutics, Inc. Carbonate prodrugs and methods of using the same

Families Citing this family (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20050070504A1 (en) * 2001-12-21 2005-03-31 The Procter & Gamble Co. Risedronate compositions and their methods of use
CN102766112B (en) * 2012-08-10 2014-03-19 河北富格药业有限公司 Synthetic method of repaglinide
WO2014146111A2 (en) * 2013-03-15 2014-09-18 The Regents Of The University Of California Analgesic compounds and methods of use
WO2016106133A1 (en) * 2014-12-23 2016-06-30 Nektar Therapeutics N-methyl-n-(1-phenyl-2-(1-pyrrolidinyl)ethyl)-2-aminophenylacetamide derivatives agonists for the kappa opioid receptor

Citations (15)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4065573A (en) * 1976-06-03 1977-12-27 The Upjohn Company 4-Amino-4-phenylcyclohexanone ketal compositions and process of use
US4098904A (en) * 1976-11-12 1978-07-04 The Upjohn Company Analgesic n-(2-aminocycloaliphatic)benzamides
US4145435A (en) * 1976-11-12 1979-03-20 The Upjohn Company 2-aminocycloaliphatic amide compounds
US4212878A (en) * 1978-01-26 1980-07-15 The Upjohn Company Phenylacetamide derivative analgesics
US4359476A (en) * 1981-04-09 1982-11-16 The Upjohn Company Adjacently substituted cycloalkane-amide analgesics
US4438130A (en) * 1981-11-12 1984-03-20 The Upjohn Company Analgesic 1-oxa-, aza- and thia-spirocyclic compounds
US4663343A (en) * 1985-07-19 1987-05-05 Warner-Lambert Company Substituted naphthalenyloxy-1,2-diaminocyclohexyl amide compounds
US4855316A (en) * 1988-02-18 1989-08-08 Warner-Lambert Company 1,2-diamino-4,5-dimethoxycyclohexyl amide analgesic compounds
US4906655A (en) * 1989-01-24 1990-03-06 Warner-Lambert Company Novel 1,2-cyclohexylaminoaryl amides useful as analgesic agents
US5646151A (en) * 1996-03-08 1997-07-08 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US5688955A (en) * 1996-03-08 1997-11-18 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US5763445A (en) * 1996-03-08 1998-06-09 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
US6057323A (en) * 1996-03-08 2000-05-02 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
US6239154B1 (en) * 1996-03-08 2001-05-29 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
US6303611B1 (en) * 1996-03-08 2001-10-16 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof

Family Cites Families (12)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4656182A (en) 1983-12-06 1987-04-07 Warner-Lambert Company Substituted trans-1,2-diaminocyclohexyl amide compounds
FR2592879B1 (en) 1986-01-13 1988-04-29 Roussel Uclaf NOVEL DECAHYDROQUINOLEIN DERIVATIVES, PROCESS FOR THEIR PREPARATION, PREPARATION INTERMEDIATES, THEIR APPLICATION AS MEDICAMENTS AND COMPOSITIONS CONTAINING THEM
GB8618188D0 (en) 1986-07-25 1986-09-03 Ici Plc Diamine compounds
DE3766335D1 (en) 1986-09-17 1991-01-03 Zambeletti Spa L N-1 ACYLATED- (1- (PHENYL- OR BENZYL-)) - 1,2-AETHYLENE DIAMINE.
GB8801304D0 (en) 1988-01-21 1988-02-17 Ici Plc Diamine compounds
EP0330467A1 (en) 1988-02-23 1989-08-30 Glaxo Group Limited Heterocyclic compounds
GB8804104D0 (en) 1988-02-23 1988-03-23 Glaxo Group Ltd Chemical compounds
GB8824400D0 (en) 1988-10-18 1988-11-23 Glaxo Group Ltd Chemical compounds
AU626949B2 (en) 1988-12-06 1992-08-13 Warner-Lambert Company 2-amino-4 or 5-methoxycyclohexyl amides useful as analgesics
WO1991008206A1 (en) 1989-11-24 1991-06-13 Dr. Lo. Zambeletti S.P.A. N-acyl-substituted azacyclic compounds, processes for their preparation, and their use as pharmaceuticals
EP0585296A1 (en) 1991-05-21 1994-03-09 Smithkline Beecham Farmaceutici S.p.A. 2-(pyrrolidinyl-1-methyl)-piperidine derivatives and their use as kappa-recept or agonists
JP5610659B2 (en) 2000-07-21 2014-10-22 ルバンス セラピュティックス インク.Revance Therapeutics,Inc. Multi-component biological transport system

Patent Citations (21)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4065573A (en) * 1976-06-03 1977-12-27 The Upjohn Company 4-Amino-4-phenylcyclohexanone ketal compositions and process of use
US4098904A (en) * 1976-11-12 1978-07-04 The Upjohn Company Analgesic n-(2-aminocycloaliphatic)benzamides
US4145435A (en) * 1976-11-12 1979-03-20 The Upjohn Company 2-aminocycloaliphatic amide compounds
US4212878A (en) * 1978-01-26 1980-07-15 The Upjohn Company Phenylacetamide derivative analgesics
US4359476A (en) * 1981-04-09 1982-11-16 The Upjohn Company Adjacently substituted cycloalkane-amide analgesics
US4438130A (en) * 1981-11-12 1984-03-20 The Upjohn Company Analgesic 1-oxa-, aza- and thia-spirocyclic compounds
US4663343A (en) * 1985-07-19 1987-05-05 Warner-Lambert Company Substituted naphthalenyloxy-1,2-diaminocyclohexyl amide compounds
US4855316A (en) * 1988-02-18 1989-08-08 Warner-Lambert Company 1,2-diamino-4,5-dimethoxycyclohexyl amide analgesic compounds
US4906655A (en) * 1989-01-24 1990-03-06 Warner-Lambert Company Novel 1,2-cyclohexylaminoaryl amides useful as analgesic agents
US5646151A (en) * 1996-03-08 1997-07-08 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US5688955A (en) * 1996-03-08 1997-11-18 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US5744458A (en) * 1996-03-08 1998-04-28 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US5763445A (en) * 1996-03-08 1998-06-09 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
US5945443A (en) * 1996-03-08 1999-08-31 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US5981513A (en) * 1996-03-08 1999-11-09 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds, pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
US6028063A (en) * 1996-03-08 2000-02-22 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds, pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
US6057323A (en) * 1996-03-08 2000-05-02 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
US6180623B1 (en) * 1996-03-08 2001-01-30 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds, pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
US6239154B1 (en) * 1996-03-08 2001-05-29 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
US6303611B1 (en) * 1996-03-08 2001-10-16 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US6391910B1 (en) * 1996-03-08 2002-05-21 Adolor Corporation Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof

Cited By (14)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20030138455A1 (en) * 1997-09-04 2003-07-24 Hertelendy, Pharm.D.,Ph.D Zsolt Istvan Urogential or anorectal transmucosal vaccine delivery system
US7135191B2 (en) * 1997-09-04 2006-11-14 Zsolt Istvan Hertelendy Urogenital or anorectal transmucosal vaccine delivery system
US20100046495A1 (en) * 2006-09-28 2010-02-25 Guy Wolf Method and apparatus of system scheduler
US20090163682A1 (en) * 2007-10-19 2009-06-25 Braskem S/A Process of Preparation of Catalytic Support and Supported Metallocene Catalysts for Production of Homopolymers and Copolymers of Ethylene with Alfa-Olefins, of High and Ultra High Molecular Weight and with Broad Molecular Weight Distribution in Slurry, Bulk and Gas Phase Processes and Products Thereof
US8993545B2 (en) 2008-05-20 2015-03-31 Acorda Therapeutics, Inc. Carbonate prodrugs and methods of using the same
US8735376B2 (en) 2008-05-20 2014-05-27 Acorda Therapeutics, Inc. Carbonate prodrugs and methods of using the same
US20110212926A1 (en) * 2008-05-20 2011-09-01 Neurogesx, Inc. Water-soluble acetaminophen analogs
US9289501B2 (en) 2008-05-20 2016-03-22 Acorda Therapeutics, Inc. Carbonate prodrugs and methods of using the same
US9683000B2 (en) 2008-05-20 2017-06-20 Acorda Therapeutics, Inc. Carbonate prodrugs and methods of using the same
US9981998B2 (en) 2008-05-20 2018-05-29 Acorda Therapeutics, Inc. Water-soluble acetaminophen analogs
US10377779B2 (en) 2008-05-20 2019-08-13 Acorda Therapeutics, Inc. Carbonate prodrugs and methods of using the same
US10442826B2 (en) 2008-05-20 2019-10-15 Acorda Therapeutics, Inc. Water-soluble acetaminophen analogs
US11021498B2 (en) 2008-05-20 2021-06-01 Acorda Therapeutics, Inc. Water-soluble acetaminophen analogs
US11136342B2 (en) 2008-05-20 2021-10-05 Acorda Therapeutics, Inc. Carbonate prodrugs and methods of using the same

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US20030144272A1 (en) 2003-07-31
US6750216B2 (en) 2004-06-15

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US6476063B2 (en) Kappa agonist compounds, pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
US5945443A (en) Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US6391910B1 (en) Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US5981513A (en) Kappa agonist compounds, pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
US5688955A (en) Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
US6054445A (en) Kappa agonist compounds pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritis therewith
US6750216B2 (en) Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
USRE38133E1 (en) Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
AU5960699A (en) Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
AU2760002A (en) Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
AU4584302A (en) Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
AU5960499A (en) Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof
MXPA99011344A (en) Kappa agonist compounds, pharmaceutical formulations and method of prevention and treatment of pruritus therewith
AU5960599A (en) Kappa agonist compounds and pharmaceutical formulations thereof

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: ADOLOR CORPORATION, PENNSYLVANIA

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:MAYCOCK, ALAN L.;MARELLA, MICHAEL A.;KUMAR, VIRENDRA;AND OTHERS;REEL/FRAME:015084/0386;SIGNING DATES FROM 20040702 TO 20040820

Owner name: ADOLOR CORPORATION, PENNSYLVANIA

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:ZHANG, WEI YUAN;REEL/FRAME:015084/0395

Effective date: 20040816

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION